UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

 

xANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended: December 31, 2011

 

¨TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from _________ to __________

 

Commission File Number: 000-51584

 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware   04-3510455
(State or other jurisdiction of   (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
incorporation or organization)    
     
24 North Street, Pittsfield, Massachusetts   01201
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (413) 443-5601

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class Name of Exchange on which registered
   
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share NASDAQ Stock Market LLC

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ¨ No x

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ¨ No x

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes x No ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes x No ¨

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of the Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. x

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one)

 

Large Accelerated Filer ¨ Accelerated Filer x Non-Accelerated Filer ¨ Smaller Reporting Company ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ¨ No x

 

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates was approximately $365 million, based upon the closing price of $22.39 as quoted on the NASDAQ Global Select Market as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter.

 

The number of shares outstanding of the registrant’s common stock as of March 7, 2012 was 21,193,105.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE: Portions of the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K.

 

 
 

 

INDEX    
     
PART I   4
     
ITEM 1. BUSINESS 4
     
ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS 32
     
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS 39
     
ITEM 2. PROPERTIES 39
     
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS 40
     
ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES 41
     
PART II   42
     
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES 42
     
ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA 45
     
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS 47
     
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK 70
     
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA 72
     
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE 73
     
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES 74
     
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION 74
     
PART III   75
     
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS, AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE 75
     
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION 76
     
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS 76
     
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE 77
     
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES 77
     
PART IV   78
     
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES 78
     
SIGNATURES 80

 

2 -
 

 

TABLE INDEX  
   
PART I  4
   
ITEM 1. 4
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 1 – LOAN PORTFOLIO ANALYSIS 10
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 2 – MATURITY AND SENSITIVITY OF LOAN PORTFOLIO 12
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 3 – PROBLEM ASSETS AND ACCRUING TDR 14
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 4 – ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSS 16
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 5 – ALLOCATION OF ALLOWANCE BY LOAN CATEGORY 17
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 6 – AMORTIZED COST AND FAIR VALUE OF SECURITIES 18
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 7 – WEIGHTED AVERAGE YIELD ON SECURITIES 19
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 8 – AVERAGE BALANCE AND WEIGHTED AVERAGE INTEREST RATES ON DEPOSITS 20
   
ITEM 1 TABLE 9 – MATURITY OF DEPOSITS > $100,000 20
   
PART II 42
   
ITEM 7-7A.
   
ITEM 7 – 7A TABLE 1 – AVERAGE BALANCES, INTEREST AND AVERAGE YIELD COSTS 65
   
ITEM 7 – 7A TABLE 2 – RATE VOLUME ANALYSIS 66
   
ITEM 7 – 7A TABLE 3 – CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS 68
   
ITEM 7 – 7A TABLE 4 – QUALITATIVE ASPECTS OF MARKET RISK 70

 

3 -
 

 

PART I

 

ITEM 1. BUSINESS 

Forward-Looking Statements

 

Certain statements contained in this document that are not historical facts may constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (referred to as the Securities Act), and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (referred to as the Securities Exchange Act), and are intended to be covered by the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. You can identify these statements from the use of the words “may,” “will,” “should,” “could,” “would,” “plan,” “potential,” “estimate,” “project,” “believe,” “intend,” “anticipate,” “expect,” “target” and similar expressions. These forward-looking statements are subject to significant risks, assumptions and uncertainties, including among other things, changes in general economic and business conditions.

 

Additional factors that could cause results to differ materially from those described in the forward-looking statements can be found in the definitive Proxy Statement/Prospectus filed by Berkshire Hills Bancorp with the SEC on February 27, 2012 for the acquisition of The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company (“CBT”). This document contains forward-looking statements about the proposed merger of Berkshire Hills Bancorp and CBT. Certain factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from expected results include delays in completing the merger, difficulties in achieving cost savings from the merger or in achieving such cost savings within the expected time frame, difficulties in integrating Berkshire Hills Bancorp and CBT, increased competitive pressures, changes in the interest rate environment, changes in general economic conditions, legislative and regulatory changes that adversely affect the business in which Berkshire Hills Bancorp and CBT are engaged, changes in the securities markets and other risks and uncertainties disclosed from time to time in documents that Berkshire Hills Bancorp files with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

You should not place undue reliance on forward-looking statements, which reflect our expectations only as of the date of this report. We do not assume any obligation to revise forward-looking statements except as may be required by law.

 

General

 

Berkshire Hills Bancorp (“Berkshire” or “the Company”) is headquartered in Pittsfield, Massachusetts. Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. is a Delaware corporation and the holding company for the Berkshire Bank (“the Bank”) and Berkshire Insurance Group (“BIG”). Established in 1846, the Bank is one of Massachusetts' oldest and largest independent banks and is the largest banking institution based in Western Massachusetts.

 

At year-end 2011, the Bank had $4.0 billion in assets and its wealth management division managed under $1.0 billion in assets invested for clients. Additionally, Berkshire Insurance Group’s revenues place it among the largest independent insurance agencies in Western Massachusetts. Berkshire’s common shares are traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “BHLB”. At year-end 2011, Berkshire's closing stock price was $22.19 and 21.1 million common shares were outstanding. Berkshire is a regional bank and financial services company providing the service capabilities of a larger institution and the local focus and responsiveness as a local partner to its communities. The Company seeks to distinguish itself based on the following attributes:

 

Strong growth from organic, de novo, product and acquisition strategies

 

4 -
 

 

Solid capital, core funding and risk management culture

 

Experienced executive team focused on earnings, high performance, and stockholder value

 

Distinctive brand and culture as America’s Most Exciting BankSM

 

Diversified integrated financial service revenues

 

Positioned to be regional consolidator in attractive markets

 

The Company profiles its growing regional franchise as follows:

 

 

5 -
 

 

The Bank operates under the brand America’s Most Exciting BankSM and portrays its brand and culture as follows:

 

 

The Bank has 60 full-service banking offices serving communities throughout Western Massachusetts, Northeastern New York and in Southern Vermont. The Bank operates in four regions:

 

·The Berkshire County Region, with 19 offices in Berkshire County. Berkshire County is the Company’s traditional market, where it has a leading market share in many of its product lines. With the acquisition of Legacy Bancorp in 2011, Berkshire increased its overall share of this market. Berkshire County is renowned for its combination of nature, culture, and harmony which makes it a leisure and tourism destination and an attractive location for an emerging creative economy. Berkshire County is within commuting range of both Albany, New York and Springfield, Massachusetts and is also part of a mountain recreational area shared with Southern Vermont. Berkshire is an attractive second home and vacation area for New York City and Boston. The Pittsfield metropolitan statistical area (“MSA”) 2010 GDP was $5 billion. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had approximately $1.2 billion in loans and $1.2 billion in deposits in this market.

 

6 -
 

 

·The New York Region, with 21 offices serving the Albany area as well as to the west in Rome, adjacent to Utica as a result of the acquisition of Rome Bancorp in 2011. The Albany area represents a de novo expansion by the Company begun in 2005. Berkshire’s presence in this area expanded with the Legacy Bancorp acquisition in 2011. In 2009, the Company recruited a prominent New York Chairman and an experienced commercial banking team to serve this market. Albany is the state capital and is part of New York’s Tech Valley which is gaining prominence as a world technology hub including leading edge nanotechnology initiatives representing a blend of private enterprise and public investment. In 2010 and 2011, Berkshire opened three offices in this area and is opening another two offices in the first half of 2012. The Albany/Schenectady MSA 2010 GDP was $41 billion. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had approximately $0.7 billion in loans and $0.9 billion in deposits in its New York region (excluding discontinued operations).

 

·The Springfield Region, in the Pioneer Valley area with 12 offices along the Connecticut River valley in Springfield, Massachusetts, and north and west of Springfield. The Company entered this region through the acquisition of Woronoco Bancorp in June 2005 and also services certain other New England commercial business through this region. The Company opened its new regional headquarters in Springfield, along with a new branch in the fourth quarter of 2009. This region is the metropolitan hub of Western Massachusetts and part of the Hartford/Springfield economic region; centrally located between Boston and New York City at the crossroads of Interstate 91 which traverses the length of New England and Interstate 90 which traverses the width of Massachusetts. This region also has easy access to Bradley International Airport, which is a major airport serving central New England. The Springfield MSA 2010 GDP was $23 billion. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had approximately $0.6 billion in loans and $0.6 billion in deposits in this region.

 

·The Vermont Region, with 8 branches serving the Southern Vermont region. The Company entered this region through the acquisition of Factory Point Bancorp in September 2007. The Southern Vermont region is contiguous to Berkshire County and shares similar characteristics, with a more pronounced focus on recreation activities in Vermont’s Green Mountains. Additionally, this region shares commerce with both the Berkshire and Albany markets, and provides the Company with access to selected accounts in Northern Vermont. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had approximately $0.2 billion in loans and $0.4 billion in deposits in this region.

 

These four regions are viewed as having favorable demographics and provide an attractive regional niche for the Bank to distinguish itself from larger super-regional banks and smaller community banks while serving its three state market area. The Company’s markets have experienced less exposure to speculative development, real estate inflation, and subprime lending activities compared to many other regions of the country. The Company believes it has attractive long term growth prospects because of the Bank's positioning as the largest locally headquartered regional bank which can serve the retail and commercial markets with a strong product set and responsive local management. The Company also has a goal to deepen its wallet share as a result of its focused cross sales program across its various business lines including insurance and wealth management.

 

In addition to the above regions, Berkshire has expanded into commercial banking operations into Central and Eastern Massachusetts. In 2010, it recruited a leading New England middle market asset based lending team which is located in Woburn, Massachusetts and which serves businesses throughout New England and the New York region. In the fourth quarter of 2011, Berkshire recruited an experienced Central/Eastern Massachusetts commercial banking team which has been located in a new commercial office in Westborough. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had approximately $0.2 billion in loans under the management of these teams.

 

The Company is pursuing expansion through organic growth, de novo branching, product development, recruitment of banking teams, and through acquisitions. The Bank promotes itself as America’s Most Exciting BankSM. It has set out to change the financial service experience. Its vision is to excel as a high performing market leader with the right people, attitude, and energy providing an engaging and exciting customer and team member experience. This brand and culture statement is expected to drive customer engagement, loyalty, market share and profitability. Similarly, this focus on performance underlies Berkshire’s strong growth, improved efficiency, investment in infrastructure, and solid execution of acquisition due diligence and integration.

 

7 -
 

 

The Company offers a wide range of deposit, lending, insurance, and wealth management products to retail, commercial, not-for-profit, and municipal customers in its market areas. The Company’s product offerings also include retail and commercial electronic banking, commercial cash management, and commercial interest rate swaps. The Company’s traditional commercial banking products are offered within its regions and to commercial relationships in Massachusetts, Connecticut, and Rhode Island. The Company stresses a culture of teamwork and performance excellence to produce customer satisfaction to support its strategic growth and profitability. The Company utilizes Six Sigma tools to improve operational effectiveness and efficiency.

 

The Company has recruited executives with experience in regional bank management and has augmented its management team as it has expanded into a three state diversified regional financial services provider. The Company has invested in its infrastructure in order to position itself for further growth as a regional consolidator with an objective of filling in and expanding its footprint in its New England and New York markets. Its acquisitions of banks, insurance agencies, and wealth management companies have resulted in initial dilution to book value and tangible book value per share for the Company to achieve the scale and momentum to support future beneficial growth. In 2011, with the benefit of this strategy, the Company completed two bank acquisitions which were accretive to earnings per share while overall tangible book value per share also increased during the year.

 

The Company has continued to seek opportunities to participate in regional consolidation in its markets. In the fourth quarter of 2011, Berkshire announced an agreement to acquire CBT – The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company. Based in Hartford, CBT has approximately $0.3 billion in total assets and serves the Greater Hartford area with eight branches. This acquisition provides Berkshire with a long-targeted expansion into Northern Connecticut and combines with its initiatives in Springfield and Central Massachusetts to build its presence in this larger region, which is the second largest economic area in New England. This is anticipated to further enhance the Company’s positioning as a major regional provider.

 

Company Website and Availability of Securities and Exchange Commission Filings

 

The Company’s Internet website is in the Investor Relations section at www.berkshirebank.com. At this site, the Company makes available free of charge, its annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and any amendments to those reports filed pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically files such material with the Securities and Exchange Commission. Information on the website is not incorporated by reference and is not a part of this annual report on Form 10-K.

 

8 -
 

 

Competition

 

The Company is subject to strong competition from banks and other financial institutions and financial service providers. Its competition includes national and super-regional banks such as Bank of America, TD Bank, Citizens Bank, Sovereign Bank, and Key Bank which have substantially greater resources and lending limits. Non-bank competitors include credit unions, brokerage firms, insurance providers, financial planners, and the mutual fund industry. New technology is reshaping customer interaction with financial service providers and the increase of Internet-accessible financial institutions increases competition for the Company’s customers. The Company generally competes on the basis of customer service, relationship management, and the fair pricing of loan and deposit products and wealth management and insurance services. The location and convenience of branch offices is also a significant competitive factor, particularly regarding new offices. The Company does not rely on any individual, group, or entity for a material portion of its deposits. Recent economic and financial events have significantly impacted the competitive environment. The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (“the Federal Reserve”) reduced short-term interest rates to close to zero and numerous financial companies converted to bank charters and began accepting deposits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”). A number of nonbank sources of competition have withdrawn from the market, and national competitors have reduced their commitment to some activities in the region.

 

Lending Activities

 

General. The Bank originates loans in the four basic portfolio categories discussed below. Lending activities are limited by federal and state laws and regulations. Loan interest rates and other key loan terms are affected principally by the Bank’s asset/liability strategy, loan demand, competition, and the supply of money available for lending purposes. These factors, in turn, are affected by general and economic conditions, monetary policies of the federal government, including the Federal Reserve, legislative tax policies and governmental budgetary matters. Most of the Bank’s loans are made in its market areas and are secured by real estate located in its market areas. Lending activities are therefore affected by activity in these real estate markets. The Bank does not engage in subprime lending activities targeted towards borrowers in high risk categories. The Bank monitors and manages the amount of long-term fixed-rate lending volume. Adjustable-rate loan products generally reduce interest rate risk but may produce higher loan losses in the event of sustained rate increases. The Bank retains most of the loans it originates, although the Bank generally sells its longer-term, fixed-rate, one to four-family residential loans and sometimes buys and sells participations in some commercial loans.

 

Loan Portfolio Analysis. The following table sets forth the year-end composition of the Bank’s loan portfolio in dollar amounts and as a percentage of the portfolio at the dates indicated. Further information about the composition of the loan portfolio is contained in the Loans footnote in the consolidated financial statements.

 

9 -
 

 

Item 1 - Table 1 - Loan Portfolio Analysis
   2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
       Percent       Percent       Percent       Percent       Percent 
       of       of       of       of       of 
(In millions)  Amount   Total   Amount   Total   Amount   Total   Amount   Total   Amount   Total 
                                         
Residential mortgages  $1,020.4    34%  $645.0    30%  $609.0    31%  $677.2    34%  $657.0    33%
                                                   
Commercial mortgages   1,156.2    39    925.6    43    851.8    43    805.5    40    704.8    36 
Commercial business   410.3    14    286.1    13    186.0    10    178.9    9    203.6    11 
Total commercial loans   1,566.5    53    1,211.7    56    1,037.8    53    984.4    49    908.4    47 
                                                   
Consumer   369.6    13    285.5    14    314.8    16    345.5    17    378.6    20 
Total loans  $2,956.5    100%  $2,142.2    100%  $1,961.6    100%  $2,007.1    100%  $1,944.0    100%
                                                   
Allowance for loan losses   (32.4)        (31.9)        (31.8)        (22.9)        (22.1)     
 Net loans  $2,924.1        $2,110.3        $1,929.8        $1,984.2        $1,921.9      

 

Residential Mortgages. The Bank offers fixed-rate and adjustable-rate residential mortgage loans with maturities of up to 30 years that are fully amortizing with monthly loan payments. Residential mortgages are generally underwritten according to the Federal National Mortgage Association (“Fannie Mae”) or the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Association (“Freddie Mac”) guidelines for loans they designate as “A” or “A-” (these are referred to as “conforming loans”). Private mortgage insurance is generally required for loans with loan-to-value ratios in excess of 80%. The Bank also originates loans above conforming loan amount limits, referred to as “jumbo loans,” which are generally conforming to secondary market guidelines for these loans. The Bank does not offer subprime mortgage lending programs.

 

The Bank normally sells a portion of its newly originated fixed rate mortgages. It also monitors its interest rate risk position and sometimes may decide to sell existing mortgage loans in the secondary mortgage market. The Bank is approved as a direct seller to Fannie Mae, retaining the servicing rights. The Bank may also sell loans to other secondary market investors, either on a servicing retained or servicing released basis. The Bank is also an approved originator of loans for sale to the Federal Housing Administration (“FHA”), U.S. Department of Veteran Affairs (“VA”), and state housing agency programs.

 

The Bank offers adjustable rate (“ARM”) mortgages which do not contain interest-only or negative amortization features. After an initial term of six months to ten years, the rates on these loans generally reset every year based upon a contractual spread or margin above the average yield on U.S. Treasury securities. ARM loan interest rates may rise as interest rates rise, thereby increasing the potential for default. At year-end 2011, the Bank’s adjustable rate mortgage portfolio totaled $386 million. The Bank also originates loans to individuals for the construction and acquisition of personal residences. These loans generally provide fifteen-month construction periods followed by a permanent mortgage loan, and follow the Bank’s normal mortgage underwriting guidelines.

 

Commercial Mortgages. The Bank originates commercial mortgages on properties used for business purposes such as small office buildings, industrial, healthcare, lodging, recreation, or retail facilities. This portfolio also includes commercial 1-4 family and multifamily properties. Loans may generally be made with amortizations of up to 25 years and with interest rates that adjust periodically (primarily from short-term to five years). Most commercial mortgages are originated with final maturities of ten years or less. The Bank generally requires that borrowers have debt service coverage ratios (the ratio of available cash flows before debt service to debt service) of at least 1.25 times. Loans at origination may be made up to 80% of appraised value. Generally, commercial mortgages require personal guarantees by the principals. Credit enhancements in the form of additional collateral or guarantees are normally considered for start-up businesses without a qualifying cash flow history.

 

10 -
 

 

Commercial mortgages generally involve larger principal amounts and a greater degree of risk than residential mortgages. They also often provide higher lending spreads. Because repayment is often dependent on the successful operation or management of the properties, repayment of such loans may be affected by adverse conditions in the real estate market or the economy. The Bank seeks to minimize these risks through strict adherence to its underwriting standards and portfolio management processes.

 

The Bank offers interest rate swaps to certain larger commercial mortgage borrowers. These swaps allow the Bank to originate a mortgage based on short-term LIBOR rates and allow the borrower to swap into a longer term fixed rate. The Bank simultaneously sells an offsetting back-to-back swap to an investment grade national bank so that it does not retain this fixed-rate risk. The Bank also records fee income on these interest rate swaps based on the terms of the offsetting swaps with the bank counterparties.

 

The Bank originates construction loans to builders and commercial borrowers in and around its markets. Construction loans finance the acquisition and/or improvement of commercial and residential properties. The maximum loan to value limits for construction loans follow FDIC supervisory limits, up to a maximum of 80%. The Bank commits to provide the permanent mortgage financing on most of our construction loans on income-producing property. Advances on construction loans are made in accordance with a schedule reflecting the cost of the improvements. Construction loans include land acquisition loans up to a maximum 65% loan to value on raw land. Construction loans may have greater credit risk than permanent loans. In many cases, the loan’s repayment is dependent on the completion of construction and other real estate improvements, which entails risk that construction permits may be delayed or may not be received, or that there may be delays or cost overruns during construction. Repayment is also often dependent on the sale or rental of the improved property, which depends on market conditions and the availability of permanent financing. Developers and contractors may also encounter liquidity risks or other risks related to other projects which are not being financed.

 

Commercial Business Loans. The Bank offers secured commercial term loans with repayment terms which are normally limited to the expected useful life of the asset being financed, generally not exceeding seven years. The Bank also offers revolving loans, lines of credit, letters of credit, time notes and Small Business Administration guaranteed loans. Business lines of credit have adjustable rates of interest and are payable on demand, subject to annual review and renewal. Commercial business loans are generally secured by a variety of collateral such as accounts receivable, inventory and equipment, and are generally supported by personal guarantees. Loan to value ratios depend on the collateral type and generally do not exceed 95% of the liquidation value of the collateral. Some commercial loans may also be secured by liens on real estate. The Bank generally does not make unsecured commercial loans.

 

In the first quarter of 2010, the Bank recruited an experienced asset based lending team with a long track record of serving middle-market companies in New England. This Asset Based Lending Group serves its traditional New England market, as well as the Bank’s market in northeastern New York. This new group expands the Bank’s business lending offerings to include revolving lines of credit and term loans secured by accounts receivable, inventory, and other assets to manufacturers, distributors and select service companies experiencing seasonal working capital needs, rapid sales growth, a turnaround, buyout or recapitalization with credit needs ranging from $2 to $25 million. Asset based lending involves monitoring loan collateral so that outstanding balances are always properly secured by business assets. This new business line expands the Bank’s business services, diversifies its loan portfolio, and provides important credit services across a wider geography. The Asset Based Lending Group is located in Woburn, Massachusetts in the Greater Boston area where this lending team has been based for many years. The recruitment of this team included the operations personnel and the acquisition of lending systems which are critical to this form of lending. The Company's Chief Risk Officer brings extensive experience in the oversight of asset based lending functions, and has instituted underwriting and review policies appropriate for the integration of this form of lending into the Bank’s overall lending risk management processes.

 

11 -
 

 

In the fourth quarter of 2011, the Bank recruited an experienced commercial lending team to serve the commercial middle market in Central/Eastern Massachusetts. This team also has expertise in health care and education financing. Additionally, in the latter part of 2011, the Bank reorganized its small business lending function to expand this important business financing capability in 2012, and will include the retail division in the origination of conforming small business loans in order to provide the best service to community based small businesses.

 

Commercial loans are of higher risk and are made primarily on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from the cash flows of its business. Further, any collateral securing such loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to monitor and appraise and may fluctuate in value. The Bank gives additional consideration to the borrower’s credit history and the guarantor’s capacity to help mitigate these risks.

 

Consumer Loans. The Bank’s consumer loans consist principally of home equity lines of credit, together with second mortgage loans and automobile loans. The Bank’s home equity lines of credit are typically secured by first or second mortgages on borrowers’ residences. Home equity lines have an initial revolving period up to fifteen years, followed by an amortizing term up to twenty years. These loans are normally indexed to the prime rate. Home equity loans also include amortizing fixed-rate second mortgages with terms up to fifteen years. Lending policies for combined debt service and collateral coverage are similar to those used for residential first mortgages, although underwriting verifications are more streamlined. The maximum combined loan-to-value is 80%. Home equity line credit risks are similar to those of adjustable-rate first mortgages, although these loans may be more sensitive to losses when interest rates are rising due to increased sensitivity to rate changes. Additionally, there may be possible compression of collateral coverage on second lien home equity lines. The Bank also includes all other consumer loans in this portfolio total, including personal secured and unsecured loans and overdraft protection facilities.

 

Maturity and Sensitivity of Loan Portfolio. The following table shows contractual final maturities of selected loan categories at year-end 2011. The contractual maturities do not reflect premiums, discounts, deferred costs, and prepayments.

 

Item 1 - Table 2 - Loan Contractual Maturity -Scheduled Loan Amortizations are not included in the maturities presented.

Contractual Maturity  One Year   More than One   More Than     
(In thousands)  or Less   to Five Years   Five Years   Total 
                 
Construction mortgage loans:                    
Residential  $11,062   $30,499   $-   $41,561 
Commercial   30,579    93,639    -    124,218 
Commercial business loans   226,895    135,923    47,474    410,292 
Total  $268,536   $260,061   $47,474   $576,071 

 

For the $308 million of loans above which mature in more than one year, $70 million of these loans are fixed-rate and $238 million are variable rate.

 

Loan Administration. Lending activities are governed by a loan policy approved by the Board’s Risk Management Committee. Internal staff perform post-closing loan documentation review, quality control, and monitor commercial loan administration. The lending staff assigns a risk rating to all commercial loans. Management primarily relies on internal risk management staff to review the risk ratings of the majority of commercial loan balances.

 

12 -
 

 

The Bank’s lending activities follow written, non-discriminatory underwriting standards and loan origination procedures established by the Risk Management Committee and Management. The Bank’s loan underwriting is based on a review of certain factors including risk ratings, recourse, loan-to-value ratios and material policy exceptions. The Risk Management Committee has established individual and combined loan limits and lending approval authorities. Management’s Executive Loan Committee is responsible for commercial and residential loan approvals in accordance with these standards and procedures. Generally, Commercial lending management has the authority to approve pass rated secured loans up to $2 million, and in conjunction with the Senior Credit Officer up to $7.5 million (or $5 million in the case of material policy exceptions). The Executive Loan Committee approves secured loans over these amounts (and over $1 million unsecured).

 

The Bank’s lending activities are conducted by its salaried and commissioned loan personnel. Designated salaried branch staff originate conforming residential mortgages and receive bonuses based on overall performance. Additionally, the Bank employs commissioned residential mortgage originators. Commercial lenders receive salaries and are eligible for bonuses based on overall performance. From time to time, the Bank will purchase whole loans or participations in loans. These loans are underwritten according to the Bank’s underwriting criteria and procedures and are generally serviced by the originating lender under terms of the applicable participation agreement. The Bank routinely sells newly originated fixed rate residential mortgages in the secondary market. Customer rate locks are offered without charge and rate locked applications are generally committed for forward sale to minimize interest rate risk pending delivery of the loans to the investors. The Bank sells a limited number of commercial loan participations on a non-recourse basis. The Bank issues loan commitments to its prospective borrowers conditioned on the occurrence of certain events. Loan origination commitments are made in writing on specified terms and conditions and are generally honored for up to sixty days from approval; some commercial commitments are made for longer terms.

 

The loan policy sets certain limits on concentrations of credit and requires periodic reporting of concentrations to the Risk Management Committee. Loans outstanding to the ten largest relationships each averaged $23 million, or 6.4% of risk based capital in total. Total year-end commercial construction loans outstanding were 36% of the Bank’s risk based capital at year-end, and total commercial mortgage outstandings (including certain owner-occupied loans) were estimated at 256% of risk based capital. The Bank’s portfolio management objective has been to reduce these concentrations. The FDIC has established monitoring guidelines of 100% and 300% for these ratios, respectively. Above these guidelines, additional monitoring and risk management controls are required.

 

Problem Assets. The Bank prefers to work with borrowers to resolve problems rather than proceeding to foreclosure. For commercial loans, this may result in a period of forbearance or restructuring of the loan, which is normally done at current market terms and does not result in a “troubled” loan designation. For residential mortgage loans, the Bank generally follows FDIC guidelines to attempt a restructuring that will enable an owner-occupant to remain in their home. However, if these processes fail to result in a performing loan, then the Bank generally will initiate foreclosure or other proceedings no later than the 90th day of a delinquency, as necessary, to minimize any potential loss. Management reports delinquent loans and non-performing assets to the Board quarterly. Loans are generally removed from accruing status when they reach 90 days delinquent, except for certain loans which are well secured and in the process of collection. Delinquent automobile loans are maintained on accrual until they reach 120 days delinquent, and then they are generally charged-off.

 

Real estate acquired by the Bank as a result of loan collections is classified as real estate owned until sold. When property is acquired it is recorded at fair market value less estimated selling costs at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis. Holding costs and decreases in fair value after acquisition are expensed.

 

Interest income that would have been recorded for 2011 had nonaccruing loans been current according to their original terms, amounted to $1.3 million. Included in this amount is $54 thousand related to troubled debt restructurings. The amount of interest income on those loans that was included in net income in 2011 was $0.7 million. Included in this amount is $100 thousand related to troubled debt restructurings. Interest income on accruing troubled debt restructurings totaled $0.3 million for 2011. The total carrying value of troubled debt restructurings was $1.3 million at year-end.

 

13 -
 

 

The following table sets forth additional information on year-end problem assets and accruing troubled debt restructurings (“TDR”). Due to accounting standards for business combinations, non-accrual loans of acquired banks are recorded as accruing on the acquisition date. Therefore measures related to accruing and non-accruing loans reflect these standards and may not be comparable compared to prior periods. 

 

Item 1 - Table 3 - Problem Assets and Accruing TDR
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
                     
Non-accruing loans:                         
Residential mortgages  $7,010   $2,173   $3,304   $1,646   $726 
Commercial mortgages   14,280    9,488    31,917    7,738    5,177 
Commercial business   990    1,305    3,115    1,921    4,164 
Consumer   1,954    746    364    866    441 
Total non-performing loans   24,234    13,712    38,700    12,171    10,508 
Real estate owned   1,900    3,386    30    498    866 
Total non-performing assets  $26,134   $17,098   $38,730   $12,669   $11,374 
                          
Troubled debt restructurings (accruing)  $1,263   $7,829   $17,818   $7,456   $4,613 
Accruing loans 90+ days past due  $10,184   $1,054   $91   $923   $823 
                          
Total non-performing loans/total loans   0.82%   0.64%   1.97%   0.61%   0.54%
Total non-performing assets/total assets   0.65%   0.59%   1.43%   0.48%   0.45%

 

Asset Classification and Delinquencies. The Bank performs an internal analysis of its commercial loan portfolio and assets to classify such loans and assets similar to the manner in which such loans and assets are classified by the federal banking regulators. There are four classifications for loans with higher than normal risk: Loss, Doubtful, Substandard and Special Mention. An asset classified as Loss is normally fully charged-off. Substandard assets have one or more defined weaknesses and are characterized by the distinct possibility that the insured institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Doubtful assets have the weaknesses of substandard assets with the additional characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values questionable, and there is a high possibility of loss. Assets that do not currently expose the insured institution to sufficient risk to warrant classification in one of the aforementioned categories but possess weaknesses are designated Special Mention. Please see the additional discussion of non-accruing and potential problem loans in Item 7 and additional information about loans by risk rating in the Loans Note to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses. The Bank’s loan portfolio is regularly reviewed by management to evaluate the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. The allowance represents management’s estimate of inherent losses that are probable and estimable as of the date of the financial statements. The allowance includes a specific component for impaired loans (a “specific loan loss reserve”) and a general component for portfolios of all outstanding loans (a “general loan loss reserve”). There is no allowance for loan losses assigned to acquired loans which are carried at fair value, including the impact of expected losses, as of the acquisition date. The loan loss allowance is discussed further in the Note about Significant Accounting Policies in the consolidated financial statements.

 

For loans covered by the loan loss allowance, Management assesses specific loan loss reserves when it deems that it is probable that the Bank will be unable to collect all amounts due according to the contractual terms stipulated in the loan agreement. Management weighs various factors in its assessment, including but not limited to, its review of the borrower’s payment history and the borrower’s future ability to service the debt, the current value of any pledged collateral, and the strength of any guarantor support. Generally non-accruing commercial loans are deemed impaired and evaluated for specific valuation allowances. Confirmed loan losses are charged-off directly to the allowance. Losses are deemed confirmed when upon review of all the available evidence, any portion of the loan balance is deemed uncollectible. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance.

 

 

14 -
 

 

For loans covered by the loan loss allowance, Management estimates general loan loss reserves when it is probable that there would be credit losses in portfolios of loans with similar characteristics. Management has identified four primary loan portfolios: residential mortgages, commercial mortgages, commercial business and consumer loans. Sub-portfolios within these primary loan portfolios are also evaluated in order to arrive at a more precise general loan loss allowance.. The methodology for computing the general allowance was enhanced in 2011. This methodology includes a historical loss component and an environmental factors component. The historical loss component is based on the Bank’s risk rating system in combination with the attribution of loss factors based on industry historical corporate default and recovery rates. The environmental factors component assesses loss potential as it may be affected by economic business conditions, lending policies and procedures, portfolio characteristics, management and staff changes, problem loan trends, and credit concentration trends. While the general loss reserve is analyzed according to the various subportfolios, the general loss reserve in aggregate is available to cover all losses in all components of the loan portfolio.

 

Management believes that it uses the best information available to establish the allowance for loan losses. However, future adjustments to the allowance for loan losses may be necessary, and results of operations could be adversely affected if circumstances differ substantially from the assumptions used in making its determinations. Because the estimation of inherent losses cannot be made with certainty, there can be no assurance that the existing allowance for loan losses is adequate or that increases will not be necessary should the quality of any loan or loan portfolio category deteriorate as a result of the factors discussed above. Additionally, the regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, also periodically review the Bank’s allowance for loan losses. Such agencies may require the Bank to make additional provisions for estimated losses based upon judgments different from those of management. Any material increase in the allowance for loan losses may adversely affect the Bank’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

15 -
 

 

The following table presents an analysis of the allowance for loan losses for the years indicated.

 

Item 1 - Table 4 - Allowance for Loan Loss
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
                     
Balance at beginning of year  $31,898   $31,816   $22,908   $22,116   $19,370 
Charged-off loans:                         
Residential mortgages   1,322    409    2,016    143    110 
Commercial mortgages   4,046    6,403    27,596    1,384    - 
Commercial business   1,443    2,685    5,945    884    4,850 
Consumer   885    1,188    3,586    2,031    1,416 
Total charged-off loans   7,696    10,685    39,143    4,442    6,376 
                          
Recoveries on charged-off loans:                         
Residential mortgages   231    213    -    -    - 
Commercial mortgages   189    794    22    100    - 
Commercial business   109    1,094    64    290    13 
Consumer   150    140    235    264    356 
Total recoveries   679    2,241    321    654    369 
                          
Net loans charged-off   7,017    8,444    38,822    3,788    6,007 
Allowance attributed to loans acquired by merger   -    -    -    -    4,453 
Provision for loan losses   7,563    8,526    47,730    4,580    4,300 
Transfer of commitment reserve   -    -    -    -    - 
Balance at end of year  $32,444   $31,898   $31,816   $22,908   $22,116 
                          
Ratios:                         
                          
Net charge-offs/average loans   0.27%   0.42%   1.96%   0.19%   0.34%
Recoveries/charged-off loans   8.82    20.97    0.82    14.72    5.79 
Net loans charged-off/allowance for loan losses   21.63    26.47    109.81    14.77    27.16 
Allowance for loan losses/total loans   1.10    1.49    1.62    1.14    1.14 
Allowance for loan losses/non-accruing loans   133.88    232.63    82.21    188.22    210.47 

 

The following tables present year-end data for the approximate allocation of the allowance for loan losses by loan categories at the dates indicated (including an apportionment of any unallocated amount). The first table shows for each category the amount of the allowance allocated to that category as a percentage of the outstanding loans in that category. The second table shows the allocated allowance together with the percentage of loans in each category to total loans. Management believes that the allowance can be allocated by category only on an approximate basis. The allocation of the allowance to each category is not indicative of future losses and does not restrict the use of any of the allowance to absorb losses in any category. Due to the impact of accounting standards for acquired loans, data in the accompanying tables may not be comparable between accounting periods.

 

16 -
 

 

Item 1 - Table 5A - Allocation of Allowance for Loan Loss by Category

   2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of 
       Amount Allocated       Amount Allocated       Amount Allocated       Amount Allocated       Amount Allocated 
       to Total       to Total       to Total       to Total       to Total 
   Amount   Loans in Each   Amount   Loans in Each   Amount   Loans in Each   Amount   Loans in Each   Amount   Loans in Each 
(Dollars in thousands)  Allocated   Category   Allocated   Category   Allocated   Category   Allocated   Category   Allocated   Category 
                                         
Residential mortgages  $3,420    0.34%  $3,200    0.50%  $3,169    0.52%  $2,006    0.30%  $2,028    0.31%
Commercial mortgages   22,176    1.92    19,923    2.15    19,659    2.31    13,539    1.68    12,040    1.71 
Commercial business   4,566    1.11    6,498    2.27    6,099    3.28    4,184    2.34    5,787    2.84 
Consumer   2,282    0.62    2,277    0.80    2,889    0.92    3,179    0.92    2,261    0.60 
                                                   
Total  $32,444    1.10%  $31,898    1.49%  $31,816    1.62%  $22,908    1.14%  $22,116    1.14%

 

Item 1 - Table 5B - Allocation of Allowance for Loan Loss

   2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of       Percent of 
       Loans in Each       Loans in Each       Loans in Each       Loans in Each       Loans in Each 
   Amount   Category   Amount   Category   Amount   Category   Amount   Category   Amount   Category 
(Dollars in thousands)  Allocated   to Total Loans   Allocated   to Total Loans   Allocated   to Total Loans   Allocated   to Total Loans   Allocated   to Total Loans 
                                                   
Residential mortgages  $3,420    34.51%  $3,200    30.11%  $3,169    31.05%  $2,006    33.74%  $2,028    33.74%
Commercial mortgages   22,176    39.11    19,923    43.21    19,659    43.42    13,539    40.13    12,040    40.29 
Commercial business   4,566    13.88    6,498    13.35    6,099    9.48    4,184    8.92    5,787    8.76 
Consumer   2,282    12.50    2,277    13.33    2,889    16.05    3,179    17.21    2,261    17.21 
                                                   
Total  $32,444    100.00%  $31,898    100.00%  $31,816    100.00%  $22,908    100.00%  $22,116    100.00%

 

 

Investment Securities Activities

 

The securities portfolio provides cash flow to protect the safety of customer deposits and as a potential source of liquidity for funding loan commitments. The portfolio is also used to manage interest rate risk and to earn a reasonable return on investment. Investment decisions are made in accordance with the Company's investment policy and include consideration of risk, return, duration, and portfolio concentrations. Day-to-day oversight of the portfolio rests with the Chief Financial Officer and the Treasurer. The Asset/Liability Committee meets monthly and reviews investment strategies. The Risk Management Committee reviews all securities transactions and provides general oversight of the investment function.

 

The Company has historically maintained a high-quality portfolio of limited duration mortgage-backed securities, together with a portfolio of municipal bonds including national and local issuers and local economic development bonds issued to non-profit organizations. Nearly all of the mortgage-backed securities are issued by Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac, and they generally have an average duration of two to four years. They principally consist of collateralized mortgage obligations (generally consisting of planned amortization class bonds). Other than securities issued by the above agencies, no other issuer concentrations exceeding 10% of stockholders’ equity existed at year-end 2011. The municipal portfolio provides tax-advantaged yield, and the local economic development bonds were originated by the Company to area borrowers. Nearly all of the Company's available for sale municipal securities are investment grade rated and most of the portfolio carries credit enhancement protection. The Company also invests in equity securities of local financial institutions for a variety of reasons, including if it concludes the financial institution is undervalued or if the Company might consider partnering with the financial institution in the future. The Company owns restricted equity in the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston (“FHLBB”) based on the operating relationship with the FHLBB. The Company owns an interest rate swap against a tax advantaged economic development bond issued to a local not-for-profit organization, and as a result this security is carried as a trading account security. The Bank did not record any material losses or write-downs of investment securities during the year and none of the Company’s investment securities were other-than-temporarily impaired at year-end.

 

17 -
 

 

The following tables present the amortized cost and fair value of the Company's securities, by type of security, for the years indicated.

 

Item 1 - Table 6A - Amortized Cost and Fair Value of Securities

   2011   2010   2009 
   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair 
(In thousands)  Cost   Value   Cost   Value   Cost   Value 
Securities available for sale                              
Municipal bonds and obligations  $73,436   $77,854   $79,292   $79,906   $73,277   $74,784 
Mortgage-backed securities   289,084    292,707    170,294    172,883    192,597    197,276 
Other bonds and obligations   30,702    28,186    40,931    38,548    51,707    49,722 
Marketable equity securities   20,236    21,009    15,756    18,905    2,679    2,563 
                               
Total securities available for sale  $413,458   $419,756   $306,273   $310,242   $320,260   $324,345 
                               
Securities held to maturity                              
Municipal bonds and obligations  $10,349   $10,349   $7,069   $7,069   $14,737   $14,737 
Mortgage-backed securities   79    83    83    86    139    142 
Tax advantaged economic development bonds   47,869    49,348    48,861    50,016    42,572    43,515 
Other bonds and obligations   615    615    423    423    173    173 
                               
Total securities held to maturity  $58,912   $60,395   $56,436   $57,594   $57,621   $58,567 
                               
Trading account security  $14,096   $17,395   $14,560   $16,155   $15,000   $15,880 
                               
Restricted equity securities  $37,118   $37,118   $23,120   $23,120   $23,120   $23,120 

 

Item 1 - Table 6B - Amortized Cost and Fair Value of Securities

   2011   2010   2009 
   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair 
(In thousands)  Cost   Value   Cost   Value   Cost   Value 
U.S. Treasuries,other Government agencies and corporations  $309,399   $313,799   $186,133   $191,874   $195,415   $199,981 
Municipal bonds and obligations   145,750    154,946    149,782    153,146    145,586    148,916 
Other bonds and obligations   68,435    65,919    64,474    62,091    75,000    73,015 
                               
Total Securites  $523,584   $534,664   $400,389   $407,111   $416,002   $421,911 

The schedule includes available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities as well as the trading security and restricted equity securities.

 

The following table summarizes year-end 2011 amortized cost, weighted average yields and contractual maturities of debt securities. A significant portion of the mortgage-based securities are planned amortization class bonds. Their expected durations are 2-4 years at current interest rates, but the contractual maturities shown reflect the underlying maturities of the collateral mortgages. Additionally, the mortgage-based securities maturities shown below are based on final maturities and do not include scheduled amortization.

 

18 -
 

 

Item 1 - Table 7 - Weighted Average Yield

           More than One   More than Five Years             
   One Year or Less   Year to Five Years   to Ten Years   More than Ten Years   Total 
       Weighted       Weighted       Weighted       Weighted       Weighted 
   Amortized   Average   Amortized   Average   Amortized   Average   Amortized   Average   Amortized   Average 
(In millions)  Cost   Yield   Cost   Yield   Cost   Yield   Cost   Yield   Cost   Yield 
     
Municipal bonds and obligations  $6.7    1.60%  $3.9    4.84%  $61.7    4.68%  $95.6    5.47%   167.9    5.01%
Mortgage-backed securities   0.9    1.15    7.1    2.63    24.0    2.10    221.2    2.13    253.2    2.14 
Other bonds and obligations   0.3    0.36    8.0    3.97    2.0    5.01    20.7    5.37    31.0    4.94 
Total  $7.9    1.51%  $19.0    3.65%  $87.7    3.98%  $337.5    3.28%  $452.1    3.40%

 

Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds

 

Deposits are the major source of funds for the Bank's lending and investment activities. Deposit accounts are the primary product and service interaction with the Bank’s customers. The Bank serves personal, commercial, non-profit, and municipal deposit customers. Most of the Bank’s deposits are generated from the areas surrounding its branch offices. The Bank offers a wide variety of deposit accounts with a range of interest rates and terms. The Bank also periodically offers promotional interest rates and terms for limited periods of time. The Bank’s deposit accounts consist of interest-bearing checking, noninterest-bearing checking, regular savings, money market savings and time certificates of deposit. The Bank emphasizes its transaction deposits – checking and NOW accounts for personal accounts and checking accounts promoted to businesses. These accounts have the lowest marginal cost to the Bank and are also often a core account for a customer relationship. The Bank offers a courtesy overdraft program to improve customer service, and also provides debit cards and other electronic fee producing payment services to transaction account customers. The Bank is promoting remote deposit capture devices so that commercial accounts can make deposits from their place of business. Money market accounts have increased in popularity due to their interest rate structure. Savings accounts include traditional passbook and statement accounts. The Bank’s time accounts provide maturities from three months to ten years. Additionally, the Bank offers a variety of retirement deposit accounts to personal and business customers. Deposit service fee income also includes other miscellaneous transaction and convenience services sold to customers through the branch system as part of an overall service relationship.

 

The Bank offers 100% insurance on all deposits as a result of a combination of insurance from the FDIC and the Massachusetts Depositors Insurance Fund, a mutual insurance fund sponsored by Massachusetts-chartered savings banks. This provides a competitive advantage compared to banks which do not offer this insurance. In the fourth quarter of 2008, the FDIC increased its insurance limits from $100 thousand per person to $250 thousand per person. Additionally, the FDIC optionally offered unlimited insurance on most categories of transaction deposit accounts, and the Bank opted to participate in this program. The $250 thousand limit was made permanent by the passage of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”). The Dodd-Frank Act also extended the unlimited coverage on non-interest bearing demand accounts through December 31, 2012.

 

19 -
 

 

The following table presents information concerning average balances and weighted average interest rates on the Bank’s interest-bearing deposit accounts for the years indicated. Deposit amounts in the following tables include balances associated with discontinued operations.

 

Item 1 - Table 8 - Average Balance and Weighted Average Rates for Deposits  

   2011   2010   2009 
       Percent           Percent           Percent     
       of Total   Weighted       of Total   Weighted       of Total   Weighted 
   Average   Average   Average   Average   Average   Average   Average   Average   Average 
(In millions)  Balance   Deposits   Rate   Balance   Deposits   Rate   Balance   Deposits   Rate 
                                     
Demand  $377.9    14%  $-  $279.2    14%  $-  $256.4    13%  $ -%
NOW   244.2    9    0.4    199.3    10    0.4    188.2    10    0.4 
Money market   833.3    31    0.7    597.3    29    0.9    499.6    26    1.3 
Savings   369.6    13    0.2    224.3    11    0.3    212.3    11    0.3 
Time   902.6    33    1.8    749.2    36    2.6    777.1    40    3.2 
Total  $2,727.6    100%   0.9%  $2,049.3    100%   1.3%  $1,933.6    100%   1.7%

 

At year-end 2011, the Bank had time deposit accounts in amounts of $100 thousand or more maturing as follows:

 

Item 1 - Table 9 - Maturity of Deposits > $100,000

       Weighted 
       Average 
Maturity Period  Amount   Rate 
(In thousands)    
Three months or less  $59,988    1.36%
Over 3 months through 6 months   67,092    1.94 
Over 6 months through 12 months   100,582    1.32 
Over 12 months   263,384    2.67 
Total  $491,046    2.14%

 

The Company also uses borrowings from the FHLBB as an additional source of funding, particularly for daily cash management and for funding longer duration assets. FHLBB advances also provide more pricing and option alternatives for particular asset/liability needs. The FHLBB functions as a central reserve bank providing credit for member institutions. As an FHLBB member, the Company is required to own capital stock of the FHLBB. FHLBB borrowings are secured by a blanket lien on most of the Bank’s mortgage loans and mortgage-related securities, as well as certain other assets. Advances are made under several different credit programs with different lending standards, interest rates, and range of maturities. The Company has a $15 million trust preferred debenture outstanding . Subject to certain limitations, the Company can also choose to issue common stock in public stock offerings and can also potentially obtain privately placed common and preferred stock, and subordinated, and senior debt from institutional and private investors.

 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

The Company uses interest rate swap instruments for its own account and also offers them for sale to commercial customers for their own accounts, normally in conjunction with commercial loans offered by the Bank to these customers. At year-end 2011, the Company held derivative financial instruments with a total notional amount of $578 million. The Company has a policy for managing its derivative financial instruments, and the policy and program activity are overseen by the Risk Management Committee. Interest rate swap counterparties are limited to a select number of national financial institutions and commercial borrower customers. Collateral may be required based on financial condition tests. The Company works with a third-party firm which assists in marketing swap transactions, documenting transactions, and providing information for bookkeeping and accounting purposes.

 

20 -
 

 

Wealth Management Services

 

The Company's Wealth Management Group provides consultative investment management and trust relationships to individuals, businesses, and institutions, with an emphasis on personal investment management. The Wealth Management Group has built a track record over more than a decade with its dedicated in-house investment management team. In 2011, the Wealth Management business line expanded with the integration of the Renaissance Investment Group in the Legacy merger. At year-end 2011, assets under management (including investment accounts) totaled $964 million. Wealth management services include investment management, trust administration, estate planning, and private banking. The Bank also provides a full line of investment products, financial planning, and brokerage services utilizing Commonwealth Financial Network as the broker/dealer.

 

Insurance

 

As an independent insurance agent, the Berkshire Insurance Group represents a carefully selected group of financially sound, reputable insurance companies offering attractive coverage at competitive prices. The Insurance Group offers a full line of personal and commercial property and casualty insurance. It also offers employee benefits insurance and a full line of personal life, health, and financial services insurance products. The Group sells all lines of insurance in Western Massachusetts, Southern Vermont, Upstate New York and Northwestern Connecticut. Berkshire Insurance Group operates a focused cross-sell program of insurance and banking products through all offices and branches of the Bank with some of the Group’s offices co-located within the Bank’s branches.

 

Personnel

 

At year-end 2011, the Company had 760 full time equivalent employees (excluding employees assigned to discontinued operations which were divested in January, 2012). Total employees increased from 599 at the start of the year due to the Rome and Legacy mergers. Rome and Legacy had reported 270 full time equivalent employees as of December 31, 2010. Additionally, Berkshire adjusted its staffing based on new branches and lending teams added in 2011, along with other targeted staff increases related to deepening the Company’s infrastructure. The Company's employees are not represented by a collective bargaining unit.

 

Subsidiary Activities

 

The Parent wholly owns two active consolidated subsidiaries: the Bank and Berkshire Insurance Group. The Bank is a Massachusetts chartered savings bank. One of its subsidiaries is Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank which is chartered in the state of New York. Berkshire Insurance Group is incorporated in Massachusetts.

 

21 -
 

 

The Parent also owns all of the common stock of a Delaware statutory business trust, Berkshire Hills Capital Trust I. The capital trust was organized under Delaware law to facilitate the issuance of trust preferred securities and is not consolidated into the Company’s financial results. Its only activity has been the issuance of the $15 million trust preferred security related to the junior subordinated debentures reported in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

Additional information about subsidiaries is contained in Exhibit 21 to this report.

 

Segment Reporting

 

The Company has two reportable operating segments, Banking and Insurance. Banking includes the activities of the Bank and its subsidiaries, which provide commercial and retail banking services. Insurance includes the activities of Berkshire Insurance Group, which provides commercial and consumer insurance services. The only other consolidated financial activity of the Company is that of the Company’s role as Parent of the Bank and Berkshire Insurance Group. For more information about the Company’s reportable operating segments, see the related note in the consolidated financial statements.

 

REGULATION AND SUPERVISION

 

General

 

Berkshire Hills Bancorp is a Delaware corporation and savings and loan holding company registered with the Federal Reserve Board. The Bank's deposits are insured up to applicable limits by the FDIC and by the Depositors Insurance Fund of Massachusetts for amounts in excess of the FDIC insurance limits. The Bank is subject to extensive regulation by the Massachusetts Commissioner of Banks (the “Commissioner”) as its chartering agency, and by the FDIC, as its deposit insurer. The Bank is required to file reports with the Commissioner and the FDIC concerning its activities and financial condition in addition to obtaining regulatory approvals prior to entering into certain transactions such as mergers with, or acquisitions of, other savings institutions. The Commissioner and the FDIC conduct periodic examinations to test the Bank’s safety and soundness and compliance with various regulatory requirements. As a savings and loan holding company, Berkshire Hills Bancorp is required by federal law to file reports with, and otherwise comply with the rules and regulations of, the Federal Reserve Board. The regulatory structure gives the regulatory authorities extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities and examination policies, including policies with respect to the classification of assets and the establishment of adequate loan loss reserves for regulatory purposes. Any change in such regulatory requirements and policies, whether by the Commissioner, the Massachusetts legislature, the FDIC, the Federal Reserve Board or Congress, could have a material adverse impact on Berkshire Hills Bancorp, the Bank and their operations.

 

The 2010 Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) made extensive changes in the regulation of insured depository institution.  Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”), the previous federal regulator of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, was eliminated. At the same time, responsibility for the regulation and supervision of savings and loan holding companies, such as Berkshire Hills Bancorp, was transferred to the Federal Reserve Board, which also supervises bank holding companies. The transfer took place as of July 21, 2011.

 

22 -
 

 

Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act created a new Consumer Financial Protection Bureau as an independent bureau of the Federal Reserve Board.  The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau assumed responsibility for the implementation of the federal financial consumer protection and fair lending laws and regulations, a function previously assigned to prudential regulators, and has authority to impose new requirements.  However, institutions of less than $10 billion in assets, such as the Bank, will continue to be examined for compliance with consumer protection and fair lending laws and regulations by, and be subject to the primary enforcement authority of their prudential regulator rather than the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau.  In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act directed changes in the way that institutions are assessed for deposit insurance, mandated the imposition of consolidated capital requirements on savings and loan holding companies such as Berkshire Hills Bancorp, required originators of certain securitized loans to retain a percentage of the risk for the transferred loans, stipulated regulatory rate-setting for certain debit card interchange fees, repealed restrictions on the payment of interest on commercial demand deposits and contained a number of reforms related to mortgage originations.  Many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to delayed effective dates and/or require the issuance of implementing regulations.  Their impact on operations cannot yet be fully assessed.  However, there is a significant possibility that the Dodd-Frank Act will, at a minimum, result in increased regulatory burden, compliance costs and interest expense for the Company and the Bank.

 

Certain regulatory requirements applicable to the Company, including certain changes made by the Dodd-Frank Act, are referred to below or elsewhere herein. The description of statutory provisions and regulations applicable to savings institutions and their holding companies set forth in this Form 10-K does not purport to be a complete description of such statutes and regulations and their effects on the Company and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the actual laws and regulations.

 

Massachusetts Banking Laws and Supervision

 

General. As a Massachusetts-chartered savings bank, the Bank is subject to supervision, regulation and examination by the Commissioner and to various Massachusetts statutes and regulations which govern, among other things, investment powers, lending and deposit-taking activities, borrowings, maintenance of surplus and reserve accounts, distribution of earnings and payment of dividends. In addition, the Bank is subject to Massachusetts consumer protection and civil rights laws and regulations. The approval of the Commissioner is required for a Massachusetts-chartered bank to establish or close branches, merge with other financial institutions, organize a holding company, issue stock and undertake certain other activities.

 

Massachusetts regulations generally allow Massachusetts banks to engage in activities permissible for federally chartered banks or banks chartered by another state. The Commissioner has adopted procedures reducing regulatory burdens and expense and expediting branching by well-capitalized and well-managed banks.

 

Dividends. A Massachusetts stock bank may declare cash dividends from net profits not more frequently than quarterly and non-cash dividends at any time. No dividends may be declared, credited or paid if the bank’s capital stock is impaired. The approval of the Commissioner is required if the total of all dividends declared in any calendar year exceeds the total of its net profits for that year combined with its retained net profits of the preceding two years. Net profits for this purpose means the remainder of all earnings from current operations plus actual recoveries on loans and investments and other assets after deducting from the total thereof all current operating expenses, actual losses, accrued dividends on preferred stock, if any, and all federal and state taxes.

 

Loans to One Borrower Limitations. Massachusetts banking law grants broad lending authority. However, with certain limited exceptions, total obligations of one borrower to a bank may not exceed 20.0% of the total of the bank’s capital, which is defined under Massachusetts law as the sum of the bank’s capital stock, surplus account and undivided profits.

 

Loans to a Bank’s Insiders. Massachusetts banking laws prohibit any executive officer, director or trustee from borrowing, otherwise becoming indebted, or becoming liable for a loan or other extension of credit by such bank to any other person, except for any of the following loans or extensions of credit: (i) loans or extensions of credit, secured or unsecured, to an officer of the bank in an amount not exceeding $100,000; (ii) loans or extensions of credit intended or secured for educational purposes to an officer of the bank in an amount not exceeding $200,000; (iii) loans or extensions of credit secured by a mortgage on residential real estate to be occupied in whole or in part by the officer to whom the loan or extension of credit is made, in an amount not exceeding $750,000; and (iv) loans or extensions of credit to a director or trustee of the bank who is not also an officer of the bank in an amount permissible under the bank’s loan to one borrower limit.

 

23 -
 

 

The loans listed above require approval of the majority of the members of the Bank’s Board of Directors, excluding any member involved in the loan or extension of credit. No such loan or extension of credit may be granted with an interest rate or other terms that are preferential in comparison to loans granted to persons not affiliated with the savings bank.

 

Investment Activities. In general, Massachusetts-chartered savings banks may invest in preferred and common stock of any corporation organized under the laws of the United States or any state provided such investments do not involve control of any corporation and do not, in the aggregate, exceed 4.0% of the bank’s deposits. Massachusetts-chartered savings banks may in addition invest an amount equal to 1.0% of their deposits in stocks of Massachusetts corporations or companies with substantial employment in Massachusetts which have pledged to the Commissioner that such monies will be used for further development within the Commonwealth. However, these powers are constrained by federal law.

 

Regulatory Enforcement Authority. Any Massachusetts-chartered bank that does not operate in accordance with the regulations, policies and directives of the Commissioner may be sanctioned for non-compliance, including seizure of the property and business of the bank and suspension or revocation of its charter. The Commissioner may, under certain circumstances, suspend or remove officers or directors who have violated the law, conducted the bank’s business in a manner which is unsafe, unsound or contrary to the depositors interests or been negligent in the performance of their duties. In addition, upon finding that a bank has engaged in an unfair or deceptive act or practice, the Commissioner may issue an order to cease and desist and impose a fine on the bank concerned. Finally, Massachusetts consumer protection and civil rights statutes applicable to the Bank permit private individual and class action law suits and provide for the rescission of consumer transactions, including loans, and the recovery of statutory and punitive damage and attorney’s fees in the case of certain violations of those statutes.

 

Depositors Insurance Fund. All Massachusetts-chartered savings banks are required to be members of the Depositors Insurance Fund (“DIF”), a corporation that insures savings bank deposits in excess of federal deposit insurance coverage.  The DIF is a private, industry-sponsored insurance company and is not backed by the federal government or the Commonwealth of Massachusetts.  The DIF is authorized to charge savings banks an annual assessment for its coverage. Such assessments may vary based on the risk classification assigned to the institution.

 

The combination of FDIC and DIF insurance provides customers of Massachusetts-chartered savings banks with full deposit insurance on all their deposit accounts. DIF insurance coverage requires no applications or special forms. Depositors automatically receive this added insurance benefit at no cost whenever they make a deposit to a new or existing account at a DIF member bank.  The DIF is examined annually by the Massachusetts Division of Banks and audited by an independent auditor.

 

Massachusetts has other statutes or regulations that are similar to the federal provisions discussed below.

 

Federal Regulations

 

Capital Requirements. Under FDIC regulations, federally insured state-chartered banks that are not members of the Federal Reserve System (“state non-member banks”), such as the Bank, are required to comply with minimum leverage capital requirements. For an institution determined by the FDIC to not be anticipating or experiencing significant growth and to be in general a strong banking organization, rated composite 1 under the Uniform Financial Institutions Rating System established by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council, the minimum capital leverage requirement is a ratio of Tier 1 capital to total average assets (as defined) of 3%. For all other institutions, the minimum leverage capital ratio is not less than 4%. Tier 1 capital is the sum of common stockholders’ equity, noncumulative perpetual preferred stock (including any related surplus) and minority investments in certain subsidiaries, less intangible assets (except for certain servicing rights and credit card relationships) and certain other items.

 

24 -
 

 

The Bank must also comply with the FDIC risk-based capital guidelines. The FDIC guidelines require state non-member banks to maintain certain levels of regulatory capital in relation to regulatory risk-weighted assets. Risk-based capital ratios are determined by allocating assets and specified off-balance sheet items to four risk-weighted categories ranging from 0% to 100%, with higher levels of capital being required for the categories perceived as representing greater risk.

 

State non-member banks must maintain a minimum ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 8%, of which at least one-half must be Tier 1 capital. Total capital consists of Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 or supplementary capital items, which include allowances for loan losses in an amount of up to 1.25% of risk-weighted assets, cumulative preferred stock, a portion of the net unrealized gain on equity securities and other capital instruments. The includable amount of Tier 2 capital cannot exceed the amount of the institution’s Tier 1 capital.

 

As a savings and loan holding company, the Parent is not currently subject to any separate regulatory capital requirements, although this is expected to change in the future. The Bank’s regulatory capital is included in the Stockholders’ Equity note of the Company’s financial statements in Item 8 of this report. At year-end 2011, the Bank met each of its capital requirements.

 

Interstate Banking and Branching.  Federal law permits a bank, such as the Bank, to acquire an institution by merger in a state other than Massachusetts unless the other state has opted out. Federal law, as amended by the Dodd-Frank Act, authorizes de novo branching into another state to the extent that the target state allows its state chartered banks to establish branches within its borders. The Bank operates branches in New York and Vermont, as well as Massachusetts. Following the completion of the merger with CBT, the Bank will also operate branches in Connecticut. At its interstate branches, the Bank may conduct any activity that is authorized under Massachusetts law that is permissible either for a savings bank chartered in that state (subject to applicable federal restrictions) or a branch in that state of an out-of-state national bank. The New York State Superintendent of Banks and the Vermont Commissioner of Banking and Insurance may exercise certain regulatory authority over the Bank’s New York and Vermont branches. Following the completion of the merger with CBT, the Connecticut Commissioner of Banking may exercise certain regulatory authority over the Bank’s branches.

 

Prompt Corrective Regulatory Action. Federal law requires, among other things, that federal bank regulatory authorities take “prompt corrective action” with respect to banks that do not meet minimum capital requirements. For these purposes, the law establishes three categories of capital deficient institutions: undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized.

 

An institution is deemed to be “well capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6% or greater, and a leverage ratio of 5% or greater. An institution is “adequately capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4% or greater and generally a leverage ratio of 4% or greater. An institution is “undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 8%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4%, or generally a leverage ratio of less than 4% (3% or less for institutions with the highest examination rating). An institution is deemed to be “significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 3%, or a leverage ratio of less than 3%. An institution is considered to be “critically undercapitalized” if it has a ratio of tangible equity (as defined in the regulations) to total assets that is equal to or less than 2%. At year-end 2011, the Bank met the conditions to be classified as a “well capitalized” institution.

 

25 -
 

 

“Undercapitalized” banks must adhere to growth, capital distribution (including dividend) and other limitations and are required to submit a capital restoration plan. No institution may make a capital distribution, including payment as a dividend, if it would be “undercapitalized” after the payment. A bank’s compliance with such plans is required to be guaranteed by its parent holding company in an amount equal to the lesser of 5% of the institution’s total assets when deemed undercapitalized or the amount needed to comply with regulatory capital requirements. If an “undercapitalized” bank fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is “significantly undercapitalized.” “Significantly undercapitalized” banks must comply with one or more of a number of additional restrictions, including but not limited to an order by the FDIC to sell sufficient voting stock to become adequately capitalized, requirements to reduce assets and cease receipt of deposits from correspondent banks or dismiss directors or officers, and restrictions on interest rates paid on deposits, compensation of executive officers and capital distributions by the parent holding company. “Critically undercapitalized” institutions must comply with additional sanctions including, subject to a narrow exception, the appointment of a receiver or conservator within 270 days after it obtains such status.

 

Transactions with Affiliates. Transactions between depository institutions and their affiliates are governed by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act. In a holding company context, at a minimum, the parent holding company of a savings bank and any companies which are controlled by such parent holding company are affiliates of the savings bank. Generally, Section 23A limits the extent to which the savings bank or its subsidiaries may engage in “covered transactions,” such as loans, with any one affiliate to 10% of such savings bank’s capital stock and surplus, and contains an aggregate limit on all such transactions with all affiliates to 20% of capital stock and surplus. Loans to affiliates and certain other specified transactions must comply with specified collateralization requirements. Section 23B requires that transactions with affiliates be on terms that are no less favorable to the savings bank or its subsidiary as similar transactions with non-affiliates.

 

Further, federal law restricts an institution with respect to loans to directors, executive officers, and principal stockholders (“insiders”). Loans to insiders and their related interests may not exceed, together with all other outstanding loans to such persons and affiliated entities, the institution’s total capital and surplus. Loans to insiders above specified amounts must receive the prior approval of the board of directors. Further, loans to insiders must be made on terms substantially the same as offered in comparable transactions to other persons, except that such insiders may receive preferential loans made under a benefit or compensation program that is widely available to the Bank’s employees and does not give preference to the insider over the employees. Federal law places additional limitations on loans to executive officers.

 

Enforcement. The FDIC has extensive enforcement authority over insured savings banks, including the Bank. This enforcement authority includes, among other things, the ability to assess civil money penalties, issue cease and desist orders and to remove directors and officers. In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated in response to violations of laws and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices. The FDIC has authority under federal law to appoint a conservator or receiver for an insured bank under certain circumstances.

 

Insurance of Deposit Accounts. The Bank’s deposit accounts are insured by the Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC up to applicable legal limits, and, as discussed above under “Massachusetts Banking Laws and Supervision—Depositors Insurance Fund”, by the Massachusetts Depositors Insurance Fund for amounts in excess of federal deposit insurance coverage.

 

26 -
 

 

The FDIC insures deposits up to the standard maximum deposit insurance amount (“SMDIA”) of $250 thousand. The deposit insurance limit was increased in response to the Dodd-Frank Act, which, among other provisions, made permanent the increase in the SMDIA from $100 thousand to $250 thousand. Additionally, in November 2010, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC issued a final rule to provide separate temporary coverage for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts. The final rule indicates that all funds held in noninterest-bearing transaction accounts are fully insured, without limit, and that this unlimited coverage is separate from, and in addition to, the coverage provided to depositors with respect to other accounts held at an insured depository institution, such as the Bank.  This provision for non-interest bearing transaction accounts became effective December 31, 2010 and terminates on December 31, 2012.

 

The FDIC has adopted a risk-based insurance assessment system. The FDIC assigns an institution to one of four risk categories based on the institution’s financial condition and supervisory ratings. An institution’s assessment rate depends on the capital category and supervisory category to which it is assigned, based on a final rule which becomes effective April 1, 2011.  Under the final rule, banks in Risk Category 1 have a base assessment rate of 5-9 basis points and those in Risk Category 2 have a rate of 14 basis points, subject to adjustment based on certain risk additional risk factors specified by the FDIC.  The overall range, including prospective adjustments, is 2.5 to 45 basis points.  Assessment rates are scheduled to decline as the FDIC Reserve Ratio improves.  As required by the Dodd-Frank Act, FDIC assessments are now based on each institution’s total assets less tier 1 capital, rather than deposits, as was previously the case. The FDIC has stated that nearly all of the 7,600-plus institutions with assets less than $10 billion will pay smaller assessments as a result of this final rule.

 

In the fourth quarter of 2009, due to stress on the insurance fund, the FDIC voted to require insured institutions to prepay thirteen quarters of estimated insurance assessments. The estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011, and 2012 were paid by the Bank on December 30, 2009.

 

In addition, FDIC insured institutions are required to pay assessments to the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation to fund interest payments on bonds issued by the Financing Corporation, an agency of the federal government established to recapitalize a predecessor to deposit insurance fund. These assessments will continue until the Financing Corporation bonds mature in 2017 through 2019. The assessment rate is adjusted quarterly to reflect changes in the assessment bases of the fund based on quarterly Call Report and Thrift Financial Report submissions and for the quarter ended December 21, 2011 amounted to .68 basis point of total assets less tier 1 capital.

 

Insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by a regulator. Management does not know of any practice, condition or violation that might lead to termination of deposit insurance.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act increased the minimum target DIF ratio from 1.15% of estimated insured deposits to 1.35% of estimated insured deposits.  The FDIC must seek to achieve the 1.35% ratio by September 30, 2020.  Insured institutions with assets of $10 billion or more are supposed to fund the increase.  The Dodd-Frank Act eliminated the 1.50% maximum fund ratio, instead leaving it to the discretion of the FDIC.  The FDIC has recently exercised that discretion by establishing a long range fund ratio of 2.00%.

 

The FDIC has authority to increase insurance assessments.  A significant increase in insurance premiums would likely have an adverse effect on the operating expenses and results of operations of the Bank.  Management cannot predict what insurance assessment rates will be in the future.

 

Federal Home Loan Bank System. The Bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank system, which consists of 12 regional Federal Home Loan Banks that provide a central credit facility primarily for member institutions. The Bank, as a member, is required to acquire and hold shares of capital stock in the FHLBB.

 

27 -
 

 

The Federal Home Loan Banks are required to provide funds for certain purposes including contributing funds for affordable housing programs. These requirements, and general financial results, could reduce the amount of dividends that the Federal Home Loan Banks pay to their members and result in the Federal Home Loan Banks imposing a higher rate of interest on advances to their members. Historically, the FHLBB paid dividends to member banks based on money market interest rates. Due to losses initially reported in the fourth quarter of 2008, the FHLBB suspended its dividend to members in the first quarter of 2009.  The dividend remained suspended through year-end 2010, but was recently restored to a nominal amount in the first quarter of 2011 and subsequent quarters.

 

Holding Company Regulation

 

General. Federal law allows a state savings bank that qualifies as a “Qualified Thrift Lender,” discussed below, to elect to be treated as a savings association for purposes of the savings and loan holding company provisions of federal law. Such election allows its holding company to be regulated as a savings and loan holding company by the Federal Reserve Board rather than as a bank holding company by the Federal Reserve Board under the federal Bank Holding Company Act. As such, the Parent is registered with the Federal Reserve Board and must adhere to the Federal Reserve Board’s regulations and reporting requirements. In addition, the FRB may examine, supervise and take enforcement action against the Parent and its non-savings institution subsidiaries. Among other things, this authority permits the Federal Reserve Board to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to be a serious risk to the subsidiary savings institution. By regulation, the Federal Reserve Board may restrict or prohibit the Bank from paying dividends.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act provides for the elimination of the OTS and transferred its authority over and responsibilities for savings and loan holding companies to the Federal Reserve Board.  That transfer was effective July 21, 2011.

 

As a unitary savings and loan holding company, Berkshire Hills Bancorp is generally unrestricted under existing laws as to the types of business activities in which it may engage. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 provided that unitary savings and loan holding companies may only engage in activities permitted to a financial holding company under that legislation and those permitted for multiple savings and loan holding companies. Unitary savings and loan companies existing prior to May 4, 1999 were grandfathered as to the unrestricted activities. The Company would become subject to activities restrictions upon the acquisition of another savings institution that is held as a separate subsidiary.

 

Federal law prohibits a savings and loan holding company from, directly or indirectly, acquiring more than 5% of the voting stock of another savings association or savings and loan holding company or from acquiring such an institution or company by merger, consolidation or purchase of its assets, without prior written approval of the Federal Reserve Board. In evaluating applications by holding companies to acquire savings associations, the Federal Reserve Board considers factors such as the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the Company and the institution involved, the effect of the acquisition on the risk to the insurance fund, the convenience and needs of the community and competitive factors.

 

To be regulated as a savings and loan holding company (rather than as a bank holding company), the bank must qualify as a Qualified Thrift Lender. To qualify as a Qualified Thrift Lender, the bank must maintain compliance with the test for a “domestic building and loan association,” as defined in the Internal Revenue Code, or with a Qualified Thrift Lender Test. Under the Qualified Thrift Lender Test (the “QLT Test”), a savings institution is required to maintain at least 65% of its “portfolio assets” (total assets less: (1) specified liquid assets up to 20% of total assets; (2) intangibles, including goodwill; and (3) the value of property used to conduct business) in certain “qualified thrift investments” (primarily residential mortgages and related investments, including certain mortgage-backed securities) in at least 9 months out of each 12-month period. At year-end 2011, the Bank maintained at least 65% of its portfolio assets in qualified thrift investments and met the QTL Test for the year.

 

28 -
 

 

Unlike bank holding companies, savings and loan holding companies are not currently subject to specific regulatory capital requirements.  The Dodd-Frank Act, however, requires the Federal Reserve Board to promulgate consolidated capital requirements for depository institution holding companies that are no less stringent, both quantitatively and in terms of components of capital, than those applicable to institutions themselves.  That will eliminate the inclusion of certain instruments from Tier 1 capital, such as trust preferred securities, that are currently includable for bank holding companies.  Instruments issued before May 19, 2010 by companies of less than $15 billion in assets (as of December 31, 2009) are grandfathered.  There is a five year transition period from the July 21, 2010 date of enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act before the capital requirements are expected to apply to savings and loan holding companies.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act also extends the “source of strength” doctrine to savings and loan holding companies.  The regulatory agencies must promulgate regulations implementing the “source of strength” policy, which requires holding companies to act as a source of strength to their subsidiary depository institutions by providing capital, liquidity and other support in times of financial distress. Further, the Federal Reserve Board has issued a policy statement regarding the payment of dividends by bank holding companies that it has suggested is applicable to savings and loan holding companies as well. In general, the policy provides that dividends should be paid only out of current earnings and if the prospective rate of earnings retention by the holding company appears consistent with the organization’s capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition. Regulatory guidance provides for prior regulatory review of capital distributions in certain circumstances such as where the company’s net income for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid over that period, is insufficient to fully fund the dividend or the company’s overall rate of earnings retention is inconsistent with the company’s capital needs and overall financial condition. The ability of a savings and loan holding company to pay dividends may be restricted if a subsidiary bank becomes undercapitalized. These regulatory policies could affect the ability of Berkshire Hills Bancorp to pay dividends or otherwise engage in capital distributions.

 

Acquisition of the Company. Under the Federal Change in Bank Control Act, a notice must be submitted to the Federal Reserve Board if any person (including a company), or group acting in concert, seeks to acquire “control” of a savings and loan holding company. A change in control may occur, and prior notice is required, upon the acquisition of 10% or more of the Company’s outstanding voting stock, unless the Federal Reserve Board has found that the acquisition will not result in a change of control of the Company.

 

Massachusetts Holding Company Regulation. In addition to the federal holding company regulations, a bank holding company organized or doing business in Massachusetts must comply with regulations under Massachusetts law. Approval of the Massachusetts regulatory authorities would be required for the Company to acquire 25% or more of the voting stock of another depository institution. Similarly, prior regulatory approval would be necessary for any person or company to acquire 25% or more of the voting stock of the Company. The term “bank holding company,” for the purpose of Massachusetts law, is defined generally to include any company which, directly or indirectly, owns, controls or holds with power to vote more than 25% of the voting stock of each of two or more banking institutions, including commercial banks and state co-operative banks, savings banks and savings and loan association and national banks, federal savings banks and federal savings and loan associations. In general, a holding company controlling, directly or indirectly, only one banking institution will not be deemed to be a bank holding company for the purposes of Massachusetts law. Under Massachusetts law, the prior approval of the Board of Bank Incorporation is required before any of the following: any company becoming a bank holding company; any bank holding company acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting stock of, or all or substantially all of the assets of, a banking institution; or any bank holding company merging with another bank holding company. Although Berkshire Hills Bancorp is not a bank holding company for purposes of Massachusetts law, any future acquisition of ownership, control, or the power to vote 25% or more of the voting stock of another banking institution or bank holding company would cause it to become such.

 

29 -
 

 

Legislation. The U.S. Congress, state lawmaking bodies and federal and state regulatory agencies continue to consider a number of wide-ranging and comprehensive proposals for altering the structure, regulation and competitive relationships of the nation’s financial institutions. In addition, both the U.S. Treasury Department and the Basel Committee have issued policy statements regarding proposed significant changes to the regulatory capital framework applicable to banking organizations as discussed above. The Company cannot predict whether or in what form further legislation or regulations may be adopted or the extent to which the Company may be affected thereby.

 

Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank

 

Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank is a state-chartered limited purpose commercial bank in New York, established to accept deposits of municipalities and other governmental entities in the State of New York. Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank is subject to extensive regulation, examination and supervision by the New York State Superintendent of Banks, as its primary regulator, and the FDIC, as the deposit insurer. It is also subject to regulation as to certain matters by the Federal Reserve Board.  As of year-end 2011, Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank met all of its capital requirements and met the capital conditions to be classified as a “well capitalized” institution.

 

Other Regulations

 

Consumer Protection Laws. The Bank is subject to federal and state consumer protection statues and regulations including, but not limited to, the:

 

£Truth-In-Lending Act, governing disclosures of credit terms to consumer borrowers;
   
£Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, requiring financial institutions to provide certain information about home mortgage and refinance loans;
   
£Equal Credit Opportunity Act, prohibiting discrimination on the basis of race, creed or other prohibited factors in extending credit;
   
£Fair Credit Reporting Act, governing the provision of consumer information to credit reporting agencies and the use of consumer information;
   
£Fair Debt Collection Act, governing the manner in which consumer debts may be collected by collection agencies; and
   
£Electronic Funds Transfer Act, governing automatic deposits to and withdrawals from deposit accounts and customers’ rights and liabilities arising from the use of automated teller machines and other electronic banking services.

 

The Bank also is subject to federal laws protecting the confidentiality of consumer financial records, and limiting the ability of the institution to share non-public personal information with third parties.

 

30 -
 

 

The Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) establishes a requirement for federal banking agencies that, in connection with examinations of financial institutions within their jurisdiction, the agencies evaluate the record of the financial institutions in meeting the credit needs of their local communities, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with the safe and sound operation of those institutions. These factors are also considered in evaluating mergers, acquisitions and applications to open a branch or new facility.  Under the CRA, institutions are assigned a rating of "outstanding," "satisfactory," "needs to improve," or "substantial non-compliance."  A less than “satisfactory” rating would result in the suspension of any growth of the Bank through acquisitions or opening de novo branches until the rating is improved. As of the most recent CRA examination by the FDIC, the Bank’s CRA rating was “satisfactory.”

 

Anti-Money Laundering Laws. The Bank is subject to extensive anti-money laundering provisions and requirements, which require the institution to have in place a comprehensive customer identification program and an anti-money laundering program and procedures. These laws and regulations also prohibit financial institutions from engaging in business with foreign shell banks; require financial institutions to have due diligence procedures and, in some cases, enhanced due diligence procedures for foreign correspondent and private banking accounts; and improve information sharing between financial institutions and the U.S. government. The Bank has established policies and procedures intended to comply with these provisions.

 

TAXATION

 

The Company reports its income on a calendar year basis using the accrual method of accounting.  This discussion of tax matters is only a summary and is not a comprehensive description of the tax rules applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries.  Further discussion of income taxation is contained in the income taxes note to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Federal

 

The federal income tax laws apply to the Company in the same manner as do other corporations with some exceptions.  We may exclude from income 100% of dividends received from the Bank and from Berkshire Insurance Group as members of the same affiliated group of corporations.   For federal income tax purposes, we may carry back net operating losses to the preceding two taxable years and forward to the succeeding twenty taxable years, subject to certain limitations.

 

State

 

The Company reports income on a calendar year basis to the Commonwealth of Massachusetts.  The Massachusetts income tax rate for financial institutions was 9.5% in 2011 and is scheduled to decline to 9% in 2012 and thereafter. The Company’s taxable income under Massachusetts tax law includes gross income as defined under the Internal Revenue Code, plus interest from non-Massachusetts municipal obligations, less deductions, but not the credits, allowable under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code. Carry forwards and carry backs of net operating losses are not allowed under Massachusetts tax law.  Also no deduction is allowed for bonus depreciation or state income taxes paid.

 

Massachusetts tax law generally permits special tax treatment for a qualifying limited purpose “securities corporation.” The Bank’s three securities corporations all qualify for this treatment, and are taxed at a 1.3% rate on their gross income.

 

- 31 -
 

 

The Company also pays certain franchise taxes annually in the states of Vermont and New York.  These taxes were immaterial to the Company’s results.

 

ITEM 1a. Risk Factors

 

Overall Business Risks

 

The Company’s Business May Be Adversely Affected by Conditions in the Financial Markets and Economic Conditions Generally and Locally

 

From December 2007 through June 2009, the U.S. economy was in recession. Business activity across a wide range of industries and regions in the U.S. was greatly reduced. Although economic conditions improved, certain sectors, such as real estate, remain weak and unemployment remains high. U.S. fiscal and monetary policy have been stimulative, but the policy outlook remains uncertain amidst concerns about public debt levels and financial market conditions. International developments relating to European sovereign debt, in the Middle East, and elsewhere are affecting financial markets and oil and commodities prices, which may have a negative economic impact. Local governments and many businesses are in serious difficulty due to lower consumer spending and the lack of liquidity in the credit markets. A deterioration of business and economic conditions could adversely affect the credit quality of the Company’s loans, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Lending

 

Continued and Prolonged Deterioration in the Housing Sector, Commercial Real Estate, and Related Markets May Adversely Affect Our Business and Financial Results.

 

Softening residential housing markets, increasing delinquency and default rates and constrained secondary credit markets have been affecting the mortgage industry generally. Commercial and residential real estate markets have been impacted by the broader economic conditions previously discussed. Real estate lending is a major business activity for the Company. Real estate market conditions affect the value and marketability of this real estate collateral, and they also affect the cash flows, liquidity, and net worth of many borrowers whose operations and finances depend on real estate market conditions. Adverse conditions in our market areas could reduce our growth rate, affect the ability of our customers to repay their loans and generally affect our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our Emphasis on Commercial Lending May Expose Us to Increased Lending Risks, Which Could Hurt Our Profits.

 

We plan to continue to emphasize the origination of commercial loans, which generally exposes us to a greater risk of nonpayment and loss because repayment of such loans often depends on the successful operations and income stream of the borrowers. Commercial loans are historically more sensitive to economic downturns. Such sensitivity includes potentially higher default rates and possible reduction of collateral values. Commercial lending involves larger loan sizes and larger relationship exposures, which can have a greater impact on profits in the event of adverse loan performance. The majority of the Company’s commercial mortgages are secured by real estate and are subject to the previously discussed real estate risk factors. Commercial lending sometimes involves construction or other development financing, which is dependent on the future success of new operations. The Company’s commercial lending activities extend beyond the area of its traditional branch footprint, which is the area of which the Company has the most knowledge. The Company’s commercial lending includes asset based lending, which depends on the Company’s processes for monitoring and being able to liquidate collateral on which these loans rely. Commercial loans may increase as a percentage of total loans, and commercial lending may continue to expose the company to increased risks.

 

- 32 -
 

 

Our Allowance for Loan Losses May Prove to be Insufficient to Absorb Losses in Our Loan Portfolio.

 

Like all financial institutions, we maintain an allowance for loan losses which is our estimate of the probable losses that are inherent in the loan portfolio as of the financial statement date. However, our allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover actual loan losses, and future provisions for loan losses could materially and adversely affect our operating results. The accounting measurements related to impairment and the loan loss allowance require significant estimates which are subject to uncertainty and changes relating to new information and changing circumstances. Additionally, the allowance can only reflect those losses which are reasonably estimable, and there are constraints in our ability to estimate losses in this period of unusual economic and financial stress. This is particularly relevant for our estimates of losses for pools of loans. Accordingly, at any time, there may be probable losses inherent in the portfolio but which we are not reasonably able to estimate until additional information emerges which can form the basis for a reasonable estimate.

 

State and federal regulators, as an integral part of their examination process, periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require us to increase our allowance for loan losses by recognizing additional provisions for loan losses charged to expense, or to decrease our allowance for loan losses by recognizing loan charge-offs, net of recoveries. Any such additional provisions for loan losses or charge-offs, as required by these regulatory agencies, could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our Estimates of Discounts on Acquired Loans With Deteriorated Credit Quality May Be Insufficient

 

Under generally accepted principles for business combinations, there is no loan loss allowance recorded for acquired loans, which are recorded at net fair value on the acquisition date. This net fair value generally includes embedded loss estimates for acquired loans with deteriorated credit quality. These estimates are based on projections of expected cash flows for these problem loans. If the projections are incorrect, the fair value estimates may exceed the actual collectability of the balances, and this may result in the related loans being considered impaired.

 

Operating

 

Our Expansion, Growth, and Acquisitions Could Negatively Impact Earnings If Not Successful.

 

We plan to achieve significant growth organically, by geographic expansion, through business line expansion, and through acquisitions. We have recently expanded into new geographic markets and anticipate that we will continue to expand into additional geographic markets as we grow as a regional bank. The success of this expansion depends on our ability to continue to maintain and develop an infrastructure appropriate to support and integrate such growth. Also, our success depends on the acceptance by customers of us and our services in these new markets and, in the case of expansion through acquisitions, our success depends on many factors, including the long-term recruitment and retention of key personnel and acquired customer relationships. The profitability of our expansion strategy also depends on whether the income we generate in the new markets will offset the increased expenses of operating a larger entity with increased personnel, more branch locations and additional product offerings.

 

- 33 -
 

 

We continue to identify and evaluate opportunities to expand through acquisition of banks, insurance agencies, and wealth management firms. Some of these opportunities could result in further geographic expansion. Merger and acquisition activities are subject to a number of risks, including lending, operating, and integration risks. Growth through acquisition requires careful due diligence, evaluation of risks, and projections of future operations and financial conditions. Actual results may differ from our expectations and could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Growth through acquisition also often involves the negotiation and execution of extensive merger agreements. Such agreements may give rise to litigation, or constrain us in certain ways, or expose us to other risks beyond our normal operating risks. 

 

The Company’s recruitment of new executive and commercial lending management has in several cases brought in new management from larger institutions. These individuals have often served larger customers than the Company has historically serviced, and they have had the benefit of larger capital and administrative resources than are present in the Company’s current structure. The success of this recruitment may depend on the successful integration of these individuals into the Company and may expose the Company to lending and operating losses related to large new customers in newer markets. The Company’s commercial banking strategy has particularly focused on taking market share from larger national institutions and in many cases these new accounts are larger than the Company’s historic accounts. Additionally, the Company’s ability to service these accounts may in some cases involve arranging loan participations and syndications. These activities can expose the Company to additional lending, administrative, and liquidity risks. The Company also actively recruits in other business lines, including private banking and wealth management. This activity can give the Company additional access to large customers in its markets in order to expand our business. Such recruitment can affect the retention of new and old business, and can also be affected by competitive reactions and other relationship risks in retaining accounts.

 

Competition From Financial Institutions and Other Financial Service Providers May Adversely Affect Our Growth and Profitability.

 

Competition in the banking and financial services industry is intense. We compete with commercial banks, savings institutions, mortgage brokerage firms, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, and brokerage and investment banking firms operating locally and elsewhere. Larger banking institutions have substantially greater resources and lending limits and may offer certain services that we do not. Local competitors with excess capital may accept lower returns on new business. There is increased competition by out-of-market competitors through the internet. Federal regulations and financial support programs may in some cases favor competitors or place us at an economic disadvantage. Our profitability depends on our continued ability to successfully compete and grow profitably in our market areas.

 

- 34 -
 

 

We are Subject to Security and Operational Risks Relating to Our Use of Technology that Could Damage Our Reputation and Our Business.

 

Security breaches in our internet banking activities could expose us to possible liability and damage our reputation. Any compromise of our security also could deter customers from using our internet banking services that involve the transmission of confidential information. We rely on industry standard internet security systems to provide the security and authentication necessary to effect secure transmission of data. These precautions may not protect our systems from compromises or breaches of our security measures that could result in damage to our reputation and our business. We utilize third party core banking software and for some systems we outsource our data processing to a third party. If our third party providers encounter difficulties or if we have difficulty in communicating with such third parties, it could significantly affect our ability to adequately process and account for customer transactions, which could significantly affect our business operations. We utilize file encryption in designated internal systems and networks and are subject to certain state and federal regulations regarding how we manage the security of the data that we are responsible for. Disaster and disaster recovery risks could affect our ability to operate and our reputation.

 

Financial and Operating Counterparties Expose Us to Risks.

 

We have increased our use of derivative financial instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, which expose us to financial and contractual risks with counterparty banks. We maintain correspondent bank relationships, manage certain loan participations, engage in securities transactions, and engage in other activities with financial counterparties that are customary to our industry. We also utilize services from major vendors of technology, telecommunications, and other essential operating services. There is financial and operating risk in these relationships, which we seek to manage through internal controls and procedures, but there is no assurance that we could not experience loss or interruption of our business as a result of unforeseen events with these providers.

 

We May Not Be Able to Attract and Retain Skilled People.

 

Our success depends, in large part, on our ability to attract new employees, retain and motivate our existing employees, and continue to compensate employees competitively amid intense public and regulatory scrutiny on the compensation practices of financial institutions. Competition for the best people in most activities engaged in by us can be intense and we may not be able to hire these people or to retain them.

 

Our Controls and Procedures May Fail or Be Circumvented.

 

Management regularly reviews and updates the Company’s internal controls, disclosure controls and procedures, and corporate governance policies and procedures. Any system of controls, however well designed and operated, is based in part on certain assumptions and can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of the controls and procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

New Mortgage Lending Operations In Eastern Massachusetts May Expose Us to New Operating Risks.

 

Subsequent to year-end 2011, the Bank entered into an agreement to acquire the business assets of an established residential mortgage origination company in Eastern Massachusetts. This acquisition is expected to be completed in the second quarter of 2012. Under the agreement the Bank expects to employ the former employees of this company and to utilize its business name and operating procedures to originate residential mortgages in Eastern Massachusetts as well as in other Massachusetts and surrounding markets. The anticipated volume of mortgage originations is expected to exceed the Bank’s existing mortgage originations volume, and involves lending in a new market area with new staff and new processes. It is expected that most mortgage originations will be sold on a servicing released basis to secondary market investors. The Bank plans to implement an oversight/review process as these new operations are commenced in order to assimilate them into the Bank’s risk management program, however the conduct of these new activities may initially expose the Bank to the risk of loan losses, losses related to interest rate risk management, litigation, and other risks common in mortgage banking operations.

 

- 35 -
 

 

The Planned Core Bank Processing System Conversion Exposes Us to Operating and Financial Risks.

 

The Bank has contracted to convert its core bank processing system to a new system and a new vendor in 2012. This system will also be changed from primarily an “in-house” system run on the Bank’s own computers to one that is primarily a “service bureau” solution running on the provider’s computers and relying on long distance telecommunications. Core systems conversions involve extensive planning and operational changes which may affect bank account records, customer service delivery, internal procedures, technology risk management, and other significant operating activities. The conversion from one vendor to another can involve conversion costs and creates the risk of contract and performance disputer. Negotiations are ongoing with these vendors relating to contract matters. The planned changes expose the Bank to new risks with new systems and new vendors. The Bank is working closely with third parties to manage the related operating and financial risks.

 

Liquidity

 

Our Wholesale Funding Sources May Prove Insufficient to Replace Deposits at Maturity and Support Our Operations and Future Growth.

 

We must maintain sufficient funds to respond to the needs of depositors and borrowers. As a part of our liquidity management, we use a number of funding sources in addition to core deposit growth and repayments and maturities of loans and investments. These sources include Federal Home Loan Bank advances, proceeds from the sale of loans, and liquidity resources at the holding company. Our financial flexibility will be severely constrained if we are unable to maintain our access to funding or if adequate financing is not available to accommodate future growth at acceptable costs. Finally, if we are required to rely more heavily on more expensive funding sources to support future growth, our revenues may not increase proportionately to cover our costs. In this case, our operating margins and profitability would be adversely affected. Turbulence in the capital and credit markets may adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition and the willingness of certain counterparties and customers to do business with us.

 

Our Ability to Service Our Debt, Pay Dividends and Otherwise Pay Our Obligations as They Come Due Is Substantially Dependent on Capital Distributions from the Bank, and These Distributions Are Subject to Regulatory Limits and Other Restrictions.

 

A substantial source of our holding company income is the receipt of dividends from the Bank, from which we service our debt, pay our obligations, and pay shareholder dividends. The availability of dividends from the Bank is limited by various statutes and regulations. It is possible, depending upon the financial condition of the Bank and other factors, that the applicable regulatory authorities could assert that payment of dividends or other payments is an unsafe or unsound practice. If the Bank is unable to pay dividends to us, we may not be able to service our debt, pay our obligations or pay dividends on our common stock. The inability to receive dividends from the Bank would adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

- 36 -
 

 

Interest Rates

 

Changes in Interest Rates Could Adversely Affect Our Results of Operations and Financial Condition.

 

Net interest income is our largest source of income. Changes in interest rates can affect the level of net interest income. The Company’s interest rate sensitivity is discussed in more detail in Item 7A of this report. We principally manage interest rate risk by managing our volume and mix of our earning assets and funding liabilities. In a changing interest rate environment, we may not be able to manage this risk effectively. If we are unable to manage interest rate risk effectively, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially harmed. Changes in interest rates can also affect the demand for our products and services, and the supply conditions in the U.S. financial and capital markets. Changes in the level of interest rates may negatively affect our ability to originate real estate loans, the value of our assets and our ability to realize gains from the sale of our assets, all of which ultimately affect our earnings.

 

Securities Market Values

 

Declines in the Value of Certain Investment Securities Could Require Write-Downs, Which Would Reduce Our Earnings.

 

Unrealized losses on investment securities result from changes in credit spreads and liquidity issues in the marketplace, along with changes in the credit profile of individual securities issuers. We have concluded that, as of year-end 2011, any unrealized losses are temporary in nature, and we have the intent and ability to hold these investments for a time necessary to recover our cost or stated maturity (at which time, full payment is expected). However, a continued decline in the value of these securities or other factors could result in an other-than-temporary impairment write-down which would reduce our earnings. Some of the Company’s securities are locally originated economic development bonds. These securities could become impaired due to economic and real estate market conditions which also affect loan risk. We have an investment in the stock of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston, which recently reinstituted a modest dividend after a period when the dividend was suspended. If the capitalization of a Federal Home Loan Bank, including the FHLBB, became substantially diminished it could result in a write-down which would reduce our earnings.

 

Regulatory

 

Legislative and Regulatory Initiatives.

 

The potential exists for additional federal or state laws and regulations regarding lending, funding practices, capital, and liquidity standards. Bank regulatory agencies are expected to be more active in responding to concerns and trends identified in examinations, including the expected issuance of many formal enforcement orders. In addition, new laws, regulations, and other regulatory changes may also increase our costs of regulatory compliance and of doing business, and otherwise affect our operations. The FDIC sets the cost of our FDIC insurance premiums, which can affect our profitability.

 

We are required by federal and state regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support our operations. Regulatory capital requirements and their impact on the Company may change. We may need to raise additional capital in the future to support our operations and continued growth. Our ability to raise capital, if needed, will depend on conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside of our control, and on our financial performance. If we cannot raise additional capital when needed, it could affect our operations and our ability to execute our strategic plan, which includes further expanding our operations through internal growth and acquisitions.

 

- 37 -
 

 

The Dodd-Frank Act made extensive changes in the regulation of insured depository institution. In addition to eliminating the OTS and creating the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, the Dodd-Frank Act, among other things, directs changes in the way that institutions are assessed for deposit insurance, mandates the imposition of consolidated capital requirements on savings and loan holding companies, requires originators of certain securitized loans to retain a percentage of the risk for the transferred loans, stipulates regulatory rate-setting for certain debit card interchange fees, repeals restrictions on the payment of interest on commercial demand deposits and contains a number of reforms related to mortgage originations. Many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to delayed effective dates and/or require the issuance of implementing regulations. Their impact on operations cannot yet be fully assessed. However, there is a significant possibility that the Dodd-Frank Act will, at a minimum, result in increased regulatory burden, compliance costs and interest expense for the Company. 

 

New laws, regulations, and other regulatory changes, along with negative developments in the financial industry and the domestic and international credit markets, may significantly affect the markets in which we do business, the markets for and value of our loans and investments, and our ongoing operations, costs and profitability. For more information, see “Regulation and Supervision” in Item 1 of this report.

 

Provisions of Our Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws and Delaware Law, as Well as State and Federal Banking Regulations, Could Delay or Prevent a Takeover of Us by a Third Party.

 

Provisions in our certificate of incorporation and bylaws, the corporate law of the State of Delaware, and state and federal regulations could delay, defer or prevent a third party from acquiring us, despite the possible benefit to our stockholders, or otherwise adversely affect the price of our common stock. These provisions include: limitations on voting rights of beneficial owners of more than 10% of our common stock, supermajority voting requirements for certain business combinations; the election of directors to staggered terms of three years; and advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our Board of Directors and for proposing matters that stockholders may act on at stockholder meetings. In addition, we are subject to Delaware laws, including one that prohibits us from engaging in a business combination with any interested stockholder for a period of three years from the date the person became an interested stockholder unless certain conditions are met. These provisions may discourage potential takeover attempts, discourage bids for our common stock at a premium over market price or adversely affect the market price of, and the voting and other rights of the holders of, our common stock. These provisions could also discourage proxy contests and make it more difficult for you and other stockholders to elect directors other than the candidates nominated by our Board.

 

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

 

Our Acquisitions Have Resulted in Significant Goodwill, Which if it Becomes Impaired Would be Required to be Written Down, Resulting in a Negative Impact on Earnings.

 

The initial recording and subsequent impairment testing of goodwill and other intangible assets requires subjective judgments about the estimates of the fair value of assets acquired. Factors that may significantly affect the estimates include specific industry or market sector conditions, changes in revenue growth trends, customer behavior, competitive forces, cost structures and changes in discount rates. It is possible that future impairment testing could result in an impairment of the value of goodwill or intangible assets, or both. If we determine impairment exists at a given point in time, our earnings and the book value of the related intangible asset(s) will be reduced by the amount of the impairment. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the results of impairment testing on goodwill and core deposit intangible assets have no impact on our tangible book value or regulatory capital levels. These are non-GAAP financial measures. They are not a substitute for GAAP measures and should only be considered in conjunction with the Company’s GAAP financial information.

 

- 38 -
 

 

Trading

 

The Trading History of Our Common stock is Characterized by Low Trading Volume. The Value of Your Investment May be Subject to Sudden Decreases Due to the Volatility of the Price of our Common Stock.

 

Our common stock trades on the NASDAQ Global Select Market. The level of interest and trading in our stock depends on many factors beyond our control. The market price of our common stock may be highly volatile and subject to wide fluctuations in response to numerous factors, including, but not limited to, the factors discussed in other risk factors and the following actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results; changes in interest rates; changes in the legal or regulatory environment in which we operate; press releases, announcements or publicity relating to us or our competitors or relating to trends in our industry; changes in expectations as to our future financial performance, including financial estimates or recommendations by securities analysts and investors; future sales of our common stock; changes in economic conditions in our marketplace, general conditions in the U.S. economy, financial markets or the banking industry; and other developments affecting our competitors or us. These factors may adversely affect the trading price of our common stock, regardless of our actual operating performance, and could prevent our stockholders from selling their common stock at a desirable price.

 

In the past, stockholders have brought securities class action litigation against a company following periods of volatility in the market price of their securities. We could be the target of similar litigation in the future, which could result in substantial costs and divert management’s attention and resources.

 

Pending Merger

 

Failure to Complete the Pending Merger with The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company Could Negatively Impact Our Stock Price and Future Business and Financial Results.

 

If this merger is not completed, our ongoing business may be adversely affected. In addition, we may experience negative reactions from the financial markets and from customers and employees. We also could be subject to litigation related to any failure to complete the merger or to enforcement proceedings commenced against us to perform certain obligations under the merger agreement. If the merger is not completed, we cannot assure our stockholders that the risks described above will not materialize and will not materially affect our business, financial results and stock price. Litigation may prevent the merger from being completed or from being completed within the expected timeframe. Please see Item 3 regarding legal proceedings. One of the conditions to the closing of the merger is that no order, decree or injunction issued by a governmental entity that prohibits the completion of the merger shall be in effect. As such, if the plaintiffs are successful in obtaining an injunction prohibiting the completion of the merger on the agreed-upon terms, then such injunction may prevent the merger from being completed, or from being completed within the expected timeframe.

 

Item 1b. Unresolved staff comments

 

None.

 

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

 

The Company’s headquarters are located in owned and leased facilities located in Pittsfield, Massachusetts. The Company also owns or leases other facilities within its primary market areas: Berkshire County, Massachusetts; Pioneer Valley (Springfield area), Massachusetts; Southern Vermont, the Capital Region, and Northeastern New York. The Company has 60 full-service banking offices. The Company’s Asset Based Lending Group operates from a leased facility in Woburn, Massachusetts and its new Central/Eastern Massachusetts Commercial Banking Team operates from a leased facility in Westborough, Massachusetts.

 

- 39 -
 

 

During 2011, the Berkshire acquired Rome Bancorp and Legacy Bancorp, which significantly expanded its owned and leased facilities. Pittsfield has been the headquarters location of both Berkshire and Legacy, and as a result of the merger the Company has significant headquarters facilities in Pittsfield. The Company expects to have excess facilities in this location as a result of merger related operational integrations, and the Company expects to discontinue the use of some headquarters facilities over time to eliminate this excess. Berkshire also utilizes former headquarters facilities in other locations and may identify and reduce excess facilities capacity over time. Additionally, as part of its integrations, the Company is in the process of adjusting its branch configuration. The Company divested four Legacy Berkshire County branches in 2011 in accordance with its merger agreement, and held three other branches as discontinued operations at year-end 2011 under contract for divestiture in January, 2012. In selected other locations, the Company may combine or relocate other branches over time based on market conditions. Berkshire has a pending agreement to acquire The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company, and expects to add that bank’s eight Hartford area branches in the second quarter of 2012.

 

In 2011, Berkshire relocated its Wealth Management business into a new facility located in Lenox, Massachusetts. Berkshire Insurance Group operates from 11 locations in Western Massachusetts in both standalone premises as well as in rented space located in the Bank’s premises. For several years, all new Berkshire branch locations have been based around its new retail branch design which eliminates traditional teller counters and provides an interactive customer service environment through “pod” stations which include automated cash handling technology. In many cases, this branch design also includes a multimedia community room which is offered for use by nonprofit community groups. Berkshire currently has 8 offices configured based on this new branch design, including all of the de novo branch offices opened in recent years in the Albany New York market.

 

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

 

At December 31, 2011, neither the Company nor the Bank was involved in any pending legal proceedings believed by management to be material to the Company’s financial condition or results of operations. Periodically, there have been various claims and lawsuits involving the Bank, such as claims to enforce liens, condemnation proceedings on properties in which the Bank holds security interests, claims involving the making and servicing of real property loans and other issues incident to the Bank’s business. However, neither the Company nor the Bank is a party to any pending legal proceedings that it believes, in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on the financial condition or operations of the Company. 

 

Following the public announcement of the execution of the Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated October 25, 2011 (the "Merger Agreement"), by and among the Company, the Bank and The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company (“CBT”), on January 18, 2012, Jean-Pierre Van Rooy, Marie-Claire Van Rooy and Eric Van Rooy filed a shareholder class action lawsuit in the Superior Court of the State of Connecticut, Judicial District of Hartford, against CBT, the Directors of CBT, the Company and the Bank (the “CBT shareholder litigation”).  The CBT shareholder litigation purports to be brought on behalf of all of CBT's public stockholders and alleges that the directors of CBT breached their fiduciary duties to CBT's stockholders by failing to take steps necessary to obtain a fair and adequate price for CBT's common stock and that the Company and the Bank knowingly aided and abetted CBT’s directors' breach of fiduciary duty.

 

- 40 -
 

 

CBT, its Directors, the Company and the Bank deny and intend to vigorously defend all of the allegations asserted in the CBT shareholder litigation. Management of the Company and the Bank believe that the CBT shareholder litigation will not have any material adverse effect on the financial condition or operations of the Company or the Bank.    

 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

 

Not Applicable.

 

- 41 -
 

 

PART II

 

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

Market Information

 

The common shares of the Company trade on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “BHLB”. The following table sets forth the quarterly high and low closing sales price information and dividends declared per share of common stock in 2011 and 2010.

 

  High   Low   Dividends
Declared
 
2011               
First quarter  $22.92   $20.68   $0.16 
Second quarter   22.85    20.45    0.16 
Third quarter   24.14    17.11    0.16 
Fourth quarter   22.50    17.56    0.17 
2010               
First quarter  $20.99   $16.20   $0.16 
Second quarter   22.84    16.81    0.16 
Third quarter   20.94    17.08    0.16 
Fourth quarter   22.49    17.90    0.16 

 

Holders

 

The Company had approximately 3,237 holders of record of common stock at March 7, 2012.

 

Dividends

 

The Company intends to pay regular cash dividends to common stockholders; however, there can be no assurance as to future dividends because they are dependent on the Company’s future earnings, capital requirements, financial condition, and regulatory environment. Dividends from the Bank have been a source of cash used by the Company to pay its dividends, and these dividends from the Bank are dependent on the Bank’s future earnings, capital requirements, and financial condition. Further information about dividend restrictions is provided in the Stockholders’ Equity note in the consolidated financial statements.

 

Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities; Use of Proceeds From Registered Securities

 

No unregistered securities were sold by the Company within the last three years.

 

In May 2009, the Company issued 1.61 million common shares in a public stock offering and raised $32 million which was used to repay U.S. Treasury preferred stock. No other registered securities were sold by the Company within the last three years.

 

- 42 -
 

 

Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchases

 

There were no purchases of equity securities during the fourth quarter of 2011 made by or on behalf of the Company or any “affiliated purchaser”, as defined by Section 240.10b-18(a)(3) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, of shares of the Company’s common stock. On December 14, 2007, the Company authorized the purchase of up to 300 thousand shares, from time to time, subject to market conditions. The repurchase plan will continue until it is completed or terminated by the Board of Directors. The Company has no intentions to terminate this plan or to cease any potential future purchases. As of year-end 2011, there were 98 thousand maximum shares that may yet be purchased under this publicly announced plan.

 

The following table sets forth information regarding the activity during the fourth quarter of 2011:

 

           Total number of shares   Maximum number of 
           purchased as part of   shares that may yet 
   Total number of   Average price   publicly announced   be purchased under 
Period  shares purchased (1)   paid per share   plans or programs   the plans or programs 
October 1-31, 2011   416   $18.47    -    97,993 
November 1-30, 2011   -    -    -    97,993 
December 1-31, 2011   -    -    -    97,993 
Total   416   $18.47    -    97,993 

 

(1) Shares represent common stock withheld by the Company to satisfy tax withholding requirements on the vesting of shares under the Company’s benefit plans.

 

- 43 -
 

 

Performance Graph

 

The performance graph compares the Company’s cumulative stockholder return on its common stock over the last five years to the cumulative return of the NASDAQ Composite Index, and the SNL All Bank and Thrift Index. Total stockholder return is measured by dividing total dividends (assuming dividend reinvestment) for the measurement period plus share price change for a period by the share price at the beginning of the measurement period. The Company’s cumulative stockholder return over a five-year period is based on an initial investment of $100 on December 31, 2006.

 

S:\TQData\VINEYARD\Live Jobs\2012\03 Mar\13 Mar\Shift I\v305252 BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP - 10-K\Draft\03-Production

 

   Period Ending 
Index  12/31/06   12/31/07   12/31/08   12/31/09   12/31/10   12/31/11 
Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.   100.00    79.25    96.39    66.51    73.47    76.04 
NASDAQ Composite   100.00    110.66    66.42    96.54    114.06    113.16 
SNL Bank and Thrift   100.00    76.26    43.85    43.27    48.30    37.56 

 

- 44 -
 

 

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The following summary data is based in part on the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes, and other schedules appearing elsewhere in this Form 10-K. Historical data is also based in part on, and should be read in conjunction with, prior filings with the SEC.

 

   At or For the Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands, except per share data)  2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
                     
Selected Financial Data:                         
Total assets  $3,991,204   $2,881,403   $2,700,991   $2,666,729   $2,513,432 
Securities   533,181    405,953    420,966    341,516    258,497 
Loans   2,956,570    2,142,162    1,961,658    2,007,152    1,944,016 
Allowance for loan loss   (32,444)   (31,898)   (31,816)   (22,908)   (22,116)
Goodwill and intangibles   223,364    173,079    176,100    178,830    182,452 
Deposits   3,101,175    2,204,441    1,986,762    1,829,580    1,822,563 
Borrowings and subordinated debentures   237,402    260,301    306,668    374,621    349,938 
Total stockholders’ equity   553,365    388,647    385,148    408,425    326,837 
                          
Selected Operating Data:                         
Total interest and dividend income  $138,260   $112,277   $115,476   $133,211   $131,944 
Total interest expense   31,740    35,330    45,880    57,471    68,019 
Net interest income   106,520    76,947    69,596    75,740    63,925 
Service charges and fee income   33,727    29,859    28,181    30,334    26,654 
All other non-interest income (loss)   2,076    (108)   (3,004)   1,261    (2,011)
Total net revenue   142,323    106,698    94,773    107,335    88,568 
Provision for loan losses   7,563    8,526    47,730    4,580    4,300 
Total non-interest expense   116,052    81,729    78,571    71,699    65,494 
Income tax expense (benefit) - continuing operations   2,041    2,585    (15,597)   8,812    5,239 
Net income from discontinued operations   914    -    -    -    - 
Net income (loss)  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)  $22,244   $13,535 
Less: Cumulative preferred stock dividend and accretion   -    -    1,030    -    - 
Less: Deemed dividend from preferred stock repayment   -    -    2,954    -    - 
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders  $17,581   $13,858   $(19,915)  $22,244   $13,535 
                          
Dividends per common share  $0.65   $0.64   $0.64   $0.63   $0.58 
Basic earnings per common share  $0.98   $1.00   $(1.51)  $2.08   $1.47 
Diluted earnings per common share  $0.98   $1.00   $(1.51)  $2.06   $1.44 
                          
Weighted average common shares outstanding - basic   17,885    13,862    13,189    10,700    9,223 
Weighted average common hares outstanding - diluted   17,952    13,896    13,189    10,791    9,370 

 

- 45 -
 

 

   At or For the Years Ended December 31, 
   2011   2010   2009   2008   2007 
                     
Selected Operating Ratios and Other Data:                         
Performance Ratios:                         
Return on average assets   0.50%   0.51%   (0.74)%   0.87%   0.60%
Return on average equity   3.69    3.62    (4.83)   6.47    4.69 
Interest rate spread   3.38    3.01    2.61    3.06    2.79 
Net interest margin   3.57    3.28    3.00    3.44    3.26 
Non-interest income/total net revenue   25.16    27.88    26.57    29.44    27.82 
Non-interest expense/average assets   3.33    2.98    2.93    2.81    2.90 
Dividend payout ratio   66.33    64.00    N/M    30.58    40.28 
                          
Growth Ratios:                         
Total loans   38.02%   9.20%   (2.27)%   3.24%   14.43%
Total deposits   40.68    10.96    8.59    0.39    19.75 
Total net revenues   33.39    12.58    (8.15)   21.19    22.52 
                          
Capital Ratios:                         
Tier 1 capital to average assets - bank   8.41%   8.04%   7.86%   9.34%   7.97%
Total capital to risk-weighted assets - bank   11.29    10.61    10.71    12.28    10.40 
Stockholders’ equity/total assets   13.86    13.49    14.26    15.32    13.00 
Tangible common stockholders' equity to tangible assets (1)   8.76    7.96    8.26    7.75    6.22 
                          
Asset Quality Ratios:                         
Net loans charged-off/average total loans   0.27    0.42    1.96    0.19    0.34 
Allowance for loan losses/total loans   1.10    1.49    1.62    1.14    1.14 
                          
Share Data:                         
Book value per share  $26.17   $27.61   $27.68   $30.33   $31.15 
Market price at year end  $22.19   $22.11   $20.68   $30.86   $26.00 

 

 

Note: All performance ratios are based on average balance sheet amounts where applicable.

N/M = Not Meaningful

(1)Tangible common stockholders' equity to tangible assets exclude goodwill and other intangibles. This is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company believes provide investors with information that is useful in understanding our financial performance and condition.

Note: Generally accepted accounting principles require that acquired loans be recorded at fair value, whereas historical loans are recorded at cost. In 2011, BHLB acquired loans as a result of its acquisitions of Rome Bancorp and Legacy Bancorp. The fair value of acquired loans includes expected loan losses, and there is no loan loss allowance recorded for acquired loans at the time of acquisition. Accordingly, the ratio of the loan loss allowance to total loans is reduced as a result of the existence of acquired loans, and this measure is not directly comparable to prior periods. Similarly, net loan charge-offs are normally reduced for acquired loans since these loans are recorded net of expected loan losses. Therefore, the ratio of net loan charge-offs to average loans is reduced as a result of the existence of acquired loans, and this measure is not directly comparable to prior periods. Other institutions may have acquired loans, and therefore there may be no direct comparability of these ratios between and among other institutions.

 

- 46 -
 

 

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONs

 

General

 

This discussion is intended to assist in understanding the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. This discussion should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes contained in this report.

 

Critical Accounting POLICIES

 

The SEC defines “critical accounting policies” as those that require application of management’s most difficult, subjective or complex judgments, often as a result of the need to make estimates about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain and may change in future periods. The Company’s significant accounting policies are described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements. Please see those policies in conjunction with this discussion. Management believes that the following policies would be considered critical under the SEC’s definition:

 

Allowance for Loan Losses. The allowance for loan losses is the Company’s estimate of probable credit losses that are inherent in the loan portfolio at the financial statement date. Management uses historical information, as well as current economic data, to assess the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses as it is affected by changing economic conditions and various external factors, which may impact the portfolio in ways currently unforeseen. Although management believes that it uses appropriate available information to establish the allowance for loan losses, future additions to the allowance may be necessary if certain future events occur that cause actual results to differ from the assumptions used in making the evaluation. Conditions in the local economy and real estate values could require the Company to increase provisions for loan losses, which would negatively impact earnings.

 

Acquired Loans. Due to the bank acquisitions in 2011, the Company added a significant accounting policy related to acquired loans. Loans that the Company acquired are initially recorded at fair value with no carryover of the related allowance for credit losses. Determining the fair value of the loans involves estimating the amount and timing of principal and interest cash flows initially expected to be collected on the loans and discounting those cash flows at an appropriate market rate of interest. Going forward, the Company continues to evaluate reasonableness of expectations for the timing and the amount of cash to be collected. Subsequent decreases in expected cash flows may result in changes in the amortization or accretion of fair market value adjustments, and in some cases may result in the loan being considered impaired.

 

Income Taxes. Significant management judgment is required in determining income tax expense and deferred tax assets and liabilities. The Company uses the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes in which deferred tax assets and liabilities are established for the temporary differences between the financial reporting basis and the tax basis of the Company’s asset and liabilities. The realization of the net deferred tax asset generally depends upon future levels of taxable income and the existence of prior years’ taxable income, to which “carry back” refund claims could be made. A valuation allowance is maintained for deferred tax assets that management estimates are more likely than not to be unrealizable based on available evidence at the time the estimate is made. In determining the valuation allowance, the Company uses historical and forecasted future operating results, based upon approved business plans, including a review of the eligible carryforward periods, tax planning opportunities and other relevant considerations. These underlying assumptions can change from period to period. For example, tax law changes or variances in future projected operating performance could result in a change in the valuation allowance. Should actual factors and conditions differ materially from those considered by management, the actual realization of the net deferred tax asset could differ materially from the amounts recorded in the financial statements. If the Company is not able to realize all or part of our net deferred tax asset in the future, an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance would be charged to income tax expense in the period such determination was made.

 

- 47 -
 

 

Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets. Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets are recorded as a result of business acquisitions and combinations. These assets are evaluated for impairment annually or whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value of these assets may not be recoverable. When these assets are evaluated for impairment, if the carrying amount exceeds fair value, an impairment charge is recorded to income. The fair value is based on observable market prices, when practicable. Other valuation techniques may be used when market prices are unavailable, including estimated discounted cash flows and market multiples analyses. These types of analyses contain uncertainties because they require management to make assumptions and to apply judgment to estimate industry economic factors and the profitability of future business strategies. In the event of future changes in fair value, the Company may be exposed to an impairment charge that could be material.

 

Determination of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment of Securities. The Company evaluates debt and equity securities within the Company’s available for sale and held to maturity portfolios for other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”), at least quarterly. If the fair value of a debt security is below the amortized cost basis of the security, OTTI is required to be recognized if any of the following are met: (1) the Company intends to sell the security; (2) it is “more likely than not” that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis; or (3) for debt securities, the present value of expected cash flows is not sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost basis. For all impaired debt securities that the Company intends to sell, or more likely than not will be required to sell, the full amount of the depreciation is recognized as OTTI through earnings. Credit-related OTTI for all other impaired debt securities is recognized through earnings. Noncredit related OTTI for such debt securities is recognized in other comprehensive income, net of applicable taxes. In evaluating its marketable equity securities portfolios for OTTI, the Company considers its intent and ability to hold an equity security to recovery of its cost basis in addition to various other factors, including the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost and the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer. Any OTTI on marketable equity securities is recognized immediately through earnings. Should actual factors and conditions differ materially from those expected by management, the actual realization of gains or losses on investment securities could differ materially from the amounts recorded in the financial statements.

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments. The Company uses fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain financial instruments and to determine fair value disclosures. Trading assets, securities available for sale, and derivative instruments are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Additionally, from time to time, the Company may be required to record at fair value other assets on a nonrecurring basis, or to establish a loss allowance or write-down based on the fair value of impaired assets. Further, the notes to financial statements include information about the extent to which fair value is used to measure assets and liabilities, the valuation methodologies used and its impact to earnings. Additionally, for financial instruments not recorded at fair value, the notes to financial statements disclose the estimate of their fair value. Due to the judgments and uncertainties involved in the estimation process, the estimates could result in materially different results under different assumptions and conditions.

 

- 48 -
 

 

Summary

 

Berkshire achieved record total net revenue of $142 million in 2011, which was a 33% increase over $107 million in the prior year. This increase was due both to organic growth and to the acquisitions of Rome Bancorp on April 1, 2011 and Legacy Bancorp on July 21, 2011. The fourth quarter was the first full quarter of combined operations with the acquired banks. Fourth quarter net revenue increased by 45% to an annualized rate of $160 million including the full combined results of the acquired banks.

 

Berkshire’s net income increased by $3.7 million (27%) to $17.6 million in 2011, compared to $13.9 million in the prior year. Fourth quarter net income, reflecting the combined operations of the acquired banks, increased by 135% to $8.5 million in 2011, compared to $3.6 million in the prior year. Total shares outstanding increased by 50% to 21.1 million during the year as a result of shares issued for merger consideration. Full year earnings per share totaled $0.98 in 2011, compared to $1.00 in the prior year. All references to per share results in this report refer to diluted shares unless otherwise noted.

 

Fourth quarter earnings per share increased by 54% to $0.40 in 2011, compared to $0.26 in 2010. Results in the fourth quarter of 2011 included $0.8 million in net after-tax charges ($0.04 per share) related to merger and divestiture activities. The Company views the improvement in earnings per share before these charges as reflecting the ongoing benefits of organic growth, bank acquisitions, and profitability improvement achieved during the year.

 

After the initial expenses related to the merger, the Company expected the acquisition of Rome Bancorp to be accretive to earnings in the amount of $0.09 per share in 2011 and $0.10 in 2012. For the Legacy acquisition, this expectation was accretion of $0.06 per share in 2011 and $0.10 per share in 2012. Based on the results achieved in 2011, the Company believes that it met or exceeded its merger related EPS accretion expectations in 2011 and its goal is to achieve the expected benefits in 2012.

 

In addition to merger related growth, the Company produced organic growth of loans and deposits. Coupled with Berkshire’s pricing and expense management disciplines, this growth resulted in positive operating leverage – with revenue growth exceeding expense growth. The fourth quarter net interest margin improved to 3.61% in 2011 from 3.30% in the prior year. For these periods, the return on assets increased to 0.85% from 0.51%, and the return on equity increased to 6.2% from 3.7%.

 

As a result of accounting standards for business combinations, costs related to acquisitions are recorded as expenses in the current period, although the Company views such costs as part of the overall economic investment in the acquired entities. Total after-tax merger, divestiture, and non-recurring net costs were $10.4 million ($0.58 per share) in 2011.

 

In addition to the growth in revenue, earnings, and profitability described above, Berkshire took other significant steps in 2012 in implementing its strategy for growth and development. In the fourth quarter, Berkshire announced an agreement to acquire CBT – The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company, which will expand Berkshire’s operations into Northern Connecticut. Also in the fourth quarter, Berkshire announced the recruitment of a seasoned commercial banking team to be located in its new Westborough, Massachusetts commercial banking office. Along with its existing asset based lending team located in Woburn, this initiative increases Berkshire’s commercial banking activities in Central and Eastern Massachusetts. Berkshire opened two de novo branches in its Albany, New York region during 2011, continuing its ongoing expansion in this market. Berkshire appointed a new executive with extensive experience in our markets to lead the commercial banking and wealth management teams. Berkshire also expanded its risk management function, including recruiting new senior officers to manage credit underwriting and internal control. Another senior officer was recruited to lead the new office of project management. The Company entered into a contract for a new core processing system to be implemented in 2012, which is intended to increase Berkshire’s product capabilities, and scalability in future years. This systems conversion is also targeted towards improved operating efficiency, together with Berkshire’s ongoing Six Sigma process engineering initiatives. Current operations include costs related to these activities as Berkshire continues to balance earnings growth with ongoing costs of investing in the franchise to support future growth and expansion.

 

- 49 -
 

 

Reflecting the improvement in earnings and the earnings outlook, Berkshire increased the shareholder dividend by 6% to $0.17 per share from $0.16 per share beginning in the fourth quarter of 2011. Berkshire’s capital ratios were strong and improving during the year, including both the equity/assets ratio and the tangible equity/assets ratio. The Company viewed most asset quality measures as favorable and improving. Improvement in Berkshire’s liquidity was reflected in lower borrowings and a decrease in the ratio of loans/deposits. The Company’s access to funds improved as a result of an increase in the total number of branches to 60 from 42 during the year. Berkshire’s loan portfolio was further diversified as a result of the expansion of its lending footprint and the ongoing growth of its commercial business lending activities.

 

In summary, Berkshire achieved a significant increase in the size and quality of its franchise, resulting in significant growth in revenues and recurring earnings, both on an absolute and per share basis. Berkshire continued to post strong organic growth in targeted business lines. The bank acquisitions were accretive to recurring earnings per share and tangible equity measures also improved during the year. Berkshire’s profitability increased, as evidenced by the significant improvement in all fourth quarter profitability measures, with the fourth quarter representing the first full quarter with the combined results of both acquired banks. A number of strategic initiatives were undertaken to produce further growth in revenues and earnings in 2011 and beyond. The Company’s financial condition remained strong and improving, as reflected in capital, asset quality, and liquidity measures. Berkshire continued to enhance and deepen its management team and to strengthen its culture and brand as America’s Most Exciting BankSM.

 

COMPARISON OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AT DECEMBER 31, 2011 AND 2010

 

Balance Sheet Summary. Total assets increased by $1.1 billion (39% compared to the comparable prior period measure) to $4.0 billion at year-end 2011. This growth included $1.2 billion in assets recorded as a result of the acquisitions of Rome Bancorp (on April 1, 2011) and Legacy Bancorp (on July 21, 2011). Most categories of assets and liabilities increased as a result of these acquisitions. Berkshire also recorded a $143 million reduction in deposits and a $49 million reduction in assets related to the divestiture of four former Legacy branches in conjunction with the Legacy merger agreement. Additionally, Berkshire reported $55 million in liabilities and $5 million in assets related to the discontinued operations of four other former Legacy branches held for divestiture at year-end; this transaction was completed in January 2012.

 

On an organic basis, excluding the impact of acquisitions and divestitures, total loans increased by 2% and total deposits increased by 10%. Organic loan growth was primarily due to a 6% organic increase in commercial loans, and organic deposit growth benefited from commercial deposit growth as well as higher balances related to ongoing expansion of de novo branches in the Albany, New York region.

 

Capital, asset performance, and liquidity metrics improved during 2011. Total outstanding common shares increased by 50% to 21.1 million in 2011 due to shares issued as merger consideration. Total shareholders’ equity increased by $165 million (42%) to $553 million primarily due to this share issuance. The ratio of total equity/assets increased to 13.9% from 13.5%, and the Bank’s risk based capital ratio increased to 11.3% from 10.6%. The ratio of loans/deposits was 95% at year-end 2011, compared to 97% at the start of the year, due to strong deposit growth.

 

- 50 -
 

 

The ratio of net loan charge-offs/average loans was 0.27% in 2011, and the ratio of nonperforming assets/assets was 0.65% at year-end 2011. In accordance with accounting standards for business combinations, the acquired assets are recorded at fair value and there is no loan loss allowance recorded for acquired loans. Additionally, all acquired loans are recorded as performing regardless of their payment status. Accordingly, many asset quality metrics are not comparable from period to period.

 

At year-end 2011, Berkshire had a pending agreement to acquire CBT – The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company, with $0.3 billion in assets and eight branches in the Hartford, Connecticut area. The approximate value of this acquisition is $30 million, including approximately $21 million in additional common stock expected to be issued in the second quarter of 2012 based on the planned merger completion date. This acquisition is not expected to have a material effect on the key balance sheet ratios described above.

 

Investment Securities. Total investment securities increased by $127 million (31%) in 2011. This increase included the $53 million fair value of securities recorded in the business combinations, as well as the investment of excess funds generated from organic deposit growth. At year-end, most of the growth was represented in the $110 million increase in securities available for sale, along with a $14 million increase in restricted equity investments primarily consisting of Federal Home Loan Bank stock held by the acquired banks. The increase in securities available for sale mainly consisted of a $101 million increase in U.S. government agency sponsored mortgage backed securities which were mostly planned amortization class bonds with average expected lives targeted in the 2-4 year range.

 

Berkshire’s goal is to maintain a high quality portfolio consisting primarily of liquid investment securities with managed durations to limit the potential for market value declines in rising rate markets. At year-end 2011, Berkshire’s $533 million securities portfolio was primarily comprised of $293 million in U.S. government or government agency sponsored mortgage backed securities, which constituted 55% of the total portfolio, compared to $173 million (43% of the portfolio) at the start of the year. Municipal securities and development bonds were little changed, totaling $138 million (26% of the portfolio) at year-end 2011. Other significant components of the portfolio at year-end included $28 million of corporate bonds and trust preferred securities, $21 million of marketable equity securities (consisting primarily of regional community bank stocks), and $37 million of restricted securities which mostly consisted of Federal Home Loan bank stock. Approximately 79% of the total portfolio was designated as available for sale, with the primary exceptions being the restricted stock and locally issued development bonds (classified as held to maturity municipal securities except for one security classified as a trading obligation as a result of a related interest rate swap.)

 

The net unrealized gain on securities available for sale totaled $6.3 million, or 1.5% of book value at year-end 2011, compared to 1.3% a year earlier. The fair value benefit of lower long term interest rates at year-end 2011 was partially offset by the lower portfolio yield resulting from run-off during the year. Also, Berkshire realized a $2.1 million gain in income in 2011 on its investment holdings of common stock in Rome and Legacy based on the accounting standards for business combinations. Most of this gain was included in unrealized gains at the start of the year.

 

- 51 -
 

 

There were no material credit rating downgrades of securities in the portfolio in 2011. None of the Company’s investment securities were deemed impaired on an other-than-temporary basis during 2011. At year-end 2011, all available for sale debt securities carried at least one investment grade rating by a major rating agency except for two securities: a $2.6 million investment in the Mezzanine Class B tranche of a pooled trust preferred security which was rated Ca by Moodys, and a $2.0 million investment in an unrated school district bond with a year-end premium fair value and an unrealized gain. The Company’s held to maturity securities are generally unrated local securities, all of which are performing and none of which is deemed substandard according to the Company’s internal ratings systems. Regarding the above-mentioned pooled trust preferred security, the unrealized loss measured 81% of book value at year-end 2011, compared to 92% of book value at the start of the year. The Company evaluated the security, with a Level 3 fair value of $0.5 million at year-end 2011. With the assistance of independent third parties, the Company modeled cash flows and defaults and evaluated the loss protection provided by the pool’s junior tranches. There was no evidence of other-than-temporary impairment based on both the Company’s plan and ability to hold the security until the recovery of its remaining amortized cost and the protection from credit loss afforded by excess subordination above projected losses. The Level 3 fair value of the security was determined with the assistance of a third party by a subjective assessment of market conditions for similar securities. Interest payments on this security have been suspended by the issuer, but it has been maintained on an accruing status based on the Company’s cash flow analysis and the subordination protecting the Company’s tranche. In addition to this pooled trust preferred security, at year-end 2011 the Company owned $17 million in single issuer trust preferred securities issued primarily by prominent national and major regional banks, all of which had at least one investment grade rating at year-end. The net unrealized loss on this portfolio was 1% of amortized cost at year-end 2011, and there were no purchases or sales of such securities during the year.

 

The tax equivalent yield on investment securities declined to 3.3% in the fourth quarter of 2011, compared to 3.9% in the fourth quarter of 2010, reflecting the impact of portfolio turnover and growth in the ongoing low interest rate environment. For the year, the yield decreased to 3.7% in 2011 from 4.1% in 2010. Berkshire continues to pursue a general investment policy approach to maintain a high quality, relatively short duration investment portfolio, and to focus on loan growth as the primary use of funds from deposit growth and the primary source of interest income. The effective duration of the available for sale debt securities portfolio was estimated at 2.3 years, with a 4.2 year average life at year-end 2011. This reflects the short duration planned amortization class bonds which comprise the majority of the mortgage backed securities portfolio, combined with the approximate 7.1 year duration of available for sale municipal securities.

 

Loans. Total loans increased by $814 million (38%) to $2.96 billion in 2011. This included $258 million in acquired Rome loans and $566 million in acquired Legacy loans and excluded $48 million in loans designated as discontinued operations.

 

Loans acquired as a result of the bank mergers were generally in-market conforming loans, and included $279 million in commercial loans, $374 million in residential mortgages, and $123 million in consumer loans. The acquired loans were recorded at estimated net fair value. As a result of merger activity, the year-end residential mortgage portfolio increased to 34% of total loans from 30%. Consumer loans remained little changed at 13% of total loans, and commercial loans decreased to 53% of total loans from 56%.

 

Rome’s commercial loans were primarily small business loans to local area borrowers. Legacy’s commercial loans were primarily to entities in and around its footprint, and also included approximately $76 million in year-end 2011 fair value of national commercial real estate loan balances under a longstanding program targeted to provide portfolio diversity. This portfolio includes about $28 million in loans within Berkshire’s overall lending footprint, and approximately $48 million in other regions, generally in the eastern U.S. This portfolio is performing with minimal delinquencies.

 

Berkshire conducted thorough pre-merger due diligence on these acquired portfolios and post-merger fair value analysis with the assistance of a third party. The combined loan loss allowances of Rome and Legacy on the acquisition dates totaled $11.3 million. The Company recorded a net discount of $21.2 million on acquired loans (2.5% of the acquired book balance). This included $13.3 million in nonaccretable discount on acquired loans with deteriorated credit quality. The remaining $7.9 million in net discount included $3.6 million in accretable discount on loans with deteriorated credit quality, and $4.3 million in other net accretable discount. The total accretable net discount at acquisition will be accreted into loan income over the portfolio lives. Acquired loan prepayments introduced some volatility into quarterly earnings due to the unevenness of prepayment events. At year-end 2011, accruing loans over 90 days past due included $4.5 million in acquired loans which were accruing interest based on accretable discount estimates for acquired loans with deteriorated credit quality.

 

- 52 -
 

 

Excluding the $776 million net total of acquired loans, total organic loan growth was $38 million (2%). Organic growth is a non-GAAP measure which measures the change in the balance that is not attributable to merger and divestiture activities. Organic growth is viewed as the result of the Company’s ongoing activities to build its business volumes. This included ongoing growth of the commercial asset based lending portfolio, which increased by $53 million to $151 million at period-end. Including this growth, the total organic increase in commercial loan outstandings was $76 million (6% annualized). Berkshire is adhering to strong underwriting and pricing disciplines as it captures larger market share with high grade loan originations. Berkshire has emphasized commercial business loan originations in order to diversify its portfolio and to utilize the expertise of its lending teams to build more profitable relationships utilizing its service and product capabilities. Berkshire also expects to benefit from its recruitment of an established commercial lending team announced in December, which is now operating from the Company’s new Westborough office serving the commercial middle market in central and eastern Massachusetts. In conjunction with its planned acquisition of The Connecticut Bank & Trust Company, Berkshire expects to develop its commercial lending footprint in the Worcester, Springfield, Hartford triangle, as well as continuing to enhance its commercial presence in eastern Massachusetts.

 

As a result of its commercial loan origination activities, the Company achieved progress towards its goal of reducing the proportion of commercial real estate loans, which decreased to 74% of the commercial portfolio at year-end 2011, compared to 76% at the start of the year. This included a decrease in the balance of commercial construction loans to 8% of total commercial outstandings at year-end 2011. Commercial loans to hospitality borrowers were primarily real estate based and comprised 9% of total year-end 2011 commercial outstandings; the Company continues to pursue plans to lower this portfolio balance as a percent of total loans. The asset based lending portfolio grew to 10% of total commercial outstandings from 8% during the year. The year-end 2011 asset based lending portfolio was comprised primarily of loans to manufacturers (40% of the total) and wholesalers (39%) of the portfolio. There were no criticized loans outstanding in this portfolio at year-end 2011. Berkshire is gradually reducing the term to maturity of commercial loans in order to provide more long run flexibility in managing the portfolio. The Company has reviewed the maturity schedule of commercial real estate loans and does not foresee any significant concentrations of maturities. In the second half of the year, Berkshire developed enhancements to its small business lending program which will be introduced in 2012. The Company expects to increase originations of small business loans and to include the retail division in the origination of conforming low balance small business loans to more effectively provide service to this market.

 

In 2011, Berkshire originated $230 million in residential mortgages, selling $75 million and retaining $155 million in portfolio. In the prior year, mortgage originations totaled $240 million, with $105 million being sold and $135 million being retained. In 2011, the portfolio was flat on an organic basis, excluding the impact of acquisitions and divestitures. The higher retention of originations in 2011 was targeted to offset the impact of runoff, which measured approximately 19% of the average portfolio balance in the ongoing low interest rate environment. The portfolio of loans serviced for others totaled $487 million at year-end 2011, compared to $320 million at the start of the year, and included the impact of the bank acquisitions. Unused home equity lines of credit totaled $225 million at year-end 2011, increasing from $173 million at the prior year-end, including the impact of the bank acquisitions. Based on year-end outstanding loan balances, the line of credit utilization rate was 57% both at the end and at the beginning of 2011. Home equity balances outstanding decreased by 13% on an organic basis in 2011, reflecting in part the drop in demand due to refinancings and the low fixed rate mortgage alternatives.

 

- 53 -
 

 

Yields have generally been declining for many loan categories during 2011 due to the impact of run-off and of the ongoing low interest rate environment on originations. Loan yields benefited from the higher rates associated with the Rome small business loan portfolio and rates associated with some of the Legacy commercial real estate portfolio. Loan yields also benefited from the higher rates assigned to acquired non-performing and higher risk loans as a result of fair value accounting. With this benefit, the 4.74% yield on total average loans in the fourth quarter of 2011 was down only slightly from 4.77% in the same quarter of 2010. Similarly, for the year 2011, the average loan yield decreased slightly to 4.79% from 4.87% in the prior year. The average balance of total loans increased by 29% to $2.6 billion in 2011, reflecting the partial year benefit of the acquired loan portfolios.

 

Berkshire continues to favor an asset sensitive interest rate risk profile, and seeks to manage the retention of long term fixed rate loans. A portion of fixed rate residential mortgage originations is sold in the secondary market, and interest rate swaps are sometimes used to provide fixed rate protection where it is sought by large commercial borrowers. The total amount of swapped commercial loans increased to $160 million from $137 million in 2011. The Bank offers back-to-back interest rate swaps to certain commercial loan customers, which effectively allows the Bank to book a variable rate loan while providing the customer with an option to fix its interest rate. This allows the Company to be more competitive with national financing sources and to avoid booking long-term, fixed rate assets at current low interest rates, as well as providing a source of fee income. Commercial loan swap fee income decreased to $0.5 million in 2011 from $1.3 million in the prior year due to lower demand for fixed rate protection in the ongoing low interest rate environment.

 

Total loans with repricings over five years increased to $921 million at year-end 2011, compared to $527 million at the beginning of the year. In addition to the impact of the acquired loan portfolios, this growth also reflected the increased retention of fixed rate mortgage loan originations during the year to offset the impact of loan prepayments and indirect auto loan run-off on interest income. Total loans repricing under three months increased in 2011 to $935 million from $758 million, including the impact of growth in commercial business loans.

 

Asset Quality. Under accounting standards for business combinations, acquired loans are recorded at fair value and are deemed performing regardless of their payment status. Therefore, some overall portfolio measures of asset quality at year-end 2011 are not comparable to those in prior years.

 

Non-performing assets were 0.65% of total assets at year-end 2011. Total non-performing assets were $26 million at year-end 2011, compared to $17 million at the start of the year. Loans which became non-performing during the year totaled $29 million in 2011, compared to $18 million in the prior year. Growth in non-performing assets in 2011 was partially offset by resolutions totaling $20 million including upgrades, collections, and charge-offs. New non-performing assets were primarily commercial real estate development loans originated prior to the recession where development plans did not come to fruition. Residential mortgages contributed $5 million to the increase in non-performing assets, due to a limited number of loans which became past due. At year-end 2011, the largest non-performing asset was a $3 million commercial land loan. The ten largest non-performing loans totaled $15 million and were generally well secured, with $1.4 million in impairment reserves required as of year-end.

 

Accruing loans over 90 days past due measured 0.34% of total loans at year-end 2011, compared to 0.05% at the start of the year. This increase included past due loans acquired in the business combinations, which are recorded as accruing under accounting standards for business combinations, as well as an increase in delinquent residential mortgages. Loans delinquent 30-89 days increased to 0.55% of total loans from 0.26% due primarily to a small number of commercial real estate loans. Loan classified as performing troubled debt restructurings decreased to $1 million from $7 million during 2011 due to current loan performance resulting in a reclassification from the troubled status. There were no loans which were restructured in 2011 that subsequently defaulted during the year.

 

- 54 -
 

 

Foreclosed real estate remained negligible at year-end 2011, totaling $1.9 million. The Company recorded $2.0 million in foreclosed property expenses in 2011 primarily due to writedowns on one commercial property due to lower offering prices from prospective buyers. The Company anticipated the liquidation of this property in 2012.

 

Net loan charge-offs were 0.27% of average loans in 2011. Total net charge-offs were $7.0 million in 2011, compared to $8.4 million in the prior year. There were no net charge-offs recorded for acquired loans. The acquired loans were recorded with $13.3 million in non-accretable discounts representing the expected uncollectable contractual amounts owed on acquired loans. The expected cash flows of acquired loans are evaluated quarterly.

 

The credit risk profile of the Company’s loan portfolio is described in the Loans footnote in the consolidated financial statements. The Company’s risk management process focuses primary attention on loans with higher than normal risk, which includes loans rated special mention and classified (substandard and lower). These loans are referred to as criticized loans, and criticized assets are the total of criticized loans and foreclosed real estate. The Company measures criticized and classified assets in comparison to total assets and to the sum of Tier One regulatory capital plus the loan loss allowance. Criticized assets, total assets, and capital increased as a result of the business combinations in 2011. As noted above, acquired loans were recorded at fair value, net of estimated nonaccretable credit discounts, and all acquired loans were recorded as performing. The recorded values were in line with estimates made by Berkshire during due diligence prior to negotiating the final terms of the merger agreements, and the quality and performance of acquired criticized assets has been within the range of Berkshire’s expectations.

 

Total criticized assets were $162 million at year-end 2011, compared to $132 million at the start of the year, decreasing to 4.1% of total assets from 4.6% during the year. Compared to the sum of Tier One capital plus the loan loss allowance, criticized assets decreased to 47% from 54% during the year. This improvement included the benefit of risk rating upgrades during the year reflecting improved credit metrics on a number of commercial loans. The ratio of classified assets to the sum of Tier One capital plus the loan loss allowance decreased to 35% from 37%. Total classified assets increased to $123 million from $91 million due primarily to the acquired loans. Performing commercial substandard loans at year-end 2011 were $91 million, including $16 million in acquired loans. Excluding the acquired loans, performing commercial substandard historical loans totaled $75 million at year-end 2011, compared to $73 million at the start of the year. These loans are viewed as potential problem loans with a possibility of loss if weaknesses are not corrected. The ten largest of these loans totaled $43 million, with the largest loan having a $10 million balance and two other loans with balances over $5 million. These three loans were all commercial office and retail rental properties that were performing and not viewed as impaired.

 

Loan Loss Allowance. The determination of the allowance for loan losses is a critical accounting estimate. The Company’s methodologies for determining the loan loss allowance are discussed in Item 1 of this report and Item 8 includes further information about the accounting policy for the loan loss allowance and the Company’s accounting for the allowance in the consolidated financial statements.

 

The Company considers the allowance for loan losses appropriate to cover probable losses which can be reasonably estimated and which are inherent in the loan portfolio as of the balance sheet date. Under accounting standards for business combinations, acquired loans are recorded at fair value with no loan loss allowance on the date of acquisition. A loan loss allowance is recorded by the Company for the emergence of new probable and estimable losses relating to acquired loans which were not impaired as of the acquisition date. Because of the accounting for acquired loans, some measures of the loan loss allowance are not comparable to periods prior to the acquisition date.

 

- 55 -
 

 

The total amount of the loan loss allowance was $32.4 million at year-end 2011, compared to $31.9 million at the start of the year. This increase included a $0.5 million general reserve on acquired loans reflecting further seasoning and environmental factors in the second half of the year. The allowance related to historical loans measured 1.41% of historical loans (excluding acquired loans) at year-end 2011, compared to 1.49% at the start of the year. This reflected general improvement in the credit profile of historical loans during the year. Additionally, the decrease in the general allowance allocated to business loans included the impact of the Company’s additional experience and history with its asset based lending program. The loan loss allowance measured 1.10% of total loans at year-end 2011.

 

The specific valuation allowance assigned to impaired loans increased slightly to $2.8 million from $2.5 million during the year. Total loans deemed impaired increased to $17.4 million from $14.2 million at the start of the year. The allowance provided 4.6X coverage of net loan charge-offs in 2011 and 1.3X coverage of year-end non-performing loans.

 

Other Assets

 

The total amount of cash and short term investments increased by $31 million at year-end 2011, compared to the start of the year. This increased liquidity was being held for use in settling the $55 million in liabilities related to discontinued operations, which were sold in January, 2012.

 

Premises and equipment increased by $22 million in 2011, primarily due to the premises acquired in the bank acquisitions.

 

Goodwill increased by $41 million, including $17 million related to the Rome acquisition and $29 million related to the Legacy acquisition, less amounts related to discontinued operations. Goodwill is the difference between the fair value of consideration paid for these acquisitions and the fair value of net assets and liabilities acquired. The balance of goodwill includes goodwill related to prior acquisitions. Goodwill is analyzed annually for impairment in accordance with accounting standards, and there was no impairment charge recognized based on the most recent analysis in 2011. Other intangible assets increased by $10 million, primarily due to the fair value of the core deposit intangible assets recorded for the Rome and Legacy acquisitions. These assets are being amortized over eight - ten years based on the sum of the years digits method.

 

The cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance policies increased by $29 million primarily due to policies acquired with the Rome and Legacy mergers. These policies are primarily general account policies issued by carriers rated “A” or better. Increases in the cash surrender value of these policies are recorded in non-interest income. There is no income tax expense associated with this income, which partially offsets the cost of employee benefits. In 2011, the tax equivalent yield on the average balance of these policies was approximately 6.2% compared to 5.9% in the prior year.

 

Total “Other assets” increased by $32 million (55%) in 2011. This included a $22 million increase in tax assets plus the addition of various receivable, prepaid, and other miscellaneous assets from the acquired banks. The total balance of the net deferred tax asset stood at $40 million at year-end 2011, including a $22 million increase during the year primarily due to the impact of deferred tax adjustments related to fair value adjustments and core deposit intangible assets recognized with the bank acquisitions. These deferred tax balances will be amortized as the related purchase accounting impacts are amortized into income in future years.

 

The $5 million balance of assets from discontinued operations represents loans, premises, and other assets related to the branches held for sale at year-end 2011.

 

Deposits. Total deposits increased by $897 million (41%) to $3.10 billion in 2011. This included $229 million in acquired Rome balances and $661 million in acquired Legacy balances and excluded $210 million in deposits transferred to discontinued operations. The acquired Rome and Legacy deposits (excluding discontinued operations) included $135 million in transaction balances, $65 million in money market balances, $225 million in savings balances, and $252 million in time account balances. As a result of acquired balances and organic activity, money market balances increased from 32% to 34% of total deposits, and time accounts decreased from 34% to 32% of the total. Transaction and savings account balances remained unchanged at 23% and 11% of total deposits, respectively.

 

- 56 -
 

 

Excluding the $677 million net total of balances related to acquisitions and divestitures, total organic deposit growth was $216 million (10%) in 2011. Most of this organic growth was in the Albany, New York region. The New York growth reflected ongoing deposit growth related to the Bank’s de novo branches opened in recent years in this strategically important region. The Bank opened an additional two branches in this region in 2011. Overall organic growth was strongest in checking account balances (22%) and money market account balances (25%). Berkshire promotes these account types, which provide more relationship cross-sale opportunities. Organic deposit growth has included the contribution of growth in commercial balances related to the increased volumes of commercial business.

 

By emphasizing lower cost non-maturity deposits and lowering time deposit costs, the Company has reduced the cost of its deposits in order to offset the impact of lower asset yields in the current low interest rate environment. The average annualized cost of deposits decreased to 0.73% in the fourth quarter of 2011 from 1.15% in the fourth quarter of 2010. A total of $523 million in time deposits are scheduled to mature in 2012, and the weighted average cost of time deposits is expected to continue to decline based on continuing low interest rates. The average balance of total deposits increased by 33% to $2.7 billion in 2011, including the impact of the bank acquisitions during the year.

 

Borrowings and Debentures. Total borrowings and debentures decreased by $23 million to $237 million in 2011, as excess liquidity from deposit growth was used to pay down short-term borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank. At year-end 2011, Berkshire had $200 million in notional amount of interest rate swaps outstanding in relation to the $237 million in total borrowings and debentures. This notional swap amount increased from $160 million at the start of the year due to the addition of $40 million in forward starting swaps, bringing the total amount of forward starting swaps to $80 million. The average cost of borrowings (including the impact of related swaps) increased to 3.35% in the fourth quarter of 2011, compared to 2.92% in the fourth quarter of 2010. This reflected a change in the borrowings mix as a result of the repayment of low cost overnight borrowings during the year.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments. At year-end 2011, the Company held derivatives with a total notional amount of $578 million. Of this total, interest rate swaps with a combined notional amount of $200 million were designated as cash flow hedges and $335 million have been designated as economic hedges.  The remaining $43 million notional amount represents commitments to originate residential mortgage loans for sale and commitments to sell residential mortgage loans, which are also accounted for as derivative financial instruments.

 

The $200 million of cash flow hedges were hedging borrowings and debentures as described above. The $335 million in economic hedges consisted principally of $160 million in total notional value of interest rate swaps with commercial customers, which were offset with back-to-back swaps with bank counterparties. This was a 17% increase over the $137 million notional value of these swaps at the start of the year. Economic hedges also included a $14 million interest rate swap on an economic development bond designated as a trading security.

 

The net fair value of derivative financial instruments was estimated at a net loss of $13 million at year-end 2011, compared to $11 million at the start of the year, due primarily to the impact of further decreases in market interest rates on the economic hedge of the trading security, which is offset by the improved value of the trading security. The total net loss primarily relates to $9 million in losses on the cash flow hedges due to the impact of falling interest rates on the fixed payment swap obligations. At year-end 2011, gross losses of $27 million were recorded as derivative liabilities included in other liabilities and gross gains of $14 million were recorded as derivative assets in other assets. At year-end 2011, the Company also had a $5 million unamortized balance from a terminated swap in accumulated other comprehensive income which is being amortized into earnings.

 

- 57 -
 

 

Stockholders’ Equity. Total equity increased by $165 million (42%) to $553 million in 2011. Paid in capital increased by $157 million due to the merger consideration issued for the bank acquisitions. The Rome consideration was 70% stock and 30% cash, while the Legacy consideration was 90% stock and 10% cash. The cash consideration was paid from the liquid assets of the acquired companies. As a result of these acquisitions, total shares outstanding increased by 50% to 21.1 million from 14.1 million. Equity growth also included the benefit of $18 million in net income less $12 million in dividends paid. The increase in equity further included the impact of options acquired as part of the merger consideration, as well as exercises of existing outstanding stock options, and a decrease in the accumulated other comprehensive loss due to improvement in the fair value of investment securities and cash flow hedges. Tangible equity is measured as the difference between total equity and total goodwill and intangible assets. Tangible equity increased by $114 million (53%) to $330 million during the year. Tangible equity, and measures that refer to tangible equity, are non-GAAP financial measures. They are used by investors as an alternate measure of capital strength. Many regulatory capital measures also adjust equity to exclude goodwill and most intangible assets.

 

Capital remained strong at year-end 2011, with equity/assets improving to 13.9% from 13.5%, and tangible equity/assets improving to 8.8% from 8.0%. Book value per share decreased to $26.17 from $27.61 due to the impact of current market prices used to value merger stock consideration on the bank acquisition dates. Tangible book value per share increased by 2% to $15.60 from $15.31 during 2011.

 

In the fourth quarter, the Company increased its quarterly cash dividend by 6% from $0.16 per share to $0.17 per share. Compared to the year-end stock closing price of $22.19, this equated to a 3.1% annualized dividend yield. Based on the year-end stock price, the market capitalization of Berkshire’s common stock was $469 million, which was a 51% increase over the $311 million market capitalization at the start of the year. Based on its high price of $24.14 on the date of the Legacy acquisition, the Company’s highest market capitalization during the year was approximately $510 million.

 

At year-end 2011, the Bank’s regulatory capital ratios exceeded the requirements to be considered “well capitalized”, with the total risk-based capital ratio increasing to 11.3% from 10.6% at the start of the year. Berkshire Bank’s federal regulator is the FDIC.

 

The Company is a savings and loan holding company and is not subject to specific regulatory capital requirements. In the third quarter of 2011, the regulation of Berkshire Hills Bancorp (the holding company) became the responsibility of the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston. The holding company’s prior federal regulator, was the Office of Thrift Supervision, which was eliminated by federal legislation. Under a transition rule, the Federal Reserve Bank is expected to specify specific regulatory capital requirements for savings and loan holding companies which will become effective in 2015. The Company does not expect that there will be any material impact on its business as a result of this holding company regulatory change.

  

- 58 -
 

  

COMPARISON OF OPERATING RESULTS FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2011 AND 2010

 

Berkshire’s results in 2011 included Rome operations acquired on April 1, 2011 and Legacy operations acquired on July 21, 2011. As a result, most categories of revenue and expense increased due to these acquisitions. Earnings per share were affected by the issuance of 7.0 million additional Berkshire common shares related to these acquisitions. All references to revenue and expense in this discussion exclude discontinued operations of Legacy branches.

 

Net income increased by $3.7 million (27%) to $17.6 million in 2011, compared to $13.9 million in 2010. Earnings per share decreased slightly to $0.98 from $1.00 due to the additional shares issued for the bank acquisitions. Berkshire’s 2011 return on assets was 0.50% and its return on equity was 3.69%; these were little changed from the prior year measures of 0.51% and 3.62%, respectively.

 

Full year results were affected by the timing of the acquisitions and of merger related charges. The fourth quarter of 2011 was the first full quarter to include the operations of the acquired banks. It is therefore viewed as better reflecting the operating benefit of the bank acquisitions. Fourth quarter 2011 return on assets increased to 0.85% and return on equity increased to 6.22%. The improved fourth quarter profitability primarily reflected the benefit of positive operating leverage, with revenue growth exceeding expense growth.

 

In addition to absorbing the costs of business expansion, the Company has maintained a modest asset sensitive interest rate risk profile and has sacrificed higher current income in order to avoid the negative impact of potential future interest rate increases. The Company’s long term objectives are to produce a return on assets exceeding 1% and a return on equity exceeding 10%. The Company is pursuing these objectives while also maintaining an asset sensitive interest rate risk profile which results in lower interest margins in the current environment, and while maintaining its ongoing investment in expansion and infrastructure development to support future revenue and earnings growth.

 

Results in 2011 included $10.4 million in after-tax impact from non-recurring and merger related items and discontinued operations, compared to $0.4 million for such items in the prior year. Excluding these items, recurring net income was $27.9 million ($1.56 per share) in 2011, compared to $14.2 million ($1.02 per share in the prior year). The growth in recurring earnings per share is estimated to be the benefit of positive operating leverage resulting from revenue growth and disciplined expense management, together with the accretive benefit of the Rome and Legacy acquisitions.

 

Berkshire refers to its recurring revenues, expenses, and income excluding the impact of these non-recurring and merger items and discontinued operations. Most of these items were directly related to the mergers of Rome and Legacy and are not ongoing operating revenue and expenses of Berkshire. Berkshire chose to acquire these banks and incur these expenses in order to benefit future income from recurring operations, and they are viewed as part of the economic investment for the acquisition of these franchises. This discussion includes reference to recurring revenue, expense, and income in analyzing 2011 results. These are not GAAP measures and are not intended to substitute for GAAP income and expense measures. Merger related items were within the range of the Company’s expectations. Merger related expenses consisted primarily of severance and benefit related costs related to the change in control of the acquired entities. Merger expenses also included professional fees and contract termination costs.

 

Total Net Revenue. Total net revenue increased by $36 million (33% compared to the comparable prior period measure) to a record level of $142 million in 2011. Net revenue ended the year at a fourth quarter annualized run rate of approximately $160 million, which was a 45% increase over the $110 million annualized run rate in the fourth quarter of 2010 due to the benefit of the mergers and organic growth. Net revenue per share increased by 3% to $7.93 in 2011. Fee income was 24% of net revenue in 2011, compared to 28% in the prior year, as the acquired banks had a higher reliance on net interest income as a revenue source.

 

- 59 -
 

  

Net Interest Income. Net interest income increased by $30 million (38%) to $107 million in 2011 compared to 2010, including the benefit of the bank acquisitions net of discontinued operations. The pro forma revenue analysis disclosed in Note 3 of the consolidated financial statements included components for net interest income and non-interest income. The pro forma net interest income for the combined entities was estimated to be $129 million in both 2010 and 2011, assuming that the mergers had been completed at the beginning of each of those years. Annualized fourth quarter 2011 net interest income was $124 million, which was lower than these pro forma results. This primarily reflected a 5% reduction in total earning assets to $3.5 billion at year-end 2011, compared to the $3.7 billion combined total of the three banks a year earlier. This reduction was primarily due to the impact of the $0.2 million in discontinued operations, along with the reduced use of leverage related to borrowings after the banks were combined.

 

The net interest margin improved to 3.57% in 2011 compared to 3.28% in 2010. The average yield on earning assets decreased to 4.61% in 2011, compared to 4.73% in the prior year, reflecting the ongoing impact of the low interest rate environment on portfolio yields and on the market interest rates assigned to acquired assets. Net interest income in 2011 included $3.2 million in net credits to interest income for accretion of net discounts on acquired loans and $2.1 million in net credits to interest expense related to the amortization of net fair value adjustments for acquired deposits and borrowings. The impact of these credits on net income was mostly offset by charges totaling $4.2 million which were recorded to intangible asset amortization expense.

 

In the ongoing low interest rate environment, the cost of interest bearing liabilities decreased to 1.23% in 2011 compared to 1.72% in the prior year. Additionally, the Company has maintained a close focus on the pricing of loans and deposits in order to mitigate the impact of the tighter margins in the low interest rate environment, and it has pursued strategies to increase low cost deposit funding sources. The cost of deposits decreased to 0.87% in 2011 compared to 1.28% in the prior year, and the fourth quarter 2011 cost of deposits further decreased to 0.73% reflecting these ongoing strategies.

 

The Company adheres to disciplines in pricing its assets and liabilities in order to maintain an appropriate net interest margin while also achieving its asset/liability objectives. The Company strives to maintain a modestly asset sensitive interest rate risk profile so that long term earnings will benefit when interest rates increase from the very low levels that have existed in the most recent years. The current low level of interest rates is generally leading to tighter interest margins in the banking industry. The Company therefore plans to continue to adjust its pricing and to pursue volume growth in conjunction with its long term net interest margin objectives.

 

Non-Interest Income. Non-interest income increased by $6 million (20%) to $36 million in 2011 compared to 2010. Based on the pro forma analysis noted in the consolidated financial statements, pro forma non-interest income for the combined entities was estimated to be $42 million in 2011, compared to $38 million in the prior year. Excluding gains and losses recorded by the combined banks, pro forma non-interest income was approximately $38 million in each of the years 2011 and 2010. Growth in deposit fees income helped to offset the impact of discontinued operations and lower loan fee income. The Company’s total loan related fee income decreased by $0.2 million (7%) in 2011 compared to 2010 due to a $0.8 million decrease in commercial loan interest rate swap fees as a result of lower demand for fixed rate protection in the ongoing low interest rate environment. Deposit related fees increased by $2.8 million (25%) in 2011. Compared to average deposit balances, deposit fees measured 0.50% of average deposits in 2011, compared to 0.53% in the prior year, due primarily to the full year impact of the 2010 adoption of Regulation E affecting overdraft fees. Insurance fee income was flat in 2011, with certain volume gains being offset by ongoing soft insurance premium pricing conditions and lower contingency revenues. The acquired banks had no significant insurance revenues. Wealth management revenues increased by 31% primarily due to the benefit of acquired Legacy operations. Year-end total wealth and investment assets under management increased to nearly $1 billion in 2011 including the acquired Legacy portfolio.

 

- 60 -
 

 

Non-interest income includes bank owned life insurance income and losses on tax credit related equity limited partnership interests. Bank owned life insurance income is based on increases in the cash surrender value of these insurance policies, which were previously described in the Other Assets section of this discussion above. This income was $2.3 million in 2011, compared to $1.4 million in 2010, primarily reflecting the additional acquired policies from the merged banks. Losses on tax credit partnership interests totaled $1.9 million in 2011, compared to $1.4 million in 2010. These losses are more than offset by credits to current period income tax expense which are based on government programs to subsidize the related investments, which include low income housing and solar energy installations. The Company also reported $2.1 million in non-recurring gains in 2011 which primarily related to gains recorded on equity investments in Rome and Legacy which had been made prior to merger discussions as part of the Company’s ongoing program to invest in common stock of regional community banks.

 

Provision for Loan Losses. The provision for loan losses is a charge to earnings in an amount sufficient to maintain the allowance for loan losses at a level deemed adequate by the Company. The level of the allowance is a critical accounting estimate, which is subject to uncertainty. The level of the allowance was included in the discussion of financial condition. The provision for loan losses totaled $8 million in 2011, compared to $9 million in 2010. The provision for loan losses exceeded net loan charge-offs in both years, and resulted in an increase in the allowance for loan losses that was generally related to loan growth.

 

Non-Interest Expense. Total non-interest expense increased by $34 million (42%) to $116 million in 2011 compared to 2010. Most categories of non-interest expense increased as a result of the Rome and Legacy acquisitions in 2011. Non-interest expense in 2011 included $20 million in non-recurring and merger related expenses which were previously described in this discussion of operating results. These expenses included $9 million in compensation and severance related expenses, $5 million in professional services, and $3 million in premises related charges, together with accruals for systems conversion costs. Excluding these items, recurring non-interest expense increased by $15 million (18%). Berkshire estimated that by year-end 2011, it had achieved its targeted recurring non-interest expense savings of 35% related to Rome operations and 42% related to Legacy operations.

 

By holding recurring expense growth below revenue growth, Berkshire produced positive operating leverage and improved recurring profitability. As was previously noted, expense growth in 2011 included the impact of investments in business expansion, including new branches, and targeted resource additions in certain business lines and infrastructure development. The Company measures its recurring non-interest expense in relation to total assets. The comparison of recurring non-interest expense to average assets is a non-GAAP financial measure intended to provide further information about the efficiency of ongoing operations. Fourth quarter annualized recurring non-interest expense measured 2.60% of average assets in 2011, compared to 2.97% in 2010. Full-time equivalent employees totaled 760 at year-end 2011 (excluding staff related to discontinued operations), an increase of 161 compared to 599 at year-end 2010. Full-time equivalent employees of Rome and Legacy totaled 270 at year-end 2010.

 

At the beginning of the second quarter, the FDIC implemented new banking industry deposit insurance assessment rates and formulas. This change reduced FDIC insurance expense, which measured 0.12% of average deposits in 2011, compared to 0.17% in 2010. Expense of other real estate owned increased in 2011 primarily due to write-downs of foreclosed real estate. Amortization of intangible assets increased due primarily to the core deposit intangibles recorded for the bank acquisitions.

 

- 61 -
 

 

Income from Continuing Operations. Income from continuing operations increased by $3 million (20%) to $17 million in 2011 compared to 2010. The effective tax rate on income from continuing operations was 11% in 2011 compared to 16% in 2010. As discussed in the consolidated financial statements, results in 2011 and prior years included the impact of an accounting error correction related to the tax credit limited partnerships which was not material to the financial statements. This tax credit, which equated to a 7% effective credit to the 2011 effective tax rate, was previously reported as a component of non-interest income. Before this credit, the effective tax rate from continuing operations was 18% in 2011 compared to 21% in 2010. The decrease in 2011 reflects the benefit of non-taxable gains on the Rome and Legacy acquisitions.

   

Income from Discontinued Operations. Income from discontinued operations was $914 thousand in 2011. Discontinued operations related to branches held for divestiture in the second half of 2011. Four of these branches were divested in the fourth quarter and the remaining four were divested in January 2012. The divestiture in 2011 resulted in a $4.9 million pre-tax gain. The tax rate on discontinued operations was 80% due to the non-deductibility of goodwill for income tax purposes in determining the taxable gain on divestiture. Primarily as a result of this higher tax rate on discontinued operations, the effective tax rate on total continuing and discontinued operations increased to 25% in 2011 from 16% in prior year.

  

Results of Segment and Parent Operations. Berkshire Hills Bancorp (“the Parent”) has two subsidiary operating segments – banking and insurance. Results in the banking segment generally followed the levels and trends of consolidated results, which have been previously discussed. In the insurance segment, revenues decreased by 1% due to ongoing soft pricing conditions and reduced contingency fees in the industry. Expenses decreased by 7%, and as a result, insurance segment net income increased by 28%. The Parent’s net interest income included dividends from the insurance segment. Parent non-interest expense increased due primarily to professional fees related to the bank acquisitions. Most of the parent’s revenues are non-taxable revenues from subsidiaries, and the Parent therefore receives a tax benefit related to the taxable loss generated by its expenses.

 

Total Comprehensive Income. Total comprehensive income includes net income together with other net comprehensive income (loss). The latter measures changes in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income, which consist of changes (after-tax) in the unrealized market gains and losses on securities available for sale and the net gain (loss) on derivative instruments used as cash flow hedges, including a terminated hedge. The Company recorded comprehensive income of $19 million due primarily to $18 million in net income discussed previously. Comprehensive income in 2010 was $10 million, including net income of $14 million which was partially offset by an other comprehensive loss relating to unrealized losses on derivatives instruments due to ongoing low interest rates.

 

COMPARISON OF OPERATING RESULTS FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2010 AND 2009

 

Summary. The Company recorded earnings of $14 million in 2010, compared to a loss of $16 million in 2009. Results in 2009 included a $48 million provision for loan losses, which decreased to $9 million in 2010. The loan loss provision in 2009 included the results of a fourth quarter loan initiative undertaken by management resulting in a comprehensive loan review to assess the impacts of the recession and to take actions to reduce current and future risk.

 

On a per share basis, the Company recorded earnings of $1.00 per share in 2010 compared to a loss of $1.51 in 2009. In 2009, per share results were impacted by preferred dividends in the first half of the year, which reduced income available to common shareholders by $0.30 per share.

 

Financial highlights in 2010 included: 13% net revenue growth; 11% net interest income growth; 6% fee income growth; 9% loan growth; 11% deposit growth; and 4% expense growth including costs of business expansion

 

Reflecting the improved earnings, the return on assets was 0.51% and the return on average common equity was 3.62% in 2010. In addition to absorbing the costs of business expansion, the Company maintained a modest asset sensitive interest rate risk profile and sacrificed higher current income in order to avoid the negative impact of anticipated future interest rate increases.

 

- 62 -
 

 

Total Net Revenue. The Company achieved $107 million total of net revenue in 2010. The record net revenue in 2010 was due to record net interest income totaling $77 million. Net revenue per share increased by 7% to $7.68 in 2010 from $7.19 in the prior year. Fee income was 28% of total net revenue in 2010, down slightly from 30% in the prior year.

 

Net Interest Income. Net interest income increased by $7 million (11%) to $77 million in 2010. Most of this increase was due to an improvement in the net interest margin to 3.28% in 2010 from 3.00% in 2009. Additionally, net interest income benefited from a 2% increase in average earning assets resulting from the 2% increase in average loans. The improvement in the net interest margin resulted largely from the Company’s strategies to reduce funding costs and included the benefit of prepayments made at the end of 2009 on certain borrowings. Both asset yields and funding costs decreased during the year due to the effects of the ongoing low interest rate environment. Funding costs were reduced at a greater rate, and both deposit and borrowings costs declined during the year. This produced a steady improvement in the net interest margin from 3.05% in the fourth quarter of 2009 to 3.30% in the final two quarters of 2010. At the start of 2010, the Company’s interest rate model indicated that the margin would be under further pressure if interest rates did not increase in 2010. The Company undertook various initiatives previously described to offset this margin pressure and to increase the net interest margin towards its long term goal of 3.50%.

 

Non-Interest Income. Non-interest income increased by $5 million (18%) to $30 million in 2010 due to a similar increase in fee income. A $2 million increase in loan fee income included increases in net residential mortgage loan sale income, mortgage servicing income, and commercial lending fees. Total deposit related fees increased by $1 million (7%) in 2010 due primarily to higher business volumes. Amendments to Regulation E requiring customer opt-in for eligibility for certain overdraft privileges became effective in the third quarter of 2010 for all banks. The Company aggressively solicited checking account customers to obtain opt-ins in order to minimize the potential negative impact on overdraft volume and fee income, with more than 80% of solicited accounts choosing the opt-in. Additionally, the Company made other changes to its checking account offerings. The fourth quarter of 2010 was the first complete quarter following the implementation of this regulatory change. Total checking and related fee income was flat in the fourth quarter of 2010 compared to 2009, reflecting the Company’s strategy to avoid any negative income impact from this regulatory change. Insurance fee income decreased by $1 million (9%) due primarily to lower contingency fee income, as well as lower premium income, related to the soft pricing and profitability conditions in the property casualty insurance business. Insurance results also include the impact of lower premium volumes as a result of the recession and competitive auto insurance conditions, which was partially offset by growth in commercial insurance accounts in 2010. In the fourth quarter of the year, insurance premium income increased by 8% over the prior year comparable period, reflecting improved business conditions in the most recent period. For the year 2010, wealth management income decreased by 7% due to competitive factors. The decrease in all other non-interest income was primarily due to decreased losses on tax credit limited partnership interests, which are offset by credits to income tax expense. In 2009, the $1 million charge for non-recurring non-interest income items included prepayment fees, a swap termination gain, and a credit for a merger termination fee.

 

Provision for Loan Losses. The provision for loan losses totaled $9 million in 2010, compared to $48 million in 2009. In 2010, the provision for loan losses slightly exceeded total net loan charge-offs for the year. The level and trend of most asset quality indicators remained favorable throughout 2010. There was no material change in the balance of the loan loss allowance. Reflecting the improved credit characteristics of the loan portfolio, the ratio of the allowance to total loans decreased to 1.49% in 2010, compared to 1.62% at the start of the year.

 

- 63 -
 

 

Non-Interest Expense and Income Tax Expense. Total non-interest expense increased by $3 million (4%) in 2010 compared to 2009. By holding expense growth below revenue growth, the Company produced positive operating leverage. which contributed to the 55% increase in pre-tax pre-provision earnings from year to year. As was previously noted, expense growth in 2010 included the impact of investments in business expansion, including new business lines, new branches, and targeted resource additions in certain business lines and infrastructure development. The Company measures its recurring non-interest expense in relation to total assets. Compared to average assets, this measure increased to 2.97% in 2010 from 2.93% in the prior year. However, most asset growth was in the second half of the year, and compared to year-end assets, this measure declined to 2.82% from 2.89%.

 

The increase in non-interest expense in 2010 resulted from a $6 million (15%) increase in compensation related expense, which was partially offset by decreases of $1 million (21%) in marketing and professional services and $1 million (25%) in FDIC insurance expense. All other total non-interest expenses were flat from year-to-year. In addition to business growth, compensation related expense in 2010 included a $2 million increase for the restoration of incentive compensation, which was substantially eliminated in 2009 due to the operating loss. Additionally, 2010 compensation related expense included $2 million related to severance charges and a decrease in compensation cost credited against expense and charged against loan sales income due to the mortgage refinancing wave in 2009. Excluding the above items, all other compensation related expense increased by $2 million, which was equivalent to a 4% increase over 2009 total compensation related expense. The Company had 599 full time equivalent employees at year-end 2010, compared to 622 at the end of 2009.

 

The $1 million decrease in marketing and professional fees was due to the higher professional fees in 2009 related to strategic initiatives undertaken in the fourth quarter of that year. The $1 million decrease in FDIC insurance expense was due to a special assessment levied in 2009 on all banks based on their size. Non-recurring expense in 2010 consisted of charges related to the pending merger agreements with Rome Bancorp and Legacy Bancorp. Nonrecurring expense in 2009 included costs associated with the terminated merger agreement with CNB Financial Corp. and other charges related to operational restructurings together with a legal settlement related charge.

 

The Company’s effective income tax rate was 16% in 2010 and included the proportionately greater benefit of tax exempt income on investment securities and other tax preference items compared to total pre-tax income. The Company recorded a $16 million income tax benefit in 2009, measuring 49% of the pre-tax loss.

 

Results of Segment and Parent Operations. Results in the banking segment generally followed the levels and trends of consolidated results, which have been previously discussed. In the insurance segment, revenues declined by 9% as a result of non-interest income changes previously discussed. Due to re-engineering of the operations in this segment, non-interest expenses decreased by 8% in 2010. Insurance segment earnings decreased by 9%. Fourth quarter insurance revenues increased by 8% in 2010 compared to 2009, and the Company expected improved non-contingency income in the future due to improved market conditions and business development. The parent did not receive dividends from subsidiaries in 2010; the parent had $13 million in cash on deposit at the Bank at year-end 2010. The charge to non-interest income for the parent in 2010 represented interest on the trust preferred securities and non-interest expense included $0.4 million in charges related to the pending merger agreements with Rome Bancorp and Legacy Bancorp.

 

Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Comprehensive (loss) income is a component of total stockholders’ equity on the balance sheet. It includes changes in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income, which consist of changes (after-tax) in the unrealized market gains and losses on securities available for sale and the net gain (loss) on derivative instruments used as cash flow hedges, including a terminated hedge. The Company recorded comprehensive income of $10 million in 2010, compared to a comprehensive loss of $7 million in 2009. In 2010, net income of $14 million was partially offset by an other comprehensive loss relating to unrealized losses on derivatives instruments due to ongoing low interest rates. In 2009, the $16 million operating loss was partially offset by unrealized gains in the prices of securities and derivatives instruments. These results reflected the impact on interest rates and market prices of the financial turmoil in the second half of 2008 and the partial recovery to more normalized market conditions in 2009.

 

- 64 -
 

 

Average Balances, Interest and Average Yields/Cost

 

The following table presents an analysis of average rates and yields on a fully taxable equivalent basis for the years presented. Tax exempt interest revenue is shown on a tax-equivalent basis for proper comparison using a statutory federal income tax rate of 35%.

 

Item 7-7A - Table 1 - Average Balance and Weighted Average Interest Rates
       2011           2010           2009     
           Average           Average           Average 
   Average       Yield/   Average       Yield/   Average       Yield/ 
(Dollars in millions)  Balance   Interest   Rate   Balance   Interest   Rate   Balance   Interest   Rate 
                                     
Interest-earning assets:                                             
Loans:                                             
Residential Loans  $876.1   $42.5    4.85%  $633.6   $32.9    5.19%  $642.9   $34.7    5.40%
Commercial Mortgages   1,058.0    52.9    5.00    881.9    43.3    4.91    829.3    42.3    5.10 
Commercial Business Loans   344.3    16.5    4.79    204.0    10.5    5.15    177.8    10.0    5.62 
Consumer Loans   336.7    13.4    3.98    299.9    11.7    3.90    332.5    14.7    4.42 
Total Loans   2,615.1    125.3    4.79    2,019.4    98.4    4.87    1,982.5    101.7    5.13 
Investment securities (2)   444.9    16.5    3.71    403.5    16.7    4.14    368.5    16.0    4.34 
Federal funds sold and short-term investments   14.7    -    0.11    11.4    -    0.14    42.1    0.1    0.24 
Total interest-earning assets   3,074.7    141.8    4.61    2,434.3    115.1    4.73    2,393.1    117.8    4.92 
Intangible assets   207.5              174.5              177.6           
Other non-interest earning assets   201.8              134.2              112.2           
Total assets  $3,484.0             $2,743.0             $2,682.9           
                                              
Interest-bearing liabilities:                                             
Deposits:                                             
NOW accounts  $244.2   $0.9    0.37%  $199.3   $0.7     0.4%  $188.2   $0.8    0.43%
Money market accounts   833.3    5.6    0.67    597.3    5.6    0.94    499.6    6.4    1.28 
Savings accounts   369.6    0.8    0.22    224.3    0.6    0.27    212.3    0.7    0.33 
Certificates of deposit   902.6    16.3    1.81    749.2    19.4    2.59    777.1    24.7    3.18 
Total interest-bearing deposits   2,349.7    23.6    1.00    1,770.1    26.3    1.49    1,677.2    32.6    1.94 
Borrowings and debentures   250.4    8.4    3.35    282.0    9.0    3.19    312.9    13.3    4.25 
Total interest-bearing liabilities   2,600.1    32.0    1.23    2,052.1    35.3    1.72    1,990.1    45.9    2.31 
Deposits:                                             
deposits   377.9              279.1              256.4           
Other non-interest-bearing                                             
liabilities   29.8              28.7              24.2           
Total liabilities   3,007.8              2,359.9              2,270.7           
Equity   476.2              383.1              412.2           
Total liabilities and equity  $3,484.0             $2,743.0             $2,682.9           
Net interest-earning assets  $474.6             $382.2             $403.0           
Net interest income        109.8              79.8              71.9      
                                              
Supplementary data                                             
Total non-maturity deposits  $1,825.0             $1,300.0             $1,156.5           
Total deposits   2,727.6              2,049.2              1,933.6           
Fully taxable equivalent adjustment   2.7              2.8              2.3           
                                              
Interest rate spread             3.38%             3.01%             2.61%
Net interest margin             3.57              3.28              3.00 
Cost of funds             1.08              1.52              2.04 
Cost of deposits             0.87              1.28              1.69 
Interest-earning assets/interest-bearing liabilities             118.25              118.62              120.25 

 

Notes:

(1)The average balances of loans includes nonaccrual loans, loans held for sale, and deferred fees and costs.
(2)The average balance of investment securities is based on amortized cost. The average balance of equity also reflects this adjustment.
(3)The above schedule includes balances associated with discontinued operations.

 

- 65 -
 

 

Rate/Volume Analysis

 

The following table presents the effects of rate and volume changes on the fully taxable equivalent net interest income.  Tax exempt interest revenue is shown on a tax-equivalent basis for proper comparison using a statutory, federal income tax rate of 35%.  For each category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, information is provided with respect to changes attributable to (1) changes in rate (change in rate multiplied by prior year volume), (2) changes in volume (change in volume multiplied by prior year rate) and (3) changes in volume/rate (change in rate multiplied by change in volume) have been allocated proportionately based on the absolute value of the change due to the rate and the change due to volume.

 

Item 7-7A - Table 2 - Rate Volume Analysis                 
   2011 Compared with 2010   2010 Compared with 2009 
   Increase (Decrease) Due to   Increase (Decrease) Due to 
(In thousands)  Rate   Volume   Net   Rate   Volume   Net 
                         
Interest income:                              
Residential Loans  $(2,262)  $11,879   $9,617   $(1,341)  $(498)  $(1,839)
Commercial Mortgage Loans   861    8,796    9,657    (1,643)   2,620    977 
Commercial Business Loans   (817)   6,764    5,947    (867)   1,397    530 
Consumer Loans   232    1,457    1,689    (1,647)   (1,367)   (3,014)
Total Loans   (1,986)   28,896    26,910    (5,497)   2,151    (3,346)
Investment securities   (1,826)   1,626    (200)   (773)   1,466    693 
Short-term investments   (4)   4    -    (47)   (53)   (100)
Total interest income   (3,816)   30,526    26,710    (6,316)   3,563    (2,753)
                               
Interest expense:                              
NOW accounts   62    169    231    (137)   45    (92)
Money market accounts   (1,774)   1,842    68    (1,945)   1,109    (836)
Savings accounts   (98)   333    235    (154)   38    (116)
Certificates of deposit   (6,660)   3,492    (3,168)   (4,395)   (859)   (5,254)
Total deposits   (8,470)   5,836    (2,634)   (6,631)   333    (6,298)
Borrowings   400    (1,045)   (645)   (3,032)   (1,220)   (4,252)
Total interest expense   (8,070)   4,791    (3,279)   (9,663)   (887)   (10,550)
Change in net interest income  $4,254   $25,735   $29,989   $3,347   $4,450    7,797 

Changes in volume/rate (change in rate multiplied by change in volume) have been allocated proportionately based on the absolute value of the change due to the rate and the change due to volume.

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

Liquidity is the ability to meet cash needs at all times with available cash or by conversion of other assets to cash at a reasonable price and in a timely manner. At year-end 2011, the parent company had $16 million in cash and equivalents, compared to $13 million at the start of the year. This cash was held on deposit in the Bank. The primary ongoing source of funding for the parent company is dividend payments from the Bank and from Berkshire Insurance Group. There were no dividend payments from the Bank in 2011; Berkshire Insurance Group paid $4 million in dividends to the parent company in 2011. Additional potential sources of liquidity are proceeds from borrowings and capital offerings, and from stock option exercises. The main uses of liquidity are the payment of common stockholder dividends, routine operating expenses, debt service on outstanding borrowings and debentures, purchases of treasury stock, and business acquisitions. In 2011, business acquisitions were both sources and uses of cash at the parent. Sources and uses of cash at the parent are reported in the condensed financial statements of the parent company included in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. There are certain restrictions on the payment of dividends by the Bank as discussed in the Stockholders’ Equity note to the consolidated financial statements. At the beginning of 2011, under state statutes and based on its condition at that date, the Bank’s retained earnings were $8 million below the statutory amount necessary to be eligible to pay dividends from future earnings. At the beginning of 2012, including the benefit of 2011 net income, the Bank was eligible to pay dividends from existing and future retained earnings. In the past, the parent has maintained credit facilities with correspondent banks and such facilities may be arranged in the future.

 

- 66 -
 

 

The Bank’s primary source of liquidity is customer deposits and the main use of liquidity is the funding of loans and lending commitments. Additional routine sources are borrowings, repayments of loans and investment securities, and the sale and repayments of investment securities. The Bank also utilizes the mortgage secondary market, and primarily the federal mortgage agencies, as a source of funds for residential mortgages which are sold into that market. The Bank closely monitors its liquidity position on a daily basis. Sources of borrowings include advances from the FHLBB and borrowings at the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston. As of year-end 2011, based on its arrangements and collateral amounts, the Bank had potential borrowing capacity totaling $667 million with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston. At year-end 2011, the utilization of borrowings decreased during the year in part due to the benefit of 10% organic deposit growth. One general measure of liquidity is the loan/deposit ratio, which stood at 95% at year-end 2011 compared to 97% at the start of the year – a lower ratio generally indicates more liquidity. Additionally, as a result of the bank acquisitions in 2011, the Company believes that it has further improved its access to sources of liquidity and capital, including the benefits of branch expansion and a higher volume of issued and outstanding common stock.

 

The greatest sources of uncertainty affecting liquidity are deposit withdrawals and usage of loan commitments, which are influenced by interest rates, economic conditions, and competition. Under the 2010 Dodd-Frank Act, FDIC deposit insurance limits were permanently increased from $100 thousand to $250 thousand and transaction accounts were provided with unlimited insurance through December 31, 2012. Additionally, the Bank offers 100% insurance on all deposit balances as a result of the combination of FDIC insurance and the Massachusetts Depositors Insurance Fund. The Bank also relies on competitive rates, customer service, and long-standing relationships with customers to manage deposit and loan liquidity. Based on its historical experience, management believes that it has adequately provided for deposit and loan liquidity needs. Both liquidity and capital resources are managed according to policies approved by the Board of Directors and executive management and the Board review liquidity metrics and contingency plans on a regular basis.

 

The Bank must satisfy various regulatory capital requirements. Additionally, the Parent will need to satisfy additional regulatory capital requirements in 2012 due to the change in its supervision from the Office of Thrift Supervision to the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston. Regulatory capital requirements are discussed in the Regulation and Supervision section of Item 1, in the Risk Factors discussion, and in the Stockholders’ Equity note to the consolidated financial statements. Please also see management’s discussion of financial condition for additional information about liquidity and capital at year-end 2011. In the fourth quarter of 2009, the Company filed a universal shelf registration with the Securities and Exchange Commission for the issuance of up to $150 million in securities, including debt securities, common stock, or preferred stock. This registration replaced an earlier $125 million universal shelf registration. The Company has not issued any securities under this latest registration, and does not have any specific plans for issuances under this registration, which expires in the fourth quarter of 2012.

 

- 67 -
 

 

Berkshire views its earnings and related internal capital generation as a primary source of capital to support dividends and growth of the franchise. Additionally, the Company generally uses the issuance of common stock as the primary source of consideration for bank acquisitions, and such acquisitions may result in net increases or decreases in its capital ratios. In 2011, the bank acquisitions resulted in a net increase in the Company’s capital ratios. Berkshire’s long term objective is to generate a double digit core annual return on equity, and the Company evaluates lending, investment, and acquisition decisions with an objective of returning double digit returns on the equity utilized to support these activities. In the fourth quarter of 2011, Berkshire’s Board of Directors established a new Capital Committee, which is responsible for assisting the Board in planning for future capital needs and for ensuring compliance with regulations pertaining to capital structure and levels. In 2011, Berkshire increased its outstanding shares by 50% from 14.4 million to 21.1 million due to the issuance of merger consideration. The Company believes that this provides further liquidity and visibility to its common stock, and that the market for its stock is an additional capital resource over the long run. Additionally, the Company regularly evaluates market conditions for Tier Two regulatory capital such as preferred stock or subordinated debt, which are additional potential future capital resources to the Company and/or the Bank.

 

Contractual Obligations. The year-end 2011 contractual obligations were as follows:

 

Item 7-7A - Table 3 - Contractual Obligations

 

       Less than One   One to Three   Three to Five   After Five 
(In thousands)  Total   Year   Years   Years   Years 
                     
FHLBB borrowings (1)  $221,937   $44,940   $106,418   $20,000   $50,579 
Junior subordinated debentures   15,464    15,464    -    -    - 
Operating lease obligations (2)   60,981    3,773    7,641    7,260    42,307 
Purchase obligations (3)   28,639    6,610    10,510    7,685    3,834 
Total Contractual Obligations  $327,021   $70,787   $124,569   $34,945   $96,720 

 

Merger related obligations are not included.

(1)Consists of borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank. The maturities extend through 2027 and the rates vary by borrowing.
(2)Consists of leases, bank branches and ATMs through 2031.
(3)Consists of obligations with multiple vendors to purchase a broad range of services and other items.

 

Further information about borrowings and lease obligations is in the notes on borrowings and commitments to the financial statements. There was no change in the debenture obligation. Operating lease obligations increased due to the Company’s expansion. Purchase obligations increased significantly due to a seven-year licensing and maintenance contract with Fidelity Information Services, LLC, which was executed in connection with the Company’s planned core bank processing system conversion during 2012.

 

Pending Merger Agreement. In the fourth quarter of 2011, Berkshire announced a merger agreement with CBT – The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company. This acquisition is expected to be completed in the second quarter of 2012, subject to regulatory and CBT shareholder approvals. This agreement is discussed in the Mergers and Acquisitions Note of the consolidated financial statements and elsewhere in this Item 7. The acquisition is subject to the approval of shareholders and various regulatory authorities. Berkshire expects to issue approximately 965 thousand shares of common stock and to pay approximately $10 million in cash as consideration for this acquisition. Berkshire expects to use existing cash balances to finance this cash consideration. Additionally, in 2012 the Company entered into an agreement to acquire the assets of a mortgage banking company in Eastern Massachusetts and to undertake mortgage originations activities using the operating name and team from this company. This acquisition is not expected to have a significant effect on the Company’s financial condition.

 

- 68 -
 

 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements. In the normal course of operations, the Company engages in a variety of financial transactions that, in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, are not recorded in the Company’s financial statements. These transactions involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit, interest rate and liquidity risk. Such transactions are used primarily to manage customers’ requests for funding and take the form of loan commitments and lines of credit. Off-balance sheet activities are described in a related note to the consolidated financial statements. For 2011 and 2010, the Company did not engage in any off-balance sheet transactions reasonably likely to have a material effect on the Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows, aside from the merger agreements with Rome, Legacy, and CBT.

 

Fair Value Measurements. The Company records fair value measurements of certain assets and liabilities, as described in the related note in the financial statements. Recurring fair values of financial instruments primarily relate to securities and derivative instruments. A valuation hierarchy is utilized based on generally accepted accounting principles. Measurements based on Level 3 inputs rely the most on subjective management judgments. Level 3 recurring measurements relate primarily to the $17 million fair value of a local tax advantaged economic development bond issued to a Berkshire County non-profit, which is classified as a trading security. Changes in the fair value of this security are recorded in non-interest income, as are offsetting changes in the accompanying interest rate swap. Non-recurring fair value measurements primarily relate to securities held to maturity, restricted equity securities, impaired loans, and goodwill and other intangibles. When measurement is required, these measures are generally based on Level 3 inputs. Non-recurring fair values of financial instruments relate primarily to impairment analysis of economic development bonds recorded as held-to-maturity, restricted equity securities, and loans. The only assets deemed impaired were $17 million in loans, which were evaluated based on Level 3 inputs, which gave rise to a $3 million impairment reserve at year-end 2011. Fair value measurements of non-financial assets and liabilities primarily relate to impairment analyses of intangibles and goodwill. The Company performed an impairment analysis of its goodwill in the most recent quarter, and determined that there was no impairment at year-end 2011. The Company also provides a summary of estimated fair values of financial instruments at each quarter-end. The category of financial assets with the most significant difference between carrying value and fair value is the net loan category. The fair value of loans is estimated to be a $66 million (2%) premium to carrying value at year-end 2011, compared to a $58 million (3%) discount to carrying value at year-end 2010. This improvement reflected the improved credit profile of the loan portfolio in 2011, along with the impact of lower medium term rates and market pricing spreads for loans. Of note, loans acquired in bank acquisitions were recorded at fair value at the time of acquisition, whereas the carrying value of historical loans is based on cost. Regarding the total fair value of deposits, borrowings, and debenture, there was no significant difference between fair value and carrying amount at either year-end. The excess fair value of deposits over carrying amount was eliminated primarily due to the ongoing runoff of higher costing time deposits. Due to the premium value of loans in 2011, the combined impact of the above fair value estimates reflected an overall improvement in the economic value of equity related to these instruments, based solely on the measures utilized for the purpose of this analysis.

 

Impact of Inflation and Changing PriceS

 

The financial statements and related financial data presented in this Form 10-K have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars, without considering changes in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation. Unlike many industrial companies, substantially all of the assets and liabilities of the Bank are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates have a more significant impact on the Bank’s performance than the general level of inflation. Interest rates may be affected by inflation, but the direction and magnitude of the impact may vary. A sudden change in inflation (or expectations about inflation), with a related change in interest rates, would have a significant impact on our operations.

 

- 69 -
 

 

Impact of New Accounting Pronouncements

 

Please refer to the note on Recent Accounting Pronouncements in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements for a detailed discussion of new accounting pronouncements.

 

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

 

Management of Interest Rate Risk and Market Risk Analysis

 

Qualitative Aspects of Market Risk. The Company’s most significant form of market risk is interest rate risk. The Company seeks to avoid fluctuations in its net interest income and to maximize net interest income within acceptable levels of risk through periods of changing interest rates. The Company maintains an Asset/Liability Committee that is responsible for reviewing its asset/liability policies and interest rate risk position. This Committee meets monthly and reports trends and interest rate risk position to the Risk Management Committee and Board of Directors on a quarterly basis. The extent of the movement of interest rates is an uncertainty that could have a negative impact on the Company’s earnings. The Company has managed interest rate risk by emphasizing assets with shorter-term repricing durations, periodically selling long term fixed-rate assets, promoting low cost core deposits, and using FHLBB advances to structure its liability repricing durations. The Company also uses interest rate swaps in order to enhance its interest rate risk position and manage its balance sheet.

 

Quantitative Aspects of Market Risk. The Company uses a simulation model to measure the potential change in net interest income that would result from both an instantaneous or ramped change in market interest rates assuming a parallel shift along the entire yield curve. The chart below shows the analysis of a ramped change. Loans, deposits and borrowings were expected to reprice at the repricing or maturity date. The Company uses prepayment guidelines set forth by market sources as well as Company generated data where applicable. Cash flows from loans and securities are assumed to be reinvested based on current operating conditions and strategies. Other assumptions about balance sheet mix are generally held constant. No material changes have been made to the methodologies used in the model.

 

Item 7-7A - Table 4 - Qualitative Aspects of Market Risk        
Change in                
Interest Rates-Basis  1- 12 Months   13- 24 Months 
Points (Rate Ramp)  $ Change   % Change   $ Change   % Change 
(In thousands)                
At December 31, 2011                    
+ 300  $4,882    4.22%  $13,470    12.36%
+ 200   2,977    2.57    9,340    8.57 
+ 100   1,283    1.11    4,304    3.95 
- 100   (2,408)   (2.08)   (9,475)   (8.69)
                     
At December 31, 2010                    
+ 300  $3,413    4.34%  $8,780    11.38%
+ 200   2,047    2.60    5,934    7.69 
+ 100   1,497    1.90    4,528    5.87 
- 100   (1,510)   (1.92)   (6,254)   (8.11)

 

- 70 -
 

 

At year-end 2011, there were no significant changes in the indicators of near term net interest income at risk as shown in the table above. The table shows that Berkshire has maintained a moderately asset sensitive interest rate risk profile. With this profile, net interest income will increase if interest rates rise and net interest income will decline if they fall (assuming a parallel shift in the yield curve and unchanged market spreads to treasuries for various categories of assets and liabilities). Short term U.S. treasury rates are currently near zero and the Federal Reserve Bank has indicated an expectation that they will be maintained at these levels through most of 2014. The Company views it as unlikely that short term rates will decrease significantly from current levels.

 

The addition of Rome and Legacy increased interest bearing assets and liabilities, but did not materially change modeled interest rate sensitivity of net interest income. Based on Berkshire’s review of Rome’s balance sheet and balance sheet changes subsequent to the merger, Berkshire models that the interest rate risk of Rome’s operations was modestly liability sensitive. Legacy’s analysis at the same date demonstrated modest liability sensitivity. After integrating these two banks and restructuring the borrowings and securities, Berkshire estimates that there has been no material change to its measures of its asset sensitivity after completing these mergers. This is consistent with its earlier estimates and includes the impact of $40 million in new forward starting interest rate swaps in 2011, which have the effect of limiting the impact of potential future higher interest rates on funding costs. Berkshire does not expect any material change in its interest rate sensitivity based on the anticipated acquisition and integration of The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company in the second quarter of 2012. The Company also estimates the sensitivity of the economic value of its equity to interest rate shocks. At year-end 2011, the Company estimated that this measure would decrease by approximately 7% in the event of a 300 basis point upward interest rate shock, which was well within the Company’s policy limits. The decrease reflects the impact of fixed rate assets on medium and long term modeled net income if interest rates increase. This estimate is subject to numerous assumptions and uncertainties and is not intended as a projection of future operating results.

 

The market is expected to experience some general yield compression if short term rates remain near zero for the next three years and if international and other economic events continue to hold down long term U.S. interest rates. The Company expects that interest rates will increase over the medium term from currently suppressed levels and that there is the potential for rate spikes based on economic or financial shocks in the domestic and global markets. Berkshire continues to target ongoing loan growth as it pursues its market share acquisition strategies. Part of this growth is expected to include growth in residential mortgages, which are primarily fixed rate instruments. The interest rate risk impact of this growth will be somewhat offset by commercial loan growth, which tends to emphasize adjustable rate loans, including LIBOR based loans. The Company anticipates that its asset sensitivity (based on its model for net interest income sensitivity) may move towards a more neutral position, while still remaining asset sensitive. The Company’s long term target is to maintain a net interest margin above 3.50%, and this objective will be balanced with the Company’s interest rate risk management and with its goals to increase low cost transaction account funds sources.

 

Berkshire has a number of business strategies to increase net interest income despite the potential for tighter market yields. These include changes in volumes and mix of interest bearing assets and liabilities, some of which are discussed above. The Company also evaluates its pricing strategies on an ongoing basis, and considers its investment, borrowings, and derivatives strategies in managing its income and risk profile. Due to the limitations and uncertainties relating to model assumptions, the modeled computations should not be relied on as projections of income. Further, the computations do not reflect any actions that management may undertake in response to changes in interest rates. The most significant assumption relates to expectations for the interest sensitivity of non-maturity deposit accounts in a rising rate environment. The model assumes that deposit rate sensitivity will be a percentage of the market interest rate change. The rate sensitivity depends on the underlying amount of market rate change and the type of deposit account. The percentage rate movements are as follows: NOW accounts–ranging between 0% and 35%; money market accounts–ranging between 30% and 70%; and savings accounts–ranging between 25% and 50%. One of the significant limitations of the simulation is that it assumes parallel shifts in the yield curve. Actual interest rate risks are often more complex than this scenario. Due to the extraordinary fiscal and monetary interventions in the domestic and international markets since 2008, there is elevated uncertainty about future market conditions and about customer demand and behaviors in the event of future interest rate changes. Assumption changes in 2011 were based on a review of past performance and future expectations and were not viewed as material.

 

- 71 -
 

 

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

 

 

The financial statements and supplementary data required by this item are presented elsewhere in this report beginning on page F-1, in the order shown below:

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting F-1
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm F-2
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 F-4
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 F-5
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 F-6
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 F-7
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements F-9

 

- 72 -
  

 

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

 

 

On February 24, 2011, the Company's Audit Committee dismissed Wolf & Company, P.C. ("Wolf & Company") as the Company's principal accountants for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2011, and all quarterly periods therein. The Company's Audit Committee participated in, and approved the decision to change its independent registered public accounting firm.

 

The audit reports of Wolf & Company on the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of and for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 did not contain an adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion, and were not qualified or modified, or expected to be modified or qualified, as to uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principles.

 

During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 and the subsequent interim period through February 24, 2011, there were no: (1) disagreements with Wolf & Company on any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreements, if not resolved to Wolf & Company’s satisfaction, would have caused Wolf & Company to make reference in connection with its opinion to the subject matter, or (2) reportable events under Item 304(a)(1)(v) of Regulation S-K.

 

Also on February 24, 2011, the Company engaged PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (“PwC”) as the Company's principal accountants starting with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2011.  The engagement was approved by the Company's Audit Committee.  During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the subsequent interim period prior to the engagement of PwC, the Company did not consult with PwC, regarding any of the matters or events set forth in Item 304(a)(2)(i) and (ii) of Regulation S-K.

 

- 73 -
 

 

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

 

The Company’s management, including the Company’s Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s “disclosure controls and procedures,” as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15(d) - 15(e) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (the “Exchange Act”) as of December 31, 2011. Based upon their evaluation, the Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer concluded that, as of that date, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective for the purpose of ensuring that the information required to be disclosed in the reports that the Company files or submits under the Exchange Act with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) (1) is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and (2) is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

CHANGES IN INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

During the most recent quarter, the Company converted the Legacy core processing systems to the Company’s systems. Additionally, during the quarter, the Company utilized temporary accounting resources as a result of vacancies in its Controller position and in other Accounting Department positions. The Company evaluated the changes in its internal control over financial reporting during the most recent fiscal quarter and concluded that there was no change that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting and the independent registered public accounting firm’s report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting are contained in “Item 8 – Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

 

 

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

 

 

None.

 

- 74 -
 

 

PART III

 

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS, AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

 

For information concerning the directors of the Company, the information contained under the sections captioned “Proposals to be Voted on by Stockholders – Proposal 1 - Election of Directors” in Berkshire’s Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders (“Proxy Statement”) is incorporated by reference.

 

The following table sets forth certain information regarding the executive officers of the Company.

 

Name   Age   Position
         
Michael P. Daly   50   President and Chief Executive Officer
Kevin P. Riley   52   Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, and Treasurer
Patrick J. Sullivan   56   Executive Vice President, Commercial Banking and Wealth Management
Richard M. Marotta   53   Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer
Sean A. Gray   35   Executive Vice President, Retail Banking
Linda A. Johnston   59   Executive Vice President, Human Resources

 

The executive officers are elected annually and hold office until their successors have been elected and qualified or until they are removed or replaced. Mr. Daly is employed pursuant to a three-year employment agreement which renews automatically if not otherwise terminated pursuant to its terms.

 

Biographical Information

 

Michael P. Daly has served as President and Chief Executive Officer since October 2002. Before these appointments, Mr. Daly served as Executive Vice President and Senior Loan Officer of the Bank. He has been an employee since 1986. He has served as a Director of the Company and the Bank since 2002.

 

Kevin P. Riley has served as Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, and Treasurer since joining the Company in August 2007. Mr. Riley also manages the Company’s Project Management department . Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Riley was Executive Vice President for Client Information and Relationship Management with KeyCorp. Previously from 1996 to 2002, he served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of KeyBank National Association.

 

Patrick J. Sullivan has served as Executive Vice President of Commercial Banking and Wealth Management since joining the Company in July 2011. Prior to that, he was President and Chief Executive Officer of Legacy Banks and President of Legacy Bancorp. In his current role, he oversees all aspects of commercial banking including commercial lending (including asset based lending and small business lending), commercial deposit and cash management services, commercial financial derivatives products, and commercial insurance services. His oversight of Wealth Management includes investment management, estate planning and trust administration. Previously, Mr. Sullivan served as Executive Vice President and Managing Director of Corporate Banking with Sovereign/Santander. Prior to that, he was Sovereign’s CEO of New England. His previous background included executive positions in two New England community banks.

 

Richard M. Marotta joined the Company as Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer in January, 2010. He is responsible for overall risk management, loan workout, loan review, loan documentation, internal audit, and compliance. Mr. Marotta was previously Executive Vice President and Group Head, Asset Recovery at KeyBank. He has extensive career experience in credit and risk management, including asset based lending portfolios.

  

- 75 -
 

 

Sean A. Gray was promoted to Executive Vice President, Retail Banking in 2010, having previously served has served as Senior Vice President, Retail Banking since April 2008. In addition to managing the Bank’s branches, Mr. Gray is also responsible for information technology, deposit operations, the call center, facilities management, marketing, retail investment services, and retail insurance services. Mr. Gray joined the Company in January 2007 as First Vice President, Retail Banking. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Gray was Vice President and Consumer Market Manager at Bank of America, in Waltham, Massachusetts. 

 

Linda A. Johnston was promoted to Executive Vice President, Human Resources in 2010, having previously served as Senior Vice President since November 2002. Ms. Johnston is responsible for overseeing and directing the Company’s human resources functions including compensation and benefits, performance and talent management, training, recruitment, development, executive compensation, and initiatives and practices that support the Company’s strategic direction. Ms. Johnston serves as a key advisor to the Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors and has been part of the Company for more than 27 years.

 

Reference is made to the cover page of this report and to the section captioned “Other Information Relating to Directors and Executive Officers - Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Proxy Statement for information regarding compliance with Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act. For information concerning the audit committee and the audit committee financial expert, reference is made to the section captioned “Corporate Governance – Committees of the Board of Directors” and “Audit Committee” in the Proxy Statement.

 

for information concerning the Company’s code of ethics, the information contained under the section captioned “Corporate Governance – Code of Business Conduct” in the Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference. A copy of the Company’s code of ethics is available to stockholders on the Company’s website at “www.berkshirebank.com.

 

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

 

 

For information regarding executive compensation, the sections captioned “Director Compensation”, “Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” and “Executive Compensation” in the Proxy Statement are incorporated herein by reference.

 

For information regarding the Compensation Committee Report, the section captioned “Compensation Committee Report” in the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

 

 

(a)Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners

 

Information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Stock Ownership” in the Proxy Statement.

 

(b)Security Ownership of Management

 

Information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Stock Ownership” in the Proxy Statement.

 

- 76 -
 

 

(c)Changes in Control

 

Management of Berkshire knows of no arrangements, including any pledge by any person of securities of Berkshire, the operation of which may at a subsequent date result in a change in control of the registrant.

 

(d)Equity Compensation Plan Information

 

The following table sets forth information, as of December 31, 2011, about Company common stock that may be issued upon exercise of options under stock-based benefit plans maintained by the Company.

 

           Number of securities 
   Number of securities       remaining available for 
   to be issued upon   Weighted-average   future issuance under 
   exercise of   exercise price of   equity compensation plans 
   outstanding options,   outstanding options,   (excluding securities 
Plan category  warrants and rights   warrants and rights   reflected in the first column) 
             
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders   397,000   $25.39    1,207,064 
                
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders   -    -    - 
                
Total   397,000   $25.39    1,207,064 

 

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

 

 

The information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the sections captioned “Other Information Relating to Directors and Executive Officers – Transactions with Related Persons” and “ Procedures Governing Related Persons Transactions” in the Proxy Statement.

 

Information regarding director independence is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Proposals to be Voted on by Stockholders – Proposal 1 – Election of Directors” in the Proxy Statement.

 

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTing FEES AND SERVICES

 

 

The information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Proposals to be Voted on by Stockholders – Proposal 3 – Ratification of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Proxy Statement.

 

- 77 -
 

 

PART IV

 

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

 

(a) [1] Financial Statements

 

·Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

·Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

 

·Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

·Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

·Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

·Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The consolidated financial statements required to be filed in our Annual Report on Form 10-K are included in Part II, Item 8 hereof.

 

  [2] Financial Statement Schedules

 

All financial statement schedules are omitted because the required information is either included or is not applicable.

 

  [3] Exhibits  
       
    2.1 Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of October 25, 2011, by and between Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc., Berkshire Bank and The Connecticut Bank and Trust Company. (1)
    3.1  Certificate of Incorporation of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. (2)
    3.2  Bylaws of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.(3)
    4.1 Form of Common Stock Certificate of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. (2)
    10.1 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Michael P. Daly (4)
    10.2 Amended and Restated Three Year Change in Control Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Kevin P. Riley (4)
    10.3 Amended and Restated Three Year Change in Control Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Sean A. Gray(6)
    10.4 Amended and Restated Three Year Change in Control Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Richard M. Marotta (5)
    10.5 Amended and Restated Three Year Change in Control Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Linda A. Johnston (6)
    10.6 Amended and Restated Supplemental Executive Retirement Agreement between Berkshire Bank and Michael P. Daly (7)
    10.7 Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. 2011 Equity Incentive Plan (8)
    10.8 Form of Berkshire Bank Employee Severance Compensation Plan (3)
    10.9 Three Year Change in Control Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Patrick J. Sullivan, dated as of December 21, 2010 (9)
    10.10 Settlement Agreement by and among Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc., Legacy Bancorp, Inc., Legacy Banks and Patrick J. Sullivan, dated as of December 21, 2010 (9)

 

- 78 -
 

 

    10.11 Severance Agreement by and among Berkshire Bank, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and Patrick J. Sullivan, dated as of December 21, 2010 (9)
    10.12 Amended and Restated Settlement Agreement by and among Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc., Legacy Bancorp,, Inc., Legacy Banks and J. Williar Dunlaevy, dated as of April 6, 2011 (9)
    10.13 Non-Competition and Consulting Agreement by and among Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc., Berkshire Bank and J. Williar Dunlaevy, dated as of April 6, 2011 (9)
    10.14 Legacy Bancorp, Inc. Amended and Restated 2006 Equity Incentive Plan (10)
    10.15 Form of Split Dollar Agreement entered into with Michael P. Daly, Kevin P. Riley, Sean A. Gray, Richard M. Marotta and Linda A. Johnston (11)
    11.0 Statement re: Computation of Per Share Earnings is incorporated herein by reference to Part II, Item 8, “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”
    21.0 Subsidiary Information
    23.1 Consent of Wolf & Company, P.C.
    23.2 Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers, LLP
    31.1 Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
    31.2 Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
    32.1 Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
    32.2 Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
    101 Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T:  (i) the Consolidated Statements of Condition, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Income, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity, (v) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements tagged as blocks of text and in detail (12)

 

 

  (1) Incorporated by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 8-K filed on October 26, 2011.
  (2) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to Form S-1, Registration Statement and amendments thereto, initially filed on March 10, 2000, Registration No. 333-32146.
  (3) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 8-K as filed on February 29, 2008.
  (4) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 8-K as filed on January 6, 2009.
  (5) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 10-K as filed on March 16, 2010.
  (6) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 10-K as filed on March 16, 2011.
  (7) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to Form 10-K as filed on March 16, 2009.
  (8) Incorporated herein by reference from the Appendix to the Proxy Statement as filed on March 24, 2011.
  (9) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 as filed on April 20, 2011, Registration No. 333-173404.
  (10)  Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibits to the Form 8-K filed by Legacy Bancorp, Inc. on December 22, 2010.
  (11) Incorporated herein by reference from the Exhibit to the Form 8-K as filed on January 19, 2011.
  (12) As provided in Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, this information is furnished and not field for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 

- 79 -
 

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

  Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.
Date: March 15, 2012 By: /s/ Michael P. Daly
    Michael P. Daly
    President and Chief Executive Officer

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

/s/ Michael P. Daly   President and Chief Executive Officer   March 15, 2012
Michael P. Daly   (principal executive officer)    
         
/s/ Kevin P. Riley   Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer   March 15, 2012
Kevin P. Riley   (principal financial and accounting officer)    
         
/s/ Lawrence A. Bossidy   Non-Executive Chairman   March 15, 2012
Lawrence A. Bossidy        
/s/ Robert M. Curley   Director   March 15, 2012
Robert M. Curley        
/s/ John B. Davies   Director   March 15, 2012
John B. Davies        
/s/ Rodney C. Dimock   Director   March 15, 2012
Rodney C. Dimock        
/s/ Susan M. Hill   Director   March 15, 2012
Susan M. Hill        
/s/ J. William Dunlaevy   Director   March 15, 2012
J. William Dunlaevy        
/s/ Cornelius D. Mahoney   Director   March 15, 2012
Cornelius D. Mahoney        
/s/ Catherine B. Miller   Director   March 15, 2012
Catherine B. Miller        
/s/ David E. Phelps   Director   March 15, 2012
David E. Phelps        
/s/ Barton D. Raser   Director   March 15, 2012
Barton D. Raser        
/s/ D. Jeffrey Templeton   Director   March 15, 2012
D. Jeffrey Templeton        

 

- 80 -
 

 

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

The management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the Company’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

 

As of December 31, 2011, management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this assessment, management has determined that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 was effective.

 

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report, which follows. This report expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011.

 

/s/ Michael P. Daly   /s/ Kevin P. Riley
Michael P. Daly   Kevin P. Riley
President and Chief Executive Officer   Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and
March 15, 2012   Treasurer
    March 15, 2012

 

F-1
 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of

Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.

 

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in stockholders' equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2011, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2011 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company's management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audit. We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinions. The financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2010, and for each of the two years then ended were audited by other auditors whose report dated March 14, 2011, expressed an unqualified opinion on those statements.

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

/s/PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

 

Boston, MA

 

March 15, 2012

 

F-2
 

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of

Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2010. These financial statements are the responsibility of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.'s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2010, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

/s/ Wolf & Company, P.C.

 

Boston, Massachusetts 

March 14, 2011, except for Note 2 as to which the date is March 15, 2012

 

F-3
 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

   December 31, 
(In thousands, except share data)  2011   2010 
Assets          
Cash and due from banks  $46,713   $24,643 
Short-term investments   28,646    19,497 
Total cash and cash equivalents   75,359    44,140 
           
Trading security   17,395    16,155 
Securities available for sale, at fair value   419,756    310,242 
Securities held to maturity (fair values of $60,395 and $57,594 in 2011 and 2010, respectively)   58,912    56,436 
Federal Home Loan Bank stock and other restricted securities   37,118    23,120 
Total securities   533,181    405,953 
           
Loans held for sale   1,455    1,043 
           
Residential mortgages   1,020,435    644,973 
Commercial mortgages   1,156,241    925,573 
Commercial business loans   410,292    286,087 
Consumer loans   369,602    285,529 
Total loans   2,956,570    2,142,162 
Less:  Allowance for loan losses   (32,444)   (31,898)
Net loans   2,924,126    2,110,264 
           
Premises and equipment, net   60,139    38,546 
Other real estate owned   1,900    3,386 
Goodwill   202,391    161,725 
Other intangible assets   20,973    11,354 
Cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance   75,009    46,085 
Other assets   91,309    58,907 
Assets from discontinued operations   5,362    - 
Total assets  $3,991,204   $2,881,403 
           
Liabilities          
Demand deposits  $447,414   $297,502 
NOW deposits   272,204    212,143 
Money market deposits   1,055,306    716,078 
Savings deposits   350,517    237,594 
Time deposits   975,734    741,124 
Total deposits   3,101,175    2,204,441 
Short-term debt   10,000    47,030 
Long-term Federal Home Loan Bank advances   211,938    197,807 
Junior subordinated debentures   15,464    15,464 
Total borrowings   237,402    260,301 
Other liabilities   43,758    28,014 
Liabilities from discontinued operations   55,504    - 
Total liabilities   3,437,839    2,492,756 
           
Commitments and contingencies (See notes 18)          
           
Stockholders’ equity          
Common stock ($.01 par value; 50,000,000 shares authorized; 22,860,368 shares issued and 21,147,736 shares outstanding in 2011; 26,000,000  shares authorized; 15,848,825 shares issued and 14,076,148 shares outstanding in 2010)   229    158 
Additional paid-in capital   494,304    337,537 
Unearned compensation   (2,790)   (1,776)
Retained earnings   109,477    103,972 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss   (4,885)   (6,410)
Treasury stock, at cost (1,712,632 shares in 2011 and 1,772,677 shares in 2010)   (42,970)   (44,834)
Total stockholders' equity   553,365    388,647 
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity  $3,991,204   $2,881,403 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-4
 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF Operations

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands, except per share data)  2011   2010   2009 
Interest and dividend income               
Loans  $124,398   $98,359   $101,705 
Securities and other   13,862    13,918    13,771 
Total interest and dividend income   138,260    112,277    115,476 
Interest expense               
Deposits   23,372    26,316    32,614 
Borrowings and junior subordinated debentures   8,368    9,014    13,266 
Total interest expense   31,740    35,330    45,880 
Net interest income   106,520    76,947    69,596 
Non-interest income               
Loan related fees   3,160    3,386    1,077 
Deposit related fees   13,641    10,880    10,121 
Wealth management fees   5,838    4,457    4,812 
Insurance commissions and fees   11,088    11,136    12,171 
Total fee income   33,727    29,859    28,181 
Gain/(loss) on sales of securities, net   14    -    (4)
Non-recurring gain/(loss), net   2,099    -    (893)
Other   (37)   (108)   (2,107)
Total non-interest income   35,803    29,751    25,177 
Total net revenue   142,323    106,698    94,773 
Provision for loan losses   7,563    8,526    47,730 
Non-interest expense               
Compensation and benefits   49,545    43,920    38,280 
Occupancy and equipment   14,927    12,029    11,614 
Technology and communications   7,457    5,733    5,466 
Marketing and professional services   6,208    5,186    6,549 
Supplies, postage and delivery   2,061    2,088    2,610 
FDIC premiums and special assessment   3,205    3,427    4,544 
Other real estate owned   2,003    311    281 
Amortization of intangible assets   4,236    3,021    3,278 
Non-recurring expenses   19,928    447    601 
Other   6,482    5,567    5,348 
Total non-interest expense   116,052    81,729    78,571 
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes   18,708    16,443    (31,528)
Income tax expense (benefit)   2,041    2,585    (15,597)
Net income (loss) from continuing operations   16,667    13,858    (15,931)
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes (including gain on disposal of $4,962)   4,684    -    - 
Income tax expense   3,770    -    - 
Net income from discontinued operations   914    -    - 
Net income (loss)  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)
Less: Cumulative preferred stock dividends and accretion   -    -    1,030 
Less: Deemed dividend from preferred stock repayment   -    -    2,954 
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders  $17,581   $13,858   $(19,915)
                
Basic and diluted earnings per share:               
Continuing Operations  $0.93   $1.00   $(1.51)
Discontinued operations  $0.05   $-   $- 
Total  $0.98   $1.00   $(1.51)
                
Weighted average common shares outstanding:               
Basic  $17,885   $13,862   $13,189 
Diluted  $17,952   $13,896   $13,189 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-5
 

 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED statementS of CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

                           Accumulated         
               Additional   Unearned       other comp-         
   Common stock   Preferred   paid-in   compen-   Retained   rehensive   Treasury     
(In thousands, except per share data)  Shares   Amount   stock   capital   sation   earnings   income (loss)   stock   Total 
Balance at January 1, 2009   12,253   $142   $36,822   $307,620   $(1,905)  $128,204   $(11,574)  $(50,453)  $408,856 
                                              
Comprehensive loss:                                             
Net loss   -    -    -    -    -    (15,931)   -    -    (15,931)
Other net comprehensive income   -    -    -    -    -    -    8,606    -    8,606 
Total comprehensive loss                                           (7,325)
Redemption of preferred stock, including deemed dividend of $2,954   -    -    (37,046)   -    -    (2,954)   -    -    (40,000)
Preferred stock discount accretion and dividends   -    -    224    -    -    (1,030)   -    -    (806)
Repurchase of warrant issued with  preferred stock   -    -    -    (1,040)   -    -    -    -    (1,040)
Issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs of $2,266   1,610    16    -    32,349    -    -    -    -    32,365 
Cash dividends declared ($0.64 per share)   -    -    -    -    -    (8,390)   -    -    (8,390)
Forfeited shares   (24)   -    -    12    579    -    -    (591)   - 
Exercise of stock options   23    -    -    -    -    (236)   -    580    344 
Restricted stock grants   59    -    -    (136)   (1,354)        -    1,490    - 
Stock-based compensation   -    -    -    43    1,362    -    -    -    1,405 
Other, net   (5)   -    -    (26)   -    (63)   -    (172)   (261)
                                              
Balance at December 31, 2009   13,916    158    -    338,822    (1,318)   99,600    (2,968)   (49,146)   385,148 
                                              
Comprehensive income:                                             
Net income   -    -    -    -    -    13,858    -    -    13,858 
Other net comprehensive loss   -    -    -    -    -    -    (3,442)   -    (3,442)
Total comprehensive income                                           10,416 
Cash dividends declared ($0.64 per share)   -    -    -    -    -    (8,989)   -    -    (8,989)
Forfeited shares   (14)   -    -    3    268    -    -    (271)   - 
Exercise of stock options   60    -    -    -    -    (513)   -    1,517    1,004 
Restricted stock grants   139    -    -    (1,199)   (2,322)   -    -    3,521    - 
Stock-based compensation   -    -    -    5    1,596    -    -    -    1,601 
Net tax expense related to stock-based compensation   -    -    -    (94)   -    -    -    -    (94)
Other, net   (25)   -    -    -    -    16    -    (455)   (439)
                                              
Balance at December 31, 2010   14,076    158    -    337,537    (1,776)   103,972    (6,410)   (44,834)   388,647 
                                              
Comprehensive income:                                             
Net income   -    -    -    -    -    17,581    -    -    17,581 
Other net comprehensive income   -    -    -    -    -    -    1,525    -    1,525 
Total comprehensive income                                           19,106 
Acquisition of Legacy Bancorp, Inc   4,351    44    -    101,639    -    -    -    -    101,683 
Acquisition of Rome Bancorp, Inc   2,661    27    -    55,463    -    -    -    -    55,490 
Employee Stock Ownership Plan   (44)   -    -         -    -    -    (943)   (943)
Cash dividends declared ($0.65 per share)   -    -    -    -    -    (11,910)   -    -    (11,910)
Forfeited shares   (23)   -    -    40    463    -    -    (503)   - 
Exercise of stock options   16    -    -    -    -    (166)   -    418    252 
Restricted stock grants   160    -    -    (474)   (2,925)   -    -    3,399    - 
Stock-based compensation   -    -    -    3    1,447    -    -    -    1,450 
Net tax expense related to stock-based compensation   -    -    -    68    -    -    -    -    68 
Other, net   (49)   -    -    28    1    -    -    (507)   (478)
                                              
Balance at December 31, 2011   21,148   $229   $-   $494,304   $(2,790)  $109,477   $(4,885)  $(42,970)  $553,365 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-6
 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC. 

CONSOLIDATED statementS of Cash flows

 

   Years ended December 31, 
(In thousands)   2011   2010   2009 
Cash flows from operating activities:               
Net income (loss)  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:               
Provision for loan losses   7,563    8,526    47,730 
Net amortization of securities   1,317    2,352    1,784 
Change in unamortized net loan costs and premiums   316    1,462    1,223 
Premises and equipment depreciation and amortization expense   4,849    3,817    3,859 
Stock-based compensation expense   1,450    1,601    1,405 
Amortization/(accretion) of purchase accounting entries   (5,319)   (1,490)   (1,718)
Amortization of intangible assets   4,401    3,021    3,278 
Write down of other real estate owned   2,000    -    - 
Excess tax loss from stock-based payment arrangements   (68)   94    - 
Income from cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance policies   (2,120)   (1,398)   (1,236)
(Gain) Loss on available for sale securities, net   (2,113)   -    4 
Net (increase) decrease in loans held for sale   (412)   3,103    (2,378)
Loss on sale of real estate   (50)   -    - 
Net change in other   10,774    5,739    (26,128)
Net cash provided by operating activities   40,169    40,685    11,892 
                
Cash flows from investing activities:               
Trading security:               
Net (increase) decrease in trading security   464   440    - 
Securities available for sale:               
Sales   9,522    -    6,303 
Proceeds from maturities, calls and prepayments   119,939    121,326    72,473 
Purchases   (201,527)   (109,690)   (143,458)
Securities held to maturity:               
Proceeds from maturities, calls and prepayments   10,625    19,897    15,438 
Purchases   (13,101)   (18,713)   (47,191)
Net investment in limited partnership tax credits   (4,909)   (537)   (3,197)
Loan (originations) principal repayments, net   (44,849)   (159,982)   7,377 
Loan portfolio purchases   -    (32,324)   - 
Acquisitions, net of cash paid   179,308    -    - 
Net cash used for Divestiture   (85,733)   -    - 
Proceeds from surrender of bank-owned life insurance   -    2,217    - 
Purchase of bank-owned life insurance   -    (10,000)   - 
Proceeds from sale of Federal Home Loan Bank stock   3,601    -    - 
Purchase of Federal Home Loan Bank stock   (1,387)   -    - 
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment   718    -    - 
Purchase of premises and equipment, net   (7,988)   (5,020)   (3,529)
Proceeds from sale of other real estate   1,230    -    - 
Net cash used by investing activities   (34,087)   (192,386)   (95,784)

(continued)

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-7
 

 

BERKSHIRE HILLS BANCORP, INC.  

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (Concluded)

 

   Years ended December 31, 
(In thousands)   2011   2010   2009 
                
Cash flows from financing activities:               
Net increase in deposits   207,919    217,679    157,182 
Proceeds from Federal Home Loan Bank advances and other borrowings   125,480    259,535    208,860 
Repayments of Federal Home Loan Bank advances and other borrowings   (296,249)   (305,902)   (276,813)
Net proceeds from common stock issuance   -    -    32,365 
Net proceeds from reissuance of treasury stock   252    1,004    344 
Excess tax loss from stock-based payment arrangements   68    (94)   - 
Redemption of preferred stock   -    -    (40,000)
Repurchase of warrant issued with preferred stock   -    -    (1,040)
Preferred stock cash dividends paid   -    -    (806)
Common stock cash dividends paid   (11,910)   (8,989)   (8,390)
Net cash provided by financing activities   25,560    163,233    71,702 
                
Net change in cash and cash equivalents   31,642    11,532    (12,190)
                
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   44,140    32,608    44,798 
                
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  $75,782   $44,140   $32,608 
                
Supplemental cash flow information:               
Interest paid on deposits  $23,750   $26,748   $32,614 
Interest paid on borrowed funds   8,292    8,174    13,690 
Income taxes (refunded) paid, net   (164)   (3,452)   1,970 
                
Acquisition of non-cash assets and liabilities:               
Assets acquired   1,193    -    - 
Liabilities assumed   (1,042)   -    - 
Rome and Legacy stock owned by the Company   6,284    -    - 
                
Other non-cash changes:               
Other net comprehensive income   1,525    (3,442)   8,606 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

Note: The Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 2011 include the cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities associated with discontinued operations.

 

F-8
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Basis of Presentation and Consolidation

 

The consolidated financial statements (the “financial statements”) of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the “Company” or “Berkshire”) have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”). The Company is a Delaware corporation and the holding company for Berkshire Bank (the “Bank”), a Massachusetts-chartered savings bank headquartered in Pittsfield, Massachusetts, and Berkshire Insurance Group, Inc. (“Berkshire Insurance Group” or “BIG”). These financial statements include the accounts of the Company, its wholly-owned subsidiaries and the Bank’s consolidated subsidiaries. One of the Bank’s consolidated subsidiaries is Berkshire Bank Municipal Bank, a New York-chartered limited-purpose commercial bank. All significant inter-company balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

Assets and liabilities related to discontinued operations are carried at the lower of cost or estimated fair value in the aggregate and presented in a separate line item on the consolidated balance sheets. Revenue and expense related to discontinued operations are not reported separately, and net income related to these operations is presented in a separate line item on the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Certain items in prior financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation. The Company has evaluated subsequent events for potential recognition and/or disclosure through the date these consolidated financial statements were issued. All acquisitions during the reported periods were accounted for using the purchase method. Accordingly, the operating results of the acquired companies are included with the Corporation's results of operations since their respective dates of acquisition.

 

Business

 

Through its wholly-owned subsidiaries, the Company provides a variety of financial services to individuals, businesses, not-for-profit organizations, and municipalities through its offices in western Massachusetts, southern Vermont and northeastern and central New York. The Company also provides asset-based middle-market commercial lending throughout New England and its New York markets. Its primary deposit products are checking, NOW, money market, savings, and time deposit accounts. Its primary lending products are residential mortgages, commercial mortgages, commercial business loans and consumer loans. The Company offers electronic banking, cash management, other transaction and reporting services and interest rate swap contracts to commercial customers. The Company offers wealth management services including trust, financial planning, and investment services. The Company is also an agent for complete lines of property and casualty, life, disability, and health insurance.

 

Business Segments

 

An operating segment is a component of a business for which separate financial information is available that is evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision-maker in deciding how to allocate resources and evaluate performance. The Company has two reportable operating segments, Banking and Insurance, which are delineated by the consolidated subsidiaries of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. Banking includes the activities of the Bank and its subsidiaries, which provide commercial and consumer banking services. Insurance includes the activities of Berkshire Insurance Group, which provides commercial and consumer insurance services. The only other consolidated financial activity of the Company consists of the transactions of its parent, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc.

 

F-9
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the financial statements. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance for loan losses; the valuation of deferred tax assets; the estimates related to the initial measurement of goodwill and intangible assets and subsequent impairment analyses; the determination of other-than-temporary impairment of securities; and the determination of fair value of financial instruments and subsequent impairment analysis.

 

Cash and Cash equivalents

 

Cash and cash equivalents include cash, balances due from banks, and short-term investments, all of which mature within ninety days. Due to the nature of cash and cash equivalents and the near term maturity, the Company estimated that the carrying amount of such instruments approximated fair value. The nature of the Bank’s business requires that it maintain amounts due from banks which at times, may exceed federally insured limits. The Bank has not experienced any losses on such amounts and all amounts are maintained with well-capitalized institutions.

 

Trading Security

 

The Company elected the fair value option permitted by Financial Accounting Standards Board’s (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures”, on a tax advantaged economic development bond originated in 2008. The bond has been designated as a trading account security and is recorded at fair value, with changes in unrealized gains and losses recorded through earnings each period as part of non-interest income.

 

Securities

 

Debt securities that management has the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held to maturity and carried at amortized cost. All other securities, including equity securities with readily determinable fair values, are classified as available for sale and carried at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses reported as a component of other net comprehensive income. Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase. Restricted equity securities, such as stock in the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston (“FHLBB”) are carried at cost. There are no quoted market prices for the Company’s restricted equity securities. The Bank is a member of the FHLBB, which requires that members maintain an investment in FHLBB stock, which may be redeemed based on certain conditions. The Bank reviews for impairment based on the ultimate recoverability of the cost bases in the FHLBB stock.

 

Purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the terms of the securities. Gains and losses on the sale of securities are recorded on the trade date and are determined using the specific identification method.

 

F-10
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The Company evaluates debt and equity securities within the Company’s available for sale and held to maturity portfolios for other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”), at least quarterly. If the fair value of a debt security is below the amortized cost basis of the security, OTTI is required to be recognized if any of the following are met: (1) the Company intends to sell the security; (2) it is “more likely than not” that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis; or (3) for debt securities, the present value of expected cash flows is not sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost basis. For all impaired debt securities that the Company intends to sell, or more likely than not will be required to sell, the full amount of the depreciation is recognized as OTTI through earnings. Credit-related OTTI for all other impaired debt securities is recognized through earnings. Non-credit related OTTI for such debt securities is recognized in other comprehensive income, net of applicable taxes. In evaluating its marketable equity securities portfolios for OTTI, the Company considers its intent and ability to hold an equity security to recovery of its cost basis in addition to various other factors, including the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost and the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer. Any OTTI on marketable equity securities is recognized immediately through earnings.

 

Loans Held for Sale / Gains and Losses on Dales of Mortgage Loans

 

Residential mortgage loans originated and held for sale are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or fair value. Gains and losses on sales of mortgage loans are recognized in non-interest income at the time of the sale. Market value is based on committed secondary market prices. 

 

Loans

 

Loans are reported at their outstanding unpaid principal balances adjusted for charge-offs, the allowance for loan losses, any deferred fees or costs on originated loans, and any premiums or discounts on loans purchased or acquired through mergers. Interest income is accrued on the unpaid principal balance. Direct loan originations costs, net of any origination fees, in addition to premiums and discounts on loans, are deferred and recognized as an adjustment of the related loan yield using the interest method. Interest on loans, excluding automobile loans, is generally not accrued on loans which are ninety days or more past due unless the loan is well-secured and in the process of collection. Past due status is based on contractual terms of the loan. Automobile loans generally continue accruing until one hundred and twenty days delinquent, at which time they are charged off. All interest accrued but not collected for loans that are placed on non-accrual or charged-off is reversed against interest income, except for certain loans designated as well-secured. The interest on non-accrual loans is accounted for on the cash-basis or cost-recovery method, until qualifying for return to accrual. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

 

Acquired Loans

 

Loans that the Company acquired in acquisitions are initially recorded at fair value with no carryover of the related allowance for credit losses. Determining the fair value of the loans involves estimating the amount and timing of principal and interest cash flows initially expected to be collected on the loans and discounting those cash flows at an appropriate market rate of interest.

 

For loans that meet the criteria stipulated in ASC 310-30, “Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality”, the Company shall recognize the accretable yield, which is defined as the excess of all cash flows expected at acquisition over the initial fair value of the loan, as interest income on a level-yield basis over the expected remaining life of the loan. The excess of the loan’s contractually required payments over the cash flows expected to be collected is the nonaccretable difference. The nonaccretable difference shall not be recognized as an adjustment of yield, a loss accrual, or a valuation allowance. Going forward, the Company shall continue to evaluate whether the timing and the amount of cash to be collected are reasonably expected. Subsequent significant increases in cash flows we expect to collect will first reduce previously recognized valuation allowance and then be reflected prospectively as an increase to the level yield. Subsequent decreases in expected cash flows may result in the loan being considered impaired. Interest income shall not be recognized to the extent that the net investment in the loan would increase to an amount greater than the estimated payoff amount.

 

F-11
 

  

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

For ASC 310-30 loans, the expected cash flows reflect anticipated prepayments, determined on a loan by loan basis based on the anticipated collection plan of these loans. The expected prepayments used to determine the accretable yield shall be consistent between the cash flows expected to be collected and projections of contractual cash flows so as to not affect the nonaccretable difference.  For ASC 310-30 loans, prepayments result in the recognition of the nonaccretable balance as current period yield. Changes in prepayment assumptions may change the amount of interest income and principal expected to be collected.

 

For loans that do not meet the ASC 310-30 criteria, the Company shall accrete interest income on a level yield basis using the contractually required cash flows. The Company subjects loans that do not meet the ASC 310-30 criteria to ASC Topic 450, “Contingencies” by collectively evaluating these loans for an allowance for loan loss.

 

Acquired loans that met the criteria for nonaccrual of interest prior to the acquisition are considered performing upon acquisition, regardless of whether the customer is contractually delinquent, if we can reasonably estimate the timing and amount of the expected cash flows on such loans and if we expect to fully collect the new carrying value of the loans. As such, we may no longer consider the loan to be nonaccrual or nonperforming and may accrue interest on these loans, including the impact of any accretable yield. We have determined that we can reasonably estimate future cash flows on our current portfolio of acquired loans that are past due 90 days or more and on which we are accruing interest and we expect to fully collect the carrying value of the loans.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses

 

The allowance for loan losses is established based upon the level of estimated probable losses in the current loan portfolio. Loan losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the collectability of a loan balance is doubtful. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The allowance for loan losses includes allowance allocations calculated in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 310, “Receivables” and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with ASC Topic 450, “Contingencies.”

 

The allowance for loan losses is allocated to loan types using both a formula-based approach applied to groups of loans and an analysis of certain individual loans for impairment. The formula-based approach emphasizes loss factors derived from actual historical and industry portfolio loss rates, which are combined with an assessment of certain qualitative factors to determine the allowance amounts allocated to the various loan categories. Allowance amounts are determined based on an estimate of historical average annual percentage rate of loan loss for each loan segment, a temporal estimate of the incurred loss emergence and confirmation period for each loan category, and certain qualitative risk factors considered in the computation of the allowance for loan losses.

 

Qualitative risk factors impacting the inherent risk of loss within the portfolio include the following:

 

  • National and local economic and business conditions
   
  • Level and trend of delinquencies
   
  • Level and trend of charge-offs and recoveries

  

F-12
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

  

  • Trends in volume and terms of loans
   
  • Risk selection, lending policy and underwriting standards
   
  • Experience and depth of management
   
  • Banking industry conditions and other external factors
   
  • Concentration risk

 

Risk characteristics relevant to each portfolio segment are as follows:

 

Residential mortgage — The Company generally does not originate loans with a loan-to-value ratio greater than 80 percent and does not grant subprime loans. All loans in this segment are collateralized by residential real estate and repayment is dependent on the credit quality of the individual borrower. The overall health of the economy, including unemployment rates and housing prices, will have an effect on the credit quality in this segment.  

 

Commercial mortgage — Loans in this segment are primarily owner-occupied or income-producing properties throughout New England and Northeastern New York. The underlying cash flows generated by the properties are adversely impacted by a downturn in the economy, which in turn, will have an effect on the credit quality in this segment. Management monitors the cash flows of these loans.  In addition, construction loans in this segment primarily include real estate development loans for which payment is derived from sale of the property or long term financing at completion. Credit risk is affected by cost overruns, time to sell at an adequate price, and market conditions.

 

Commercial business loans — Loans in this segment are made to businesses and are generally secured by assets of the business. Repayment is expected from the cash flows of the business. Loans in this segment include asset based loans which generally have no scheduled repayment and which are closely monitored against formula based collateral advance ratios.  A weakened economy, and resultant decreased consumer spending, will have an effect on the credit quality in this segment.

 

Consumer loans — Loans in this segment are primarily home equity lines of credit and second mortgages, together with automobile loans and other consumer loans. The overall health of the economy, including unemployment rates and housing prices, will have an effect on the credit quality in this segment.

 

The Company utilizes industry portfolio loss rates for commercial mortgage and commercial business loans that are assessed by internal risk rating. Historical loss rates for residential mortgages, home equity and other consumer loans are not risk graded but are assessed based on the total of each loan segment. This approach incorporates qualitative adjustments based upon management’s assessment of various market and portfolio specific risk factors into its formula-based estimate. Due to the imprecise nature of the loan loss estimation process and ever changing conditions, the qualitative risk attributes may not adequately capture amounts of incurred loss in the formula-based loan loss components used to determine allocations in the Company’s analysis of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses.

 

F-13
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The Company evaluates certain loans individually for specific impairment. A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. Loans are selected for evaluation based upon a change in internal risk rating, occurrence of delinquency, loan classification, or non-accrual status. The evaluation of certain loans individually for specific impairment includes loans that were previously classified as Troubled Debt Restructurings (“TDRs”) or continue to be classified as TDRs. A specific allowance amount is allocated to an individual loan when such loan has been deemed impaired and when the amount of the probable loss is able to be estimated. Estimates of loss may be determined by the present value of anticipated future cash flows or the loan’s observable fair market value, or the fair value of the collateral, if the loan is collateral dependent. However, for collateral dependent loans, the amount of the recorded investment in a loan that exceeds the fair value of the collateral is charged-off against the allowance for loan losses in lieu of an allocation of a specific allowance amount when such an amount has been identified definitively as uncollectible.

 

Large groups of small-balance homogeneous loans such as the residential mortgage, home equity and other consumer portfolios are collectively evaluated for impairment. As such, the Company does not typically identify individual loans within these groupings as impaired loans or for impairment evaluation and disclosure. The Company evaluates all TDRs for impairment on an individual loan basis regardless of loan type. In the first quarter of 2011, management made refinements to its allowance for loan loss methodology to better incorporate the Company’s internal risk ratings into its formula-based approach. This refinement did not have a significant effect on the year’s loan loss provision or the total allowance for loan loss.

 

Bank-Owned Life Insurance

 

Bank-owned life insurance policies are reflected on the consolidated balance sheets at cash surrender value. Changes in the net cash surrender value of the policies, as well as insurance proceeds received, are reflected in non-interest income on the consolidated statements of operations and are not subject to income taxes.

 

Foreclosed and Repossessed Assets

 

Assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure or repossession are held for sale and are initially recorded at the lower of the investment in the loan or fair value less estimated costs to sell at the date of foreclosure or repossession, establishing a new cost basis. Subsequently, valuations are periodically performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less estimated costs to sell. Revenue and expenses from operations, changes in the valuation allowance, any direct write-downs and gains or losses on sales are included in other real estate owned expense.

 

Capitalized Mortgage Servicing Rights

 

Capitalized mortgage servicing rights are included in “other assets” in the consolidated balance sheet. Servicing assets are initially recognized as separate assets at fair value when rights are acquired through purchase or through sale of financial assets with servicing retained. The Company uses the amortization method to subsequently measure servicing assets. Under that method, capitalized mortgage servicing rights are charged to expense in proportion to and over the period of estimated net servicing income. Fair value of the mortgage servicing rights is based on a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income. The valuation model incorporates assumptions that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income, such as the cost to service, the discount rate, prepayment speeds and default rates and losses. Impairment is recognized through a valuation allowance for an individual tranche, to the extent that fair value is less than the capitalized amount for the tranches. If the Company later determines that all or a portion of the impairment no longer exists for a particular tranche, a reduction of the allowance may be recorded as an increase to income. Capitalized servicing rights are reported in other assets and are amortized into non-interest income in proportion to, and over the period of, the estimated future net servicing income of the underlying financial assets.

 

F-14
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Premises and Equipment

 

Land is carried at cost. Buildings, improvements and equipment are carried at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization computed on the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the initial term of the lease, plus optional terms if certain conditions are met.

 

Goodwill

 

Goodwill is recognized for the excess of the acquisition cost over the fair values of the net assets acquired and is not subsequently amortized. For purchases prior to January 1, 2009, goodwill includes direct costs of the business combination and contingently payable costs are recorded to goodwill at the time that it is determined that the contingency will be satisfied. Subsequent to January 1, 2009, direct costs of the business combinations are expensed and contingently payable costs are recorded on the acquisition date. Goodwill may be adjusted during the year after acquisition based on additional information that is received about the fair values of acquired net assets which related to events or circumstances that existed at the acquisition date. Goodwill is assigned to reporting units and tested for impairment at least annually. Impairment assessments may occur more frequently if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of the reporting unit below its carrying value.

 

Other Intangibles

 

Intangible assets are acquired assets that lack physical substance but can be distinguished from goodwill because of contractual or other legal rights or the asset is capable of being sold or exchanged either on its own or in combination with a related contract, asset or liability.

 

The fair values of these assets are generally determined based on appraisals and are subsequently amortized on a straight-line basis or an accelerated basis over their estimated lives. Management assesses the recoverability of these intangible assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying value may not be recoverable. If carrying amount exceeds fair value, an impairment charge is recorded to income.

 

Transfers of Financial Assets

 

Transfers of an entire financial asset, group of entire financial assets, or a participating interest in an entire financial asset are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1) the assets have been isolated from the Company, (2) the transferee obtains the right to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and (3) the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets.

 

F-15
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Effective January 1, 2010, the Company adopted accounting guidance pertaining to transfers of financial assets. During the normal course of business, the Company may transfer a portion of a financial asset, for example, a participation loan or the government guaranteed portion of a loan. In order to be eligible for sales treatment, the transfer of the portion of the loan must meet the criteria of a participating interest. If it does not meet the criteria of a participating interest, the transfer must be accounted for as a secured borrowing. In order to meet the criteria for a participating interest, all cash flows from the loan must be divided proportionately, the rights of each loan holder must have the same priority, the loan holders must have no recourse to the transferor other than standard representations and warranties and no loan holder has the right to pledge or exchange the entire loan.

 

Income Taxes

 

Income tax expense is the total of the current year income tax due or refundable and the change in deferred tax assets and liabilities (excluding deferred tax assets and liabilities related to business combinations or components of other comprehensive income). Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are the expected future tax amounts for the temporary differences between carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, computed using enacted tax rates. A valuation allowance is established against deferred tax assets when, based upon the available evidence including historical and projected taxable income, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The Company records interest and penalties as part of income tax expense.

 

Insurance Commissions

 

Commission revenue is recognized as of the effective date of the insurance policy or the date the customer is billed, whichever is later, net of return commissions related to policy cancellations. In addition, the Company may receive additional performance commissions based on achieving certain sales and loss experience measures. Such commissions are recognized when determinable, which is generally when such commissions are received or when the Company receives data from the insurance companies that allows the reasonable estimation of these amounts.

 

Advertising Costs

 

Advertising costs are expensed as incurred.

 

Stock-Based Compensation

 

The Company measures and recognizes compensation cost relating to share-based payment transactions based on the grant-date fair value of the equity instruments issued. The fair value of restricted stock is recorded as unearned compensation. The deferred expense is amortized to compensation expense based on one of several permitted attribution methods over the longer of the required service period or performance period. For performance-based restricted stock awards, the Company estimates the degree to which performance conditions will be met to determine the number of shares that will vest and the related compensation expense. Compensation expense is adjusted in the period such estimates change.

 

Income tax benefits related to stock compensation in excess of grant date fair value, less any proceeds on exercise, are recognized as an increase to additional paid-in capital upon vesting or exercising and delivery of the stock. Any income tax benefits that are less than grant date fair value less any proceeds on exercise would be recognized as a reduction of additional paid-in capital to the extent of previously recognized income tax benefits and then as compensation expense for the remaining amount.

 

F-16
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Earnings per Common Share

 

Basic earnings per share represents income available to common stockholders divided by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. If rights to dividends on unvested options/awards are non-forfeitable, these unvested awards/options are considered outstanding in the computation of basic earnings per share. Diluted earnings per share reflects additional common shares that would have been outstanding if dilutive potential common shares had been issued, as well as any adjustments to income that would result from the assumed issuance. Potential common shares that may be issued by the Company relate to outstanding stock options and restricted stock awards and are determined using the treasury stock method. Treasury shares are not deemed outstanding for earnings per share calculations.

 

Wealth Management Assets

 

Wealth management assets held in a fiduciary or agent capacity are not included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets because they are not assets of the Company.

 

Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

 

The Company enters into interest rate swap agreements as part of the Company’s interest rate risk management strategy for certain assets and liabilities and not for speculative purposes. Based on the Company’s intended use for the interest rate swap at inception, the Company designates the derivative as either an economic hedge of an asset or liability or a hedging instrument subject to the hedge accounting provisions of FASB ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging.”

 

Interest rate swaps designated as economic hedges are recorded at fair value within other assets or liabilities. Changes in the fair value of these derivatives are recorded directly through earnings.

 

For interest rate swaps that management intends to apply the hedge accounting provisions of Topic 815, the Company formally documents at inception all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objectives and strategies for undertaking the various hedges. Additionally, the Company uses dollar offset or regression analysis at the hedge’s inception and for each reporting period thereafter, to assess whether the derivative used in its hedging transaction is expected to be and has been highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item. The Company discontinues hedge accounting when it is determined that a derivative is not expected to be or has ceased to be highly effective as a hedge, and then reflects changes in fair value of the derivative in earnings after termination of the hedge relationship.

 

The Company has characterized its interest rate swaps that qualify under Topic 815 hedge accounting as cash flow hedges. Cash flow hedges are used to minimize the variability in cash flows of assets or liabilities, or forecasted transactions caused by interest rate fluctuations, and are recorded at fair value in other assets or liabilities within the Company’s balance sheets. Changes in the fair value of these cash flow hedges are initially recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss and subsequently reclassified into earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings. Any hedge ineffectiveness assessed as part of the Company’s quarterly analysis is recorded directly to earnings.

 

Mortgage loan commitments are referred to as derivative loan commitments if the loan that will result from exercise of the commitment will be held for sale upon funding. Loan commitments that are derivatives are recognized at fair value on the consolidated balance sheets in other assets and other liabilities with changes in their fair values recorded in other non-interest income.

 

F-17
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

To protect against the price risk inherent in derivative loan commitments, the Company utilizes “best efforts” forward loan sale commitments to mitigate the risk of potential decreases in the values of loans that would result from the exercise of the derivative commitments. These contracts are accounted for as derivative instruments and are recognized at fair value on the consolidated balance sheets in other assets and other liabilities with changes in their fair values recorded in other non-interest income. Subsequent to inception, changes in the fair value of the loan commitment are recognized based on changes in the fair value of the underlying mortgage loan due to interest rate changes, changes in the probability the derivative loan commitment will be exercised, and the passage of time. In estimating fair value, the Company assigns a probability to a loan commitment based on an expectation that it will be exercised and the loan will be funded.

 

Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments

 

In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into off-balance sheet financial instruments, consisting primarily of credit related financial instruments. These financial instruments are recorded in the financial statements when they are funded or related fees are incurred or received.

 

Fair Value Hierarchy

 

The Company groups assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value in three levels, based on the markets in which the assets and liabilities are traded and the reliability of the assumptions used to determine fair value.

 

Level 1 – Valuation is based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Valuations are obtained from readily available pricing sources for market transactions involving identical assets or liabilities.

 

Level 2 – Valuation is based on observable inputs other than Level 1 prices, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities; quoted prices in markets that are not active; or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities.

 

Level 3 – Valuation is based on unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the assets or liabilities. Level 3 assets and liabilities include financial instruments whose value is determined using unobservable techniques, as well as instruments for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation.

 

Employee Benefits

 

The Company maintains an employer sponsored 401(k) plan where participants may make contributions in the form of salary deferrals and the Company provides matching contributions in accordance with the terms of the plan. Contributions due under the terms of the defined contribution plans are accrued as earned by employees.

 

Due to the Rome Bancorp acquisition, the Company inherited a noncontributory, qualified, defined benefit pension plan for certain employees who met age and service requirements; as well as other post-retirement benefits, principally health care and group life insurance. The Rome pension plan and postretirement benefits that were acquired in connection with the whole-bank acquisition in the second quarter of 2011 were frozen prior to the close of the transaction. The pension benefit in the form of a life annuity is based on the employee’s combined years of service, age, and compensation. The cost of the pension plan is based on actuarial computations of current and future benefits for employees, and is charged to current operating expenses.

 

F-18
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The Company recognizes an asset for a plan’s overfunded status or a liability for a plan’s underfunded status in the financial statements. Changes in the funded status of the pension and postretirement plans are reported as a component of other comprehensive income, net of applicable taxes, in the year in which changes occur. The assets and obligations that determine a plan’s funded status are measured as of December 31st each year.

 

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

 

FASB ASU No. 2010-20, “Receivables (Topic 310), Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the Allowance for Credit Losses”. In July 2010, the Financial Accounting Standard’s Board (“FASB”) issued ASU 2010-20 which requires an entity to provide disclosures that facilitate financial statement users’ evaluation of (1) the nature of credit risk inherent in the entity’s loan portfolio (2) how that risk is analyzed and assessed in arriving at the allowance for loan and lease losses and (3) the changes and reasons for those changes in the allowance for loan and lease losses. For public entities, the disclosures as of the end of a reporting period are effective for interim and annual reporting periods ending on or after December 15, 2010. The disclosures about activity that occurs during a reporting period are effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2010. The adoption of this guidance required significant additional loan disclosures included in Notes 1 and 8 to the Company’s financial statements.

 

In January 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-01, Receivables (Topic 310): Deferral of the Effective Date of Disclosures about Troubled Debt Restructurings in Update No. 2010-20, that temporarily delayed the effective date of the disclosures about troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) that are included in ASU No. 2010-20. The TDR disclosure guidance was effective beginning with the Company’s current interim period ended September 30, 2011. The enhanced disclosures required are incorporated in Note 8 to the Company’s financial statements.

 

FASB ASU No. 2010-29, “Business Combinations (Topic 805), Disclosure of Supplementary Pro Forma Information for Business Combinations”. In December 2010, the FASB issued ASU 2010-29 which clarifies the presentation of pro forma information required for business combinations when a public company presents comparative financial information. The amendments in this guidance are effective prospectively for business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2010. The adoption of this guidance required addition disclosures included in Note 3.

 

FASB ASU No. 2011-02,A Creditor’s Determination of Whether Restructuring Is a Troubled Debt Restructuring”. In April 2011, the FASB issued `ASU 2011-02 which clarifies when a loan modification or restructuring is considered a troubled debt restructuring. The guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011, and is to be applied retrospectively to modifications occurring on or after the beginning of the annual period of adoption. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements.

 

ASU 2011-05, "Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Presentation of Comprehensive Income." ASU 2011-05 amends Topic 220, "Comprehensive Income," to require that all non-owner changes in stockholders' equity be presented in either a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. Additionally, ASU 2011-05 requires entities to present, on the face of the financial statements, reclassification adjustments for items that are reclassified from other comprehensive income to net income in the statement or statements where the components of net income and the components of other comprehensive income are presented. The option to present components of other comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders' equity was eliminated. ASU 2011-05 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011; however, certain provisions related to the presentation of reclassification adjustments have been deferred by ASU 2011-12 "Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05," as further discussed below. ASU 2011-05 is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements.

 

F-19
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

FASB ASU No. 2011-08, “Testing Goodwill for Impairment”. In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08 which will allow an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step quantitative goodwill impairment test. Under these amendments, an entity would not be required to calculate the fair value of a reporting unit unless the entity determines, based on a qualitative assessment, that it is more likely than not that its fair value is less than its carrying amount. The guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011, with early adoption permitted. ASU 2011-08 is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements.

 

ASU 2011-11, "Balance Sheet (Topic 210) - "Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities." ASU 2011-11 amends Topic 210, "Balance Sheet," to require an entity to disclose both gross and net information about financial instruments, such as sales and repurchase agreements and reverse sale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowing/lending arrangements, and derivative instruments that are eligible for offset in the statement of financial position and/or subject to a master netting arrangement or similar agreement. ASU 2011-11 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning on January 1, 2013, and is not expected to have a significant impact on the Corporation's financial statements.

 

ASU 2011-12 "Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05." ASU 2011-12 defers changes in ASU No. 2011-05 that relate to the presentation of reclassification adjustments to allow the FASB time to redeliberate whether to require presentation of such adjustments on the face of the financial statements to show the effects of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income on the components of net income and other comprehensive income. ASU 2011-12 allows entities to continue to report reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income consistent with the presentation requirements in effect before ASU No. 2011-05. All other requirements in ASU No. 2011-05 are not affected by ASU No. 2011-12. ASU 2011-12 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011 and is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s future financial statements.

 

2. CORRECTION OF IMMATERIAL ERROR

 

During the second quarter of 2011, the Company corrected an immaterial error in its prior period accounting treatment for certain tax credit investment limited partnership interests. These interests primarily relate to low income housing, community development, and solar energy related investments. As a result of this error, the Company’s non-interest income and income tax expense were overstated in 2009 and 2010. On the corresponding balance sheets, the Company’s tax credit investment limited partnership interests were overstated in 2009 and 2010. The overstatement of the tax credit investment balance in each period was more than offset by an understatement of the Company’s deferred tax asset balance. These balances are included as components of other assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

 

F-20
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The Company assessed the materiality of this error for each previously issued quarterly and annual period that was affected in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and determined that the error was immaterial. The Company determined that the cumulative error is immaterial to our estimated income for the full fiscal year ending December 31, 2011. The Company has evaluated the effects of these errors and concluded that that they are immaterial to any of the Company’s previously issued quarterly or annual financial statements. The Company has revised its consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2010 and the consolidated statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2010. An adjustment was made to opening retained earnings as of January 1, 2009 to reflect the adjustments prior to the year ended December 31, 2009. The effect of correcting this immaterial error in the consolidated statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2010 and the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2009 and 2010 is as follows:

 

F-21
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

 

   At or For the Year Ended   At or For the Year Ended 
   December 31, 2010   December 31, 2009 
(in thousands, except per share data)  As Reported   As Revised   As Reported   As Revised 
                 
Consolidated statement of operations information:                    
Non-interest income  $31,159   $29,751   $28,989   $25,177 
Income tax expense   4,113    2,585    (11,649)   (15,597)
Net income   13,738    13,858    (16,067)   (15,931)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders   13,738    13,858    (20,051)   (19,915)
Basic earnings per share   0.99    1.00    (1.52)   (1.51)
Diluted earnings per share   0.99    1.00    (1.52)   (1.51)
                     
Consolidated balance sheet information:                    
Other assets   58,220    58,907    62,438    63,005 
Retained earnings   103,285    103,972    99,033    99,600 

 

The effect of correcting this immaterial error for the fiscal 2011 and 2010 quarterly periods to be reported in subsequent periodic filings is as follows:

 

   At or For the Quarter Ended   At or For the Quarter Ended   At or For the Quarter Ended 
   March 31, 2011   December 31, 2010   September 30, 2010 
(in thousands, except per share data)  As Reported   As Revised   As Reported   As Revised   As Reported   As Revised 
                         
Consolidated statement of operations information:                              
Non-interest income  $8,502   $8,134   $7,783   $7,431   $6,915   $6,563 
Income tax expense   1,061    656    893    511    1,081    699 
Net income   2,798    2,835    3,570    3,600    3,424    3,454 
Basic earnings per share   0.20    0.20    0.26    0.26    0.25    0.25 
Diluted earnings per share   0.20    0.20    0.26    0.26    0.25    0.25 
                               
Consolidated balance sheet information:                              
Other assets   59,122    59,846    58,220    58,907    68,408    69,065 
Retained earnings   103,720    104,444    103,285    103,972    102,270    102,927 

  

   At or For the Quarter Ended   At or For the Quarter Ended 
   June 30, 2010   March 31, 2010 
(in thousands, except per share data)  As Reported   As Revised   As Reported   As Revised 
                 
Consolidated statement of operations information:                    
Non-interest income  $7,963   $7,611   $8,498   $8,146 
Income tax expense   1,198    816    941    559 
Net income   3,408    3,438    3,336    3,366 
Basic earnings per share   0.25    0.25    0.24    0.24 
Diluted earnings per share   0.25    0.25    0.24    0.24 
                     
Consolidated balance sheet information:                    
Other assets   68,484    69,111    60,829    61,426 
Retained earnings   101,193    101,820    100,125    100,722 

 

F-22
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

3. MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS

 

Legacy Bancorp, Inc.

 

On July 21, 2011, the Company acquired all of the outstanding common shares of Legacy Bancorp, Inc. (“Legacy”), the parent company of Legacy Banks. Concurrently, Legacy Bancorp merged into Berkshire Hills Bancorp and Legacy Banks merged into Berkshire Bank. Legacy had nineteen banking offices serving Western Massachusetts and Northeastern New York. This business combination was substantially an in-market merger for Berkshire and the goodwill recognized results from the expected synergies and earnings accretion from this combination, including future cost savings related to Legacy operations. The combination was negotiated between the companies and was approved unanimously by their respective boards of directors.

 

In order to resolve any anticompetitive issues, the merger was conditioned on the divestiture of four Legacy Berkshire County branches. The divestiture was concluded on October 21, 2011. Additionally, the Company contracted to sell four Legacy New York branches. This sale was completed in the first quarter of 2012 and these branches are designated as discontinued operations in the financial statements as of December 31, 2011. Please see the Discontinued Operations footnote for further discussion.

 

On the acquisition date, Legacy had 7.717 million shares of common stock outstanding, net of 392 thousand shares held by Berkshire. Legacy shareholders received 4.351 million shares of the Company’s common stock based on an exchange ratio of 0.56385 Berkshire shares for each Legacy share. This common stock consideration was valued at $100.3 million based on the $23.06 closing price of Berkshire common stock on July 20, 2011. Based on the closing price of Legacy stock on July 20, the 392 thousand shares owned by Berkshire were valued at $5.6 million, and the value in excess of carrying value for these shares was recorded as a $2.1 million non-recurring gain in the statement of income. Legacy shareholders also received $10.0 million in cash based on an exchange of $1.30 in cash for each Legacy share. On December 28, 2011, the Company paid $0.1422 per share for each share of Legacy common stock owned by such shareholder on July 21, 2011. The fair value of this contingent consideration was $1.1 million. In accordance with the merger agreement, Legacy paid $1.2 million in cash consideration for certain outstanding Legacy options and Berkshire issued new Berkshire options valued at $1.3 million for the remaining outstanding Legacy options.

 

In accordance with ASC 805-10-25-13, the Company retrospectively adjusted certain provisional amounts recognized at the acquisition date to reflect new information obtained about facts and circumstances that existed as of the acquisition date that, if known, would have affected the measurement of the amounts recognized as of that date. Therefore, the tables below reflect updated balances from previously disclosed amounts in the Company’s quarterly financial statements.

 

The results of Legacy’s operations are included in the Consolidated Statements of Income from the date of acquisition. In connection with the merger, the consideration paid was recorded at fair value on the date of acquisition, as summarized in the following table in thousands, as of July 21, 2011.

 

Consideration Paid:     
Berkshire Hills Bancorp common stock issued to Legacy common stockholders  $100,334 
Cash consideration paid to Legacy common shareholders   10,043 
Value of Legacy stock previously purchased by Berkshire Hills   5,616 
Option consideration paid for Legacy employee stock options   1,349 
Contingent divestiture consideration recorded to Legacy common shareholders   1,146 
Total consideration paid   118,488 
      
Fair Value of Net Assets Assumed including Identifiable Intangible Assets   89,160 
      
Goodwill  $29,328 

 

F-23
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

In connection with the merger, the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed were recorded at fair value on the date of acquisition, as summarized in the following table in thousands, as of July 21, 2011.

 

   As
Acquired
   Fair Value
Adjustment
   As Recorded
at Acquisition
 
Recognized Amounts of Identifiable Assets Acquired and (Liabilities Assumed), At Fair Value:               
Cash and short term investments  $180,996   $-   $180,996 
Investment securities   53,177     (340 )(a)    52,837 
Loans   584,216     (18,367 )(b)    565,849 
Bank owned life insurance   16,896    -    16,896 
Premises and equipment   18,032     (29 )(c)    18,003 
Core deposit intangibles   1,017     8,043(d)   9,060
Other intangibles   2,124     1,588 (e)    3,712 
Other assets   18,742     5,495 (f)    24,237 
Deposits   (655,706)    (5,467 )(g)    (661,173)
Borrowings   (108,583)    (9,286 )(h)    (117,869)
Other liabilities   (4,067)   679    (3,388)
Total identifiable net assets  $106,844   $(17,684)  $89,160 

 

The table above includes balances associated with discontinued operations. Refer to Note 4 for further discussion of discontinued operations.

 

Explanation of Certain Fair Value Adjustments

(a)The adjustment represents the write down of the book value of investments to their estimated fair value based on fair values on the date of acquisition
(b)The adjustment represents the write down of the book value of loans to their estimated fair value based on current interest rates and expected cash flows, which includes an estimate of expected loan loss inherent in the portfolio. Loans that met the criteria and are being accounted for in accordance with ASC 310-30 had a carrying amount of $18.3 million. Non-Impaired Loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30 had a carrying value of $547.5 million.
(c)The adjustment represents the write down of book value of premises and equipment to their estimated fair value at the acquisition date based on their appraised value
(d)The adjustment represents the value of the core deposit base assumed in the acquisition. The core deposit asset was recorded as an identifiable intangible asset and will be amortized over the average life of the deposit base.
(e)The adjustment represents the value of other identifiable intangible assets assumed in the acquisition.
(f)The adjustment represents the write up of book value of other assets to their estimated fair value at the acquisition date.
(g)The adjustment is necessary because the weighted average interest rate of deposits exceeded the cost of similar funding at the time of acquisition.
(h)The adjustment is necessary because the interest rate of fixed borrowings exceeded current interest rates on similar borrowings.

 

Except for collateral dependent loans with deteriorated credit quality, the fair values for loans acquired from Legacy were estimated using cash flow projections based on the remaining maturity and repricing terms.  Cash flows were adjusted by estimating future credit losses and the rate of prepayments.  Projected monthly cash flows were then discounted to present value using a risk-adjusted market rate for similar loans.  For collateral dependent loans with deteriorated credit quality, to estimate the fair value we analyzed the value of the underlying collateral of the loans, assuming the fair values of the loans were derived from the eventual sale of the collateral.  We discounted those values using market derived rates of return, with consideration given to the period of time and costs associated with the foreclosure and disposition of the collateral.  There was no carryover of Legacy’s allowance for credit losses associated with the loans that were acquired as the loans were initially recorded at fair value.

 

F-24
 

 

 Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Information about the acquired loan portfolio subject to ASC 310-30 as of July 21, 2011 is as follows (in thousands):

 

   ASC 310-30
Loans
 
Contractually required principal and interest at acquisition  $29,846 
Contractual cash flows not expected to be collected (nonaccretable discount)   (8,371)
Expected cash flows at acquisition   21,475 
Interest component of expected cash flows (accretable discount)   (3,142)
Fair value of acquired loans  $18,333 

 

The core deposit intangible asset recognized as part of the Legacy merger is being amortized over its estimated useful life of approximately ten years utilizing an accelerated method.  Other intangibles consist primarily of the wealth management contract intangible which is being amortized over its estimated useful life of ten years utilizing an accelerated method.

 

The goodwill, which is not amortized for book purposes, was assigned to our banking segment and is not deductible for tax purposes.  Legacy had no significant insurance related operations, so no goodwill was recognized in connection with the insurance segment of Berkshire.  Legacy goodwill related to discontinued operations has been included in assets from discontinued operations on the balance sheet.

 

The fair value of savings and transaction deposit accounts acquired from Legacy was assumed to approximate the carrying value as these accounts have no stated maturity and are payable on demand.  The fair value of time deposits was estimated by discounting the contractual future cash flows using market rates offered for time deposits of similar remaining maturities.  The fair value of borrowed funds was estimated by discounting the future cash flows using market rates for similar borrowings.

 

Rome Bancorp, Inc.

 

On April 1, 2011, the Company acquired all of the outstanding common shares of Rome Bancorp, Inc. ("Rome"), the parent company of The Rome Savings Bank. Concurrently, Rome Bancorp merged into Berkshire Hills Bancorp and The Rome Savings Bank merged into Berkshire Bank. Rome had five banking offices serving Rome, Lee, and New Hartford, New York. This business combination is an extension of the Berkshire Hills franchise and the goodwill recognized results from the expected synergies and earnings accretion from this combination, including future cost savings related to the Rome operations. The combination was negotiated between the companies and was approved unanimously by their respective boards of directors.

 

F-25
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Rome shareholders received 2.7 million shares of the Company’s common stock and $22.7 million in cash. On the acquisition date, Rome had 6.7 million outstanding common shares. Through a cash/stock election procedure, the Company paid $11.25 per share for 30% of the outstanding Rome common shares and exchanged its stock in a ratio of 0.5658 shares of the Company’s common stock for each share of the remaining 70% outstanding Rome shares. The 2.7 million shares of Company common stock issued in this exchange were valued at $20.83 per share based on the closing price of Berkshire Hills posted on March 31, 2011. In addition to the above consideration, the Company owned 59 thousand shares of Rome stock which had been previously acquired at an average cost of $9.22 per share. Berkshire Hills recorded a $123 thousand gain on these shares which was recorded in non-interest income on the date of acquisition. Berkshire Hills paid $0.4 million in cash to retire outstanding Rome stock options.

 

In accordance with ASC 805-10-25-13, the Company retrospectively adjusted certain provisional amounts recognized at the acquisition date to reflect new information obtained about facts and circumstances that existed as of the acquisition date that, if known, would have affected the measurement of the amounts recognized as of that date. Therefore, the tables below reflect updated balances from previously disclosed amounts in the Company’s quarterly financial statements.

 

The results of Rome’s operations are included in the Consolidated Statements of Income from the date of acquisition. In connection with the merger, the consideration paid was recorded at fair value on the date of acquisition, as summarized in the following table in thousands, as of April 1, 2011.

 

Consideration Paid:     
Berkshire Hills Bancorp common stock issued to Rome common stockholders  $55,419 
Cash consideration paid to Rome common shareholders   22,683 
Value of Rome stock previously purchased by Berkshire Hills   668 
Cash consideration paid for Rome employee stock options   354 
Total consideration paid   79,124 
      
Fair Value of Net Assets Assumed including Identifiable Intangible Assets   61,948 
      
Goodwill  $17,176 

 

In connection with the merger, the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed were recorded at fair value on the date of acquisition, as summarized in the following table in thousands, as of Apri1 1, 2011.

 

F-26
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

   As
Acquired
   Fair Value
Adjustment
   As Recorded
at Acquisition
 
Recognized Amounts of Identifiable Assets Acquired and (Liabilities Assumed), At Fair Value:               
Cash and short term investments  $33,533   $-   $33,533 
Investment securities   412    6 (a)    418 
Loans   260,431    (2,827 )(b)    257,604 
Federal Home Loan Bank common stock   3,571    -    3,571 
Bank owned life insurance   9,908    -    9,908 
Premises and equipment   5,375    (643 )(c)    4,732 
Core deposit intangibles   -    4,820 (d)    4,820 
Other assets   8,014    (1,172 )(e)    6,842 
Deposits   (228,681)   (709 )(f)    (229,390)
Borrowings   (30,000)   -    (30,000)
Other liabilities   (4,679)   4,589(g)    (90)
Total identifiable net assets  $57,884   $4,064   $61,948 

 

Explanation of Certain Fair Value Adjustments

(a)The adjustment represents the write up of the book value of investments to their estimated fair value based on fair values on the date of acquisition
(b)The adjustment represents the write down of the book value of loans to their estimated fair value based on current interest rates and expected cash flows, which includes an estimate of expected loan loss inherent in the portfolio. Loans that met the criteria and are being accounted for in accordance with ASC 310-30 had a carrying amount of $5.7 million. Non-Impaired Loans not accounted for under ASC 310-30 had a carrying value of $251.9 million.
(c)The adjustment represents the write down of book value of premises and equipment to their estimated fair value at the acquisition date based on their appraised value
(d)The adjustment represents the value of the core deposit base assumed in the acquisition. The core deposit asset was recorded as an identifiable intangible asset and will be amortized over the average life of the deposit base.
(e)The adjustment represents the write down of book value of other assets to their estimated fair value at the acquisition date.
(f)The adjustment is necessary because the weighted average interest rate of deposits exceeded the cost of similar funding at the time of acquisition.
(g)The adjustment represents the write down of book value of other liabilities to their estimated fair value at the acquisition date.

 

Except for collateral dependent loans with deteriorated credit quality, the fair values for loans acquired from Rome were estimated using cash flow projections based on the remaining maturity and repricing terms.  Cash flows were adjusted by estimating future credit losses and the rate of prepayments.  Projected monthly cash flows were then discounted to present value using a risk-adjusted market rate for similar loans.  For collateral dependent loans with deteriorated credit quality, to estimate the fair value we analyzed the value of the underlying collateral of the loans, assuming the fair values of the loans were derived from the eventual sale of the collateral.  We discounted those values using market derived rates of return, with consideration given to the period of time and costs associated with the foreclosure and disposition of the collateral.  There was no carryover of Rome’s allowance for credit losses associated with the loans that were acquired as the loans were initially recorded at fair value.

 

F-27
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Information about the acquired impaired loan portfolio subject to ASC 310-30 as of April 1, 2011 is as follows (in thousands):

 

   ASC 310-30
Loans
 
Contractually required principal and interest at acquisition   10,953 
Contractual cash flows not expected to be collected (nonaccretable discount)   (4,880)
Expected cash flows at acquisition   6,073 
Interest component of expected cash flows (accretable discount)   (411)
Fair value of acquired loans  $5,662 

 

The core deposit intangible asset recognized as part of the Rome merger is being amortized over its estimated useful life of approximately ten years utilizing an accelerated method.  The goodwill, which is not amortized for book purposes, was assigned to our banking segment and is not deductible for tax purposes.  Rome had no insurance related operations, so no goodwill was recognized in connection with the insurance segment of Berkshire.

 

The fair value of savings and transaction deposit accounts acquired from Rome was assumed to approximate the carrying value as these accounts have no stated maturity and are payable on demand.  The fair value of time deposits was estimated by discounting the contractual future cash flows using market rates offered for time deposits of similar remaining maturities.  The fair value of borrowings assumed was equal to carrying value, since these were overnight borrowings at the time of the merger.

 

Financial Information

 

Assuming that the acquisition date for the Rome and Legacy business combinations had been as of January 1, 2011, the pro forma revenue and earnings of the combined entity for the year 2011 were $171.3 million and $15.8 million, respectively.  Assuming that the acquisition date for the Rome and Legacy business combinations had been as of January 1, 2010, the pro forma revenue and earnings of the combined entity for the year 2010 were $167.8 million and $2.2 million, respectively.  This supplemental pro forma information does not include all planned cost savings and the pro forma earnings include merger related income and expense, and results of discontinued operations, reported in the consolidated financial statements.  The pro forma revenue and earnings include the estimated after-tax impact of the accretion and amortization of discounts and premiums recorded as fair value adjustments of assets and liabilities at acquisition date.  The pro forma financial information is provided for illustrative purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the financial results of the combined companies had these acquisitions actually been completed at the beginning of the periods presented, nor does it indicate results for any future period.  The Company has determined that it is impracticable to report the amounts of revenue and earnings of Rome and Legacy since their acquisition dates included in the consolidated statement of income due to the integration of their operations with those of the Company subsequent to their acquisitions.

 

Proposed Merger: Connecticut Bank & Trust Company

 

On October 25, 2011, the Company and the Bank entered into an Agreement and Plan of Merger (the “Merger Agreement”) with The Connecticut Bank & Trust Company (“CBT”) pursuant to which CBT will merge with and into Berkshire Bank. The transaction is valued at approximately $30 million.

 

F-28
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Under the terms of the Merger Agreement, 70% of the outstanding shares of CBT common stock will be converted into the right to receive 0.3810 of a share of Berkshire common stock for each share of CBT common stock and the remaining 30% of outstanding shares of CBT common stock will be exchanged for $8.25 in cash.  The transaction is valued at $8.39 per CBT share based on Berkshire’s average closing stock price of $22.19 as of December 31, 2011.  CBT stockholders will have the right to elect to receive cash or Berkshire common stock as outlined above, subject to 70% of CBT common stock receiving Berkshire common stock in accordance with the proration and allocation procedures contained in the Merger Agreement.

 

The Merger Agreement also provides that, prior to the consummation of the merger, Berkshire will fund the repurchase from the United States Department of Treasury (“Treasury”) of each share of Fixed Rate Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, of CBT (the “TARP Preferred Stock”) issued and outstanding on that date.  In addition, Berkshire may, but is not required to, purchase the outstanding warrant issued to the Treasury (the “TARP Warrant”) to purchase CBT common stock.  If Berkshire does not purchase the TARP Warrant, such warrant will be converted at the effective time of the merger into a warrant to purchase Berkshire common stock, subject to appropriate adjustments in accordance with its terms.

 

The transaction is subject to customary closing conditions, including the receipt of regulatory approvals, the repurchase of the TARP Preferred Stock and approval by the stockholders of CBT. The merger is currently expected to be completed early in the second quarter of 2012.

 

The directors and executive officers of CBT have agreed to vote their shares in favor of the approval of the Merger Agreement at the stockholders’ meeting to be held to vote on the proposed transaction. One member of the CBT Board will be appointed to Berkshire’s Board of Directors in accordance with the Merger Agreement. If the merger is not consummated under certain circumstances, CBT has agreed to pay Berkshire a termination fee of $1.44 million.

 

4. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

 

In order to minimize potential anti-competitive effects of the Legacy acquisition, the Company agreed to sell four Legacy Berkshire County branches in conjunction with the Legacy merger agreement dated July 21, 2011. On October 21, 2011, the Company completed the divestiture of four Massachusetts bank branches in Berkshire County to NBT Bank, NA (“NBT”), a subsidiary of NBT Bancorp Inc.  The Company continued to operate these branches until the divestiture was completed on October 21, 2011. Berkshire received a 6% deposit premium on these branches and paid a related divestiture dividend to former Legacy shareholders for a portion of these proceeds pursuant to the Legacy merger agreement. The sale resulted in a pre-tax gain of $5.0 million and tax expense of $3.9 million resulting in a gain on discontinued operations, net of tax of $1.1 million. The above actions and subsequent divestiture have resulted in the discontinuance of these operations in the third quarter of 2011.

 

Additionally, Berkshire made a separate determination to sell four former Legacy New York branches that were not within its financial performance objectives. In the third quarter of 2011, management committed to a plan to sell the four branches and initiated the process to locate a buyer. Berkshire entered into an agreement to divest these branches for a 2.5% deposit premium, and completed the divestiture in the first quarter of 2012. Refer Note 25 – Subsequent Events for further details. The above actions and subsequent divestiture have resulted in the discontinuance of these operations in the third quarter of 2011. These branches are designated as discontinued operations in Berkshire’s financial statements. As of December 31, 2011, the Bank reclassified $5.4 million of assets and $55.5 million of liabilities to discontinued operations.

 

F-29
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Assets and liabilities of discontinued operations, all of which are classified as held-for-sale, were estimated as follows as of December, 31, 2011, in thousands:

 

(In thousand)  2011 
Assets     
Loans  $2,465 
Cash   423 
Premise and equipment, net   690 
Goodwill   1,197 
Intangibles   574 
Other   13 
Total assets   5,362 
Liabilities     
Deposits   55,504 
Total liabilities   55,504 
Net liabilities  $50,142 

 

The following table provides financial information for the discontinued operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 (in thousands) since the third quarter designation as discontinued operations:

 

(In thousands)  2011 
Net Interest Income  $613 
Non-interest Income   130 
Total Net Revenue   743 
      
Non-Interest Expense   1,021 
Loss from discontinued operations   (278)
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations   4,962 
Gain on discontiued operations   4,684 
Income tax expense   3,770 
Gain from discontinued operations, net of tax  $914 

 

5. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

 

Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks, and short-term investments with original maturities of three months or less.  Short-term investments included $1.6 million pledged as collateral support for derivative financial contracts at year-end 2011; this amount was $5.6 million at year-end 2010 and $1.6 million at year-end 2009.  The Federal Reserve Bank requires the Bank to maintain certain reserve requirements of vault cash and/or deposits. The reserve requirement, included in cash and equivalents, was $8.9 million and $6.1 million at year-end 2011 and 2010, respectively.   

 

6. TRADING ACCOUNT SECURITY

 

The Company holds a tax advantaged economic development bond that is being accounted for at fair value. The security had an amortized cost of $14.1 million and $14.6 million and a fair value of $17.4 million and $16.2 million at year-end 2011 and 2010, respectively. Unrealized gains (losses) recorded through income on this security totaled $1.7 million, $0.7 million and $(2.2) million for 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As discussed further in Note 17 - Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, the Company has entered into a swap contract to swap-out the fixed rate of the security in exchange for a variable rate. The Company does not purchase securities with the intent of selling them in the near term, and there are no other securities in the trading portfolio at year-end 2011 and 2010.

 

F-30
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

7. SECURITIES

 

The following is a summary of securities available for sale (“AFS”) and securities held to maturity (“HTM”):

 

(In thousands)  Amortized
Cost
   Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   Fair Value 
December 31, 2011                    
Securities available for sale                    
Debt securities:                    
Municipal bonds and obligations  $73,436   $4,418   $-   $77,854 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities   44,051    1,045    -    45,096 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   245,033    2,990    (412)   247,611 
Corporate bonds   9,996    -    (269)   9,727 
Trust preferred securities   20,064    343    (2,592)   17,815 
Other bonds and obligations   642    2    -    644 
Total debt securities   393,222    8,798    (3,273)   398,747 
                     
Marketable equity securities   20,236    1,555    (782)   21,009 
Total securities available for sale   413,458    10,353    (4,055)   419,756 
                     
Securities held to maturity                    
Municipal bonds and obligations   10,349    -    -    10,349 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   79    4    -    83 
Tax advantaged economic development bonds   47,869    1,479    -    49,348 
Other bonds and obligations   615    -    -    615 
Total securities held to maturity   58,912    1,483    -    60,395 
                     
Total  $472,370   $11,836   $(4,055)  $480,151 
                     
December 31, 2010                    
Securities available for sale                    
Debt securities:                    
Municipal bonds and obligations  $79,292   $1,008   $(394)  $79,906 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed                    
securities   25,801    370    (7)   26,164 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed                    
securities   144,493    2,806    (580)   146,719 
Corporate bonds   18,307    73    (90)   18,290 
Trust preferred securities   22,222    316    (2,683)   19,855 
Other bonds and obligations   402    2    (1)   403 
Total debt securities   290,517    4,575    (3,755)   291,337 
                     
Marketable equity securities   15,756    3,217    (68)   18,905 
Total securities available for sale   306,273    7,792    (3,823)   310,242 
                     
Securities held to maturity                    
Municipal bonds and obligations   7,069    -    -    7,069 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed                    
securities   83    3    -    86 
Tax advantaged economic development bonds   48,861    1,155    -    50,016 
Other bonds and obligations   423    -    -    423 
Total securities held to maturity   56,436    1,158    -    57,594 
                     
Total  $362,709   $8,950   $(3,823)  $367,836 

 

F-31
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

At year-end 2011 and 2010, accumulated net unrealized gains on AFS securities included in accumulated other comprehensive income were $6.3 million and $4.0 million, respectively, net of a related income tax liability of $2.3 million and $1.5 million.

 

The amortized cost and estimated fair value of AFS and HTM securities by contractual maturity at year-end 2011 are presented below. Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations. Mortgage-backed securities are shown in total, as their maturities are highly variable. Equity securities have no maturity and are also shown in total.

 

   Available for sale   Held to maturity 
   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair 
(In thousands)  Cost   Value   Cost   Value 
                 
Within 1 year  $304   $304   $6,672   $6,672 
Over 1 year to 5 years   8,498    8,274    1,976    1,976 
Over 5 years to 10 years   16,455    17,139    31,448    32,509 
Over 10 years   78,881    80,323    18,737    19,155 
Total bonds and obligations   104,138    106,040    58,833    60,312 
                     
Marketable equity securities   20,236    21,009    -    - 
Residential mortgage-backed securities   289,084    292,707    79    83 
                     
Total  $413,458   $419,756   $58,912   $60,395 

 

At year-end 2011 and 2010, the Company had pledged securities as collateral for certain municipal deposits, for certain customer deposits, and for interest rate swaps with certain counterparties. The total amortized cost and fair values of these pledged securities follows. Additionally, there is a blanket lien on certain securities to collateralize borrowings from the FHLBB, as discussed further in Note 13- Borrowings & Junior Subordinated Debentures.

 

   2011   2010 
   Amortized   Fair   Amortized   Fair 
(In thousands)  Cost   Value   Cost   Value 
                 
Securities pledged to swap counterparties  $33,236   $35,218   $30,071   $30,751 
Securities pledged for municipal deposits   33,071    34,297    15,078    15,465 
Securities pledged for customer deposits   -    -    1,788    1,877 
                     
Total  $66,307   $69,515   $46,937   $48,093 

 

Proceeds from the sale of AFS securities in 2011, 2010 and 2009 were $9.5 million, $0.0 million and $6.3 million, respectively. The components of net realized gains and losses on the sale of AFS securities are as follows. These amounts were reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive loss and into earnings:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
             
Gross realized gains  $14   $-   $82 
Gross realized losses   -    -    86 
                
Net realized gain/(losses)  $14   $-   $(4)

 

F-32
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Net non-recurring gains reported in 2011 non-interest income included $2.1 million in gains recorded on investments in the common stock of Rome and Legacy.  At year-end 2010, accumulated other comprehensive loss included $1.7 million in unrealized gains on these common stock investments.  These unrealized gains were reclassified and included in 2011 non-recurring gains, and they were elements of the consideration reported for these bank acquisitions and contributed to the goodwill recorded in these transactions. 

 

Securities with unrealized losses, segregated by the duration of their continuous unrealized loss positions, are summarized as follows:

 

   Less Than Twelve Months   Over Twelve Months   Total 
   Gross       Gross       Gross     
   Unrealized   Fair   Unrealized   Fair   Unrealized   Fair 
(In thousands)  Losses   Value   Losses   Value   Losses   Value 
December 31, 2011                              
                               
Securities available for sale                              
Debt securities:                              
Municipal bonds and obligations  $-   $-   $-   $-   $-   $- 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities   -    48    -    -    -    48 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   376    76,278    36    5,766    412    82,044 
Corporate bonds   224    6,776    45    2,951    269    9,727 
Trust preferred securities   20    2,541    2,572    3,065    2,592    5,606 
Other bonds and obligations   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total debt securities   620    85,643    2,653    11,782    3,273    97,425 
                               
Marketable equity securities   782    6,229    -    -    782    6,229 
                               
Total  $1,402   $91,872   $2,653   $11,782   $4,055   $103,654 
                               
December 31, 2010                              
                               
Securities available for sale                              
Debt securities:                              
Municipal bonds and obligations  $335   $15,630   $59   $1,195   $394   $16,825 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities   7    5,125    -    -    7    5,125 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   580    54,056    -    -    580    54,056 
Corporate bonds   15    1,985    75    2,920    90    4,905 
Trust preferred securities   5    2,041    2,678    4,529    2,683    6,570 
Other bonds and obligations   -    -    1    309    1    309 
Total debt securities   942    78,837    2,813    8,953    3,755    87,790 
                               
Marketable equity securities   -    -    68    1,432    68    1,432 
                               
Total  $942   $78,837   $2,881   $10,385   $3,823   $89,222 

 

Debt Securities

 

The Company expects to recover its amortized cost basis on all debt securities in its AFS and HTM portfolios. Furthermore, the Company does not intend to sell nor does it anticipate that it will be required to sell any of its securities in an unrealized loss position as of December 31, 2011, prior to this recovery. The Company’s intent not to sell and assertion that it will not be required to sell these securities until recovery is supported by the Company’s strong capital and liquidity positions as well as its historical low portfolio sales. The following summarizes, by investment security type, the basis for the conclusion that the debt securities in an unrealized loss position within the Company’s AFS portfolio were not other-than-temporarily impaired at year-end 2011:

 

F-33
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

AFS municipal bonds and obligations

 

At year-end 2011, none of the 129 securities in the Company's portfolio of AFS municipal bonds and obligations were in unrealized loss positions. The Company continually monitors the municipal bond sector of the market carefully and periodically evaluates the appropriate level of exposure to have to the market. At this time, the Company feels that the bonds in this portfolio carry minimal risk of default and that we are appropriately compensated for that risk. There were no material underlying credit downgrades during 2011. All securities are performing.

 

AFS residential mortgage-backed securities

 

At year-end 2011, 14 out of a total of 156 securities in the Company's portfolio of AFS residential mortgage-backed securities were in unrealized loss positions. Aggregate unrealized losses represented less than 1% of the amortized cost of securities in unrealized loss positions. The Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA"), Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ("FHLMC") and Government National Mortgage Association ("GNMA") guarantees the contractual cash flows of the Company's AFS residential mortgage-backed securities. The securities are investment grade rated and there were no material underlying credit downgrades during 2011. All securities are performing.

 

AFS corporate bonds

 

At year-end 2011, all 3 securities in the Company's portfolio of AFS corporate bonds were in an unrealized loss position. The aggregate unrealized loss represents 3% of the amortized cost. The securities are investment grade rated, and there were no material underlying credit downgrades during 2011. The securities are performing.

 

AFS trust preferred securities

 

At year-end 2011, 4 out of 6 securities in the Company's portfolio of AFS trust preferred securities were in unrealized loss positions. Aggregate unrealized losses represented 32% of the amortized cost of securities in unrealized loss positions. The Company's evaluation of the present value of expected cash flows on these securities supports its conclusions about the recoverability of the securities' amortized cost bases. Except for the security discussed below, the aggregate unrealized loss on the other securities in unrealized loss positions represented 10% of their amortized cost.

 

At year-end 2011, $2 .1 million of the total unrealized losses was attributable to a $2.6 million investment in a Mezzanine Class B tranche of a $360 million pooled trust preferred security issued by banking and insurance entities. The Company evaluated the security, with a Level 3 fair value of $0.5 million, for potential other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") at December 31, 2011 and determined that OTTI was not evident based on both the Company's intent not to sell and assertion that it will not be required to sell the security until the recovery of its remaining amortized cost and the protection from credit loss afforded by $33 million in excess subordination above current and projected losses. The security is performing.

 

F-34
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

AFS other bonds and obligations

 

At year-end 2011, none of the 8 securities in the Company's portfolio of other bonds and obligations were in unrealized loss positions. The securities are investment grade rated and there were no material underlying credit downgrades during 2011. All securities are performing.

 

Marketable Equity Securities

 

In evaluating its marketable equity securities portfolio for OTTI, the Company considers its more likely than not ability to hold an equity security to recovery of its cost basis in addition to various other factors, including the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost and the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer. Any OTTI is recognized immediately through earnings.

 

At year-end 2011, 5 out of a total of 15 securities in the Company’s portfolio of marketable equity securities were in an unrealized loss position. The unrealized loss represented 11% of the amortized cost of the securities. The Company has the intent and ability to hold the securities until a recovery of their cost basis and does not consider the securities other-than-temporarily impaired at year-end 2011. As new information becomes available in future periods, changes to the Company’s assumptions may be warranted and could lead to a different conclusion.

 

8. LOANS

 

The Company’s loan portfolio includes residential mortgage, commercial mortgage, commercial business, and consumer loan segments to customers. Residential mortgage loans include classes for 1- 4 family owner occupied and construction. Commercial mortgage loans include construction, single and multi-family, and commercial real estate classes. Commercial business loans include asset based lending loans and other commercial business loan classes. Consumer loans include home equity and other. A substantial portion of the loan portfolio is secured by real estate in western Massachusetts, southern Vermont, northeastern New York, and in the Bank’s New England lending areas. The ability of many of the Bank’s debtors to honor their contracts is dependent, among other things, on the economies and real estate markets in these areas.

  

F-35
 

 

 Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Year-end loans consisted of the following:

 

   2011   2010 
(In thousands)  Historical   Acquired   Total   Total 
                 
Residential mortgages:                    
1-4 family  $649,467   $329,407   $978,874   $619,969 
Construction   32,191    9,370    41,561    25,004 
Total residential mortgages   681,658    338,777    1,020,435    644,973 
                     
Commercial mortgages:                    
Construction   117,492    6,726    124,218    126,824 
Single and multi-family   89,401    16,398    105,799    86,925 
Commercial real estate   746,545    179,679    926,224    711,824 
Total commercial mortgages   953,438    202,803    1,156,241    925,573 
                     
Commercial business loans:                    
Asset based lending   151,065    2,206    153,271    98,239 
Other commercial business loans   210,701    46,320    257,021    187,848 
Total commercial business loans   361,766    48,526    410,292    286,087 
                     
Total commercial loans   1,315,204    251,329    1,566,533    1,211,660 
                     
Consumer loans:                    
Home equity   226,369    71,827    298,196    226,458 
Other   39,020    32,386    71,406    59,071 
Total consumer loans   265,389    104,213    369,602    285,529 
                     
Total loans  $2,262,251   $694,319   $2,956,570   $2,142,162 

 

Total unamortized net costs and premiums included in the year-end total loans for historical loans were the following:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Unamortized net loan origination costs  $5,163   $5,478 
Unamortized net premium on purchased loans   251    296 
Total unamortized net costs and premiums  $5,414   $5,774 

 

The Company occasionally transfers a portion of its originated commercial loans to participating lending partners. The amounts transferred have been accounted for as sales and are therefore not included in the Company’s accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The Company and its lending partners share ratably in any gains or losses that may result from a borrower’s lack of compliance with contractual terms of the loan. The Company continues to service the loans, collects cash payments from the borrowers, remits payments (net of servicing fees), and disburses required escrow funds to relevant parties. At year-end 2011 and 2010, the Company was servicing loans for participants totaling $86 million and $69 million, respectively.

 

In 2011, the Company did not purchase any residential mortgage loans and sold residential mortgage loans aggregating $75.2 million. During 2010, the Company purchased residential mortgage loans aggregating $32.3 million and sold residential mortgage loans aggregating $105.9 million.

 

Most of the Company’s lending activity occurs within its primary markets in Western Massachusetts, Southern Vermont and Northeastern New York. Most of the loan portfolio is secured by real estate, including residential mortgages, commercial mortgages, and home equity loans. Year-end loans to operators of non-residential buildings totaled $365 million, or 12.3%, and $253 million, or 11.8%, of total loans in 2011 and 2010, respectively. There were no other concentrations of loans related to any one industry in excess of 10% of total loans at year-end 2011 or 2010.

 

F-36
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

At year-end 2011, the Company had pledged loans totaling $81.6 million to the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston as collateral for certain borrowing arrangements. Also, residential first mortgage loans are subject to a blanket lien for FHLBB advances. See Note 13- Borrowings & Junior Subordinated Debentures.

 

At year-end 2011 and 2010, the Company’s commitments outstanding to related parties totaled $34.3 million and $41.5 million, respectively, and the loans outstanding against these commitments totaled $33.4 million and $32.6 million, respectively.    Related parties include directors and executive officers of the Company and its subsidiaries and their respective affiliates in which they have a controlling interest, and immediate family members.  For the years 2011 and 2010, all related party loans were performing.  Year-end aggregate extensions of credit to one related party, a large medical institution in our market area, totaled $32.7 million in 2011 and $31.4 million in 2010.  There were new extensions of credit to this party in the amount of $0.1 million and $8.2 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively. Reductions of extensions of credit (including loan repayments) to this party were $0.4 million and $2.1 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

The carrying amount of the acquired loans at December 31, 2011 totaled $694.3 million. These loans consisted of loans determined to be impaired at the time of acquisition, which are accounted for in accordance with ASC Topic 310-30, with a carrying amount of $17.1 million and loans that were considered not impaired at the acquisition date with a carrying amount of $677.2 million.

 

The following table summarizes activity in the accretable yield for the acquired loan portfolio that falls under the purview of ASC 310-30, Accounting for Certain Loans or Debt Securities Acquired in a Transfer

 

(In thousands)  2011 
Year ended Decemeber 31, 2011     
Balance at beginning of period  $- 
Acquisitions   3,553 
Sales   (648)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference for loans with improved cash flows   - 
Changes in expected cash flows that do not affect nonaccretable difference   - 
Accretion   (1,628)
Balance at end of period  $1,277 

 

The outstanding unpaid principal balance for all acquired credit impaired loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 loans as of December 31, 2011 was $34.6 million.

 

F-37
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The following is a summary of past due loans at December 31, 2011 and 2010:

 

Historical Loans                            
(in thousands)  30-59 Days
Past Due
   60-89 Days
Past Due
   Greater
Than 90
Days Past
Due
   Total Past
Due
   Current   Total Loans   Past Due >
90 days
and
Accruing
 
December 31, 2011                                   
Residential mortgages:                                   
1-4 family  $2,045   $877   $11,479   $14,401   $635,066   $649,467   $5,123 
Construction   -    -    -    -    32,191    32,191    - 
Total   2,045    877    11,479    14,401    667,257    681,658    5,123 
Commercial mortgages:                                   
Construction   -    -    8,650    8,650    108,842    117,492    - 
Single and multi-family   70    -    676    746    88,655    89,401    314 
Commercial real estate   746    8,019    5,258    14,023    732,522    746,545    - 
Total   816    8,019    14,584    23,419    930,019    953,438    314 
Commercial business loans                                   
Asset based lending   -    -    -    -    151,065    151,065    - 
Other commercial business loans   369    781    1,156    2,306    208,395    210,701    178 
Total   369    781    1,156    2,306    359,460    361,766    178 
Consumer loans:                                   
Home equity   430    257    1,692    2,379    223,990    226,369    - 
Other   311    148    148    607    38,413    39,020    100 
Total   741    405    1,840    2,986    262,403    265,389    100 
Total  $3,971   $10,082   $29,059   $43,112   $2,219,139   $2,262,251   $5,715 

 

Acquired Loans                            
(in thousands)  30-59 Days
Past Due
   60-89 Days
Past Due
   Greater
Than 90
Days Past
Due
   Total Past
Due
   Current   Total
Loans
   Past Due >
90 days
and
Accruing
 
December 31, 2011                                   
Residential mortgages:                                   
1-4 family  $663   $242   $1,450   $2,355   $327,052   $329,407   $796 
Construction   -    -    165    165    9,205    9,370    165 
Total   663    242    1,615    2,520    336,257    338,777    961 
Commercial mortgages:                                   
Construction   -    -    606    606    6,120    6,726    606 
Single and multi-family   -    -    703    703    15,695    16,398    703 
Commercial real estate   68    102    1,923    2,093    177,756    179,679    1,913 
Total   68    102    3,232    3,402    199,571    202,803    3,222 
Commercial business loans:                                   
Asset based lending   -    -    -    -    2,206    2,206    - 
Other commercial business loans   349    235    258    842    44,636    46,320    245 
Total   349    235    258    842    47,684    48,526    245 
Consumer loans:                                   
Home equity   284    -    75    359    71,468    71,827    - 
Other   239    69    179    487    31,899    32,386    41 
Total   523    69    254    846    103,367    104,213    41 
Total  $1,603   $648   $5,359   $7,610   $686,879   $694,319   $4,469 

 

F-38
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Historical Loans                            
(in thousands)  30-59 Days
Past Due
   60-89 Days
Past Due
   Greater
Than 90
Days Past
Due
   Total Past
Due
   Current   Total Loans   Past Due >
90 days
and
Accruing
 
December 31, 2010                                   
Residential mortgages:                                   
1-4 family  $2,103   $1,598   $1,936   $5,637   $614,332   $619,969   $- 
Construction   -    104    237    341    24,663    25,004    - 
Total   2,103    1,702    2,173    5,978    638,995    644,973    - 
Commercial mortgages:                                   
Construction   -    -    1,962    1,962    124,862    126,824    - 
Single and multi-family   -    -    1,514    1,514    85,411    86,925    88 
Commercial real estate   389    74    6,442    6,905    704,919    711,824    342 
Total   389    74    9,918    10,381    915,192    925,573    430 
Commercial business loans:                                   
Asset based lending   -    -    -    -    98,239    98,239    - 
Other commercial business loans   111    128    1,617    1,856    185,992    187,848    312 
Total   111    128    1,617    1,856    284,231    286,087    312 
Consumer loans:                                   
Home equity   119    20    856    995    225,463    226,458    147 
Other   780    245    202    1,227    57,844    59,071    165 
Total   899    265    1,058    2,222    283,307    285,529    312 
Total  $3,502   $2,169   $14,766   $20,437   $2,121,725   $2,142,162   $1,054 

 

There were no acquired loans as of December 31, 2010 to disclose.

 

Activity in the allowance for loan losses for 2011, 2010 and 2009 was as follows:

 

Historical Loans                        
(In thousands)  Residential mortgages   Commercial mortgages   Commercial business   Consumer   Unallocated   Total 
2011                              
Balance at beginning of year  $3,077   $19,461   $6,038   $2,099   $1,223   $31,898 
Charged-off loans   1,322    4,047    1,443    884    -    7,696 
Recoveries on charged-off loans   231    189    109    150    -    679 
Provision for loan losses   1,164    6,492    (164)   838    (1,313)   7,017 
Balance at end of year  $3,150   $22,095   $4,540   $2,203   $(90)  $31,898 
Individually evaluated for impairment   449    1,722    116    488    -    2,775 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   2,701    20,373    4,424    1,715    (90)   29,123 
Loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total  $3,150   $22,095   $4,540   $2,203   $(90)  $31,898 
                               
Loans receivable:                              
Balance at end of year                              
Individually evaluated for impairment   5,655    34,074    564    1,190         41,483 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   676,003    919,364    361,202    264,199         2,220,768 
Total  $681,658   $953,438   $361,766   $265,389        $2,262,251 

 

F-39
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Acquired Loans                        
(In thousands)  Residential mortgages   Commercial mortgages   Commercial business   Consumer   Unallocated   Total 
2011                              
Balance at beginning of year  $-   $-   $-   $-   $-   $- 
Charged-off loans   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Recoveries on charged-off loans   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Provision for loan losses   281    158    38    87    (18)   546 
Balance at end of year  $281   $158   $38   $87   $(18)  $546 
Individually evaluated for impairment   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   281    158    38    87    (18)   546 
Total  $281   $158   $38   $87   $(18)  $546 
                               
Loans receivable:                              
Balance at end of year                              
Individually evaluated for impairment   -    -    -    -         - 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   338,777    202,803    48,526    104,213         694,319 
Total  $338,777   $202,803   $48,526   $104,213        $694,319 

 

Historical Loans                        
(In thousands)  Residential
mortgages
   Commercial
mortgages
   Commercial
business
   Consumer   Unallocated   Total 
2010                              
Balance at beginning of year  $2,897   $19,282   $6,011   $2,749   $877   $31,816 
Charged-off loans   409    6,403    2,685    1,188    -    10,685 
Recoveries on charged-off loans   213    794    1,094    140    -    2,241 
Provision for loan losses   376    5,788    1,618    398    346    8,526 
Balance at end of year  $3,077   $19,461   $6,038   $2,099   $1,223   $31,898 
Individually evaluated for impairment   246    2,151    92    -    -    2,489 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   2,831    17,310    5,946    2,099    1,223    29,409 
Total  $3,077   $19,461   $6,038   $2,099   $1,223   $31,898 
                               
Loans receivable:                              
Balance at end of year                              
Individually evaluated for impairment   1,352    3,798    8,606    397         14,153 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   643,621    921,775    277,481    285,132         2,128,009 
Total  $644,973   $925,573   $286,087   $285,529        $2,142,162 

 

Historical Loans                        
(In thousands)  Residential mortgages   Commercial mortgages   Commercial business   Consumer   Unallocated   Total 
2009                              
Balance at beginning of year  $1,895   $12,814   $3,982   $3,003   $1,214   $22,908 
Charged-off loans   (2,016)   (27,596)   (5,945)   (3,586)   -    (39,143)
Recoveries on charged-off loans   -    22    64    235    -    321 
Provision for loan losses   3,018    34,042    7,910    3,097    (337)   47,730 
Balance at end of year  $2,897   $19,282   $6,011   $2,749   $877   $31,816 
Individually evaluated for impairment   230    4,121    2,058    -    -    6,409 
Collectively evaluated for impairment   2,667    15,161    3,953    2,749    877    25,407 
Total  $2,897   $19,282   $6,011   $2,749   $877   $31,816 

 

F-40
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The following is a summary of impaired loans at year-end 2011 and 2010 and for the years then ended:

 

Historical Loans  At December 31, 2011   Year Ended December 31, 2011 
(In thousands)  Recorded
Investment
   Unpaid
Principal
Balance
   Related
Allowance
   Average
Recorded
Investment
   Cash Basis
Interest Income
Recognized
 
With no related allowance:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family  $2,546   $2,546   $-   $1,740   $82 
Residential mortgages - construction   -    -    -    48    - 
Commercial mortgages - construction   -    -    -    79    - 
Commercial mortgages - single and multifamily   326    326    -    122    1 
Commercial mortgages - real estate   2,751    2,751    -    6,189    260 
Commercial business loans   -    -    -    23    1 
Consumer - home equity   308    308    -    375    4 
                          
With an allowance recorded:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family  $1,853   $2,302   $449   $1,027   $20 
Residential mortgages - construction   -    -    -    16    - 
Commercial mortgages - construction   7,559    8,650    1,091    4,476    - 
Commercial mortgages - single and multifamily   -    -    -    274    11 
Commercial mortgages - real estate   1,373    2,004    631    2,005    20 
Other commercial business loans   13    129    116    400    6 
Consumer - home equity   357    845    488    327    - 
                          
Total                         
Residential mortgages  $4,399   $4,848   $449   $2,831   $102 
Commercial mortgages   12,009    13,731    1,722    13,145    292 
Commercial business   13    129    116    423    7 
Consumer   665    1,153    488    702    4 
Total impaired loans  $17,086   $19,861   $2,775   $17,101   $405 

 

 

Acquired Loans  At December 31, 2011   Year Ended December 31, 2011 
(In thousands)  Recorded Investment   Unpaid
Principal Balance
   Related
Allowance
   Average Recorded Investment   Cash Basis Interest Income Recognized 
With no related allowance:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family  $247   $247   $-   $41   $- 
Residential mortgages - construction   -    -    -    -    - 
Commercial mortgages - real estate   -    -    -    1,198    33 
Commercial business   -    -    -    177    28 
Consumer - home equity   37    37    -    6    - 
                          
With an allowance recorded:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family  $-   $-   $-   $-   $- 
Residential mortgages - construction   -    -    -    -    - 
Commercial mortgages - construction   -    -    -    -    - 
Commercial mortgages - single and multifamily   -    -    -    -    - 
Commercial mortgages - real estate   -    -    -    -    - 
Other commercial business loans   -    -    -    -    - 
                          
Total                         
Residential mortgages  $247   $247   $-   $41   $- 
Commercial mortgages   -    -    -    1,198    33 
Commercial business   -    -    -    177    28 
Consumer   37    37    -    6    - 
Total impaired loans  $284   $284   $-   $1,422   $61 

 

 

F-41
 

 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

 

   At December 31, 2010   Year Ended December 31, 2010 
(In thousands)  Recorded
Investment
   Unpaid
Principal
Balance
   Related
Allowance
   Average
Recorded
Investment
   Cash Basis
Interest Income
Recognized
 
With no related allowance:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family  $201   $201   $-   $995   $18 
Residential mortgages - construction   -    -    -    91    - 
Commercial business loans   8,596    8,596    -    8,972    227 
Consumer - home equity   397    397    -    237    5 
                          
With an allowance recorded:                         
Residential mortgages - 1-4 family   973    1,206    233    1,108    18 
Residential mortgages - construction  $178   $191   $13   $32   $- 
Commercial mortgages - construction   1,432    1,735    303    1,236    - 
Commercial mortgages - single and multifamily   772    1,211    439    307    12 
Commercial mortgages - real estate   1,594    3,003    1,409    9,886    404 
Other commercial business loans   10    102    92    17,490    33 
                          
Total                         
Residential mortgages  $1,352   $1,598   $246   $2,226   $36 
Commercial mortgages   3,798    5,949    2,151    11,429    416 
Commercial business   8,606    8,698    92    26,462    260 
Consumer   397    397    -    237    5 
Total impaired loans  $14,153   $16,642   $2,489   $40,354   $717 

 

No additional funds are committed to be advanced in connection with impaired loans.

 

The following is summary information pertaining to non-accrual loans at year-end 2011 and 2010 for both historical and acquired loans:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
  Historical   Acquired   Total     
Residential mortgages:                     
1-4 family  $6,356   $654   $7,010   $1,936 
Construction   -    -    -    237 
Total   6,356    654    7,010    2,173 
                     
Commercial mortgages:                    
Construction   8,650    -    8,650    1,962 
Single and multi-family   362    -    362    1,426 
Other   5,259    9    5,268    6,100 
Total   14,271    9    14,280    9,488 
                     
Commercial business loans:                    
Asset based lending   -    -    -    - 
Other commercial business loans   977    13    990    1,305 
Total   977    13    990    1,305 
                     
Consumer loans:                    
Home equity   1,692    75    1,767    709 
Other   48    139    187    37 
Total   1,740    214    1,954    746 
                     
Total non-accrual loans  $23,344   $890   $24,234   $13,712 

 

Credit Quality Indicators

The Bank utilizes a twelve grade internal loan rating system for each of its commercial real estate, construction and commercial loans as follows:

 

1Substantially Risk Free

Borrowers in this category are of unquestioned credit standing and are at the pinnacle of credit quality. Credits in this category are generally cash secured with strong management depth and experience and exhibit a superior track record.

 

2Minimal Risk

A relationship which provides an adequate return on investment to the Company, have been stable during the last three years and have a superior financial condition as determined by a comparison with the industry.  In addition, management must be of unquestionable character and have strong abilities as measured by their long-term financial performance.

 

3Moderate Risk

A relationship which does not appear to possess more than the normal degree of credit risk.  Overall, the borrower’s financial statements compare favorably with the industry.  A strong secondary repayment source exists and the loan is performing as agreed.

 

4Better than Average Risk

A relationship which possesses most of the characteristics found in the Moderate Risk category and range from definitely sound to those with minor risk characteristics. Operates in a reasonably stable industry that may be moderately affected by the business cycle and moderately open to changes. Has a satisfactory track record and the loan is performing as agreed.

 

5Average Risk

A relationship which possesses most of the characteristics found in the Better than Average Risk category but may have recently experienced a loss year often as a result of their operation in a cyclical industry. The relationship has smaller margins of debt service coverage with some elements of reduced strength. Good secondary repayment source exists and the loan is performing as agreed. Start-up businesses and construction loans will generally be assigned to this category as well.

 

F-42
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

6Acceptable Risk

Borrowers in this category may be more highly leveraged than their industry peers and experience moderate losses relative to net worth.  Trends and performance i.e. sales and earnings, leverage, etc. may be negative.  Management’s ability may be questionable, or perhaps untested.  The industry may be experiencing either temporary or long term pressures.  Collateral values are seen as more important in assessing risk than in higher quality loans.  Failure to meet required line clean-up periods or other terms and conditions, including some slow payments may also predicate this grade.

 

7Special Mention

A classification assigned to all relationships for credits with potential weaknesses which present a higher than normal credit risk, but not to the point of requiring a Substandard loan classification.  No loss of principal or interest is anticipated, however, these credits are followed closely, and if necessary, remedial plans to reduce the Company’s risk exposure are established.

 

8Substandard – Performing

A classification assigned to a credit that is inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any.  Loans so classified must have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses that jeopardize the liquation of the debt.  They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Company will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.  Substandard loans will be evaluated on at least a quarterly basis to determine if an additional allocation of the Company’s allowance for loan loss is warranted.

 

9Substandard – Non-Performing

A classification given to Substandard credits which have deteriorated to the point that management has placed the accounts on non-accrual status due to delinquency exceeding 90 days or where the Company has determined that collection of principal and interest in full is unlikely.

 

10Doubtful

Loans classified as doubtful have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified Substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently known facts, highly questionable and improbable.  Collection in excess of 50% of the balance owed is not expected.

 

11Loss

Loans classified Loss are considered uncollectible and of such little value that their continuance as bankable assets is not warranted.  This classification does not mean that the loan has absolutely no recovery or salvage value but rather it is not practical or desirable to defer writing off this basically worthless asset even though partial recovery may be possible in the future.

 

100Small Business Express

Grade established for all small business credits deemed pass rated or better.

 

The Company risk rates its residential mortgages, including 1-4 family and residential construction loans, based on a three rating system: Pass, Special Mention and Substandard. Loans that are current within 59 days are rated Pass. Residential mortgages that are 60-89 days delinquent are rated Special Mention. Loans delinquent for 90 days or greater are rated Substandard. Residential mortgages are put on non-accrual status if rated Special Mention or worse. Home equity loans are risk rated based on the same rating system as the Company's residential mortgages.

 

F-43
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Other consumer loans, including auto loans, are rated based on a two rating system. Loans that are current within 119 days are rated Performing while loans delinquent for 120 days or more are rated Non-performing. Other consumer loans are placed on non-accrual at such time as they become Non-performing.

 

Acquired Loans Credit Quality Analysis

 

Upon acquiring a loan portfolio, our Internal Loan Review function undertakes the same process of assigning risk ratings as historical loans, which may differ from the risk rating policy of the predecessor company. Loans which are rated Substandard or worse according to rating process outlined below are deemed to be credit impaired loans accounted for under ASC 310-30, regardless of whether they are classified as performing or non-performing.

 

The Bank utilizes a twelve grade internal loan rating system for each of its acquired commercial real estate, construction and commercial loans as outlined in the Credit Quality Information section of this Note. The Company risk rates its residential mortgages, including 1-4 family and residential construction loans, based on a three rating system: Pass, Special Mention and Substandard. Residential mortgages that are current within 59 days are rated Pass. Residential mortgages that are 60 – 89 days delinquent are rated Special Mention. Residential mortgages delinquent for 90 days or greater are rated Substandard. Home equity loans are risk rated based on the same rating system as the Company’s residential mortgages. Other consumer loans are rated based on a two rating system. Other consumer loans that are current within 119 days are rated Performing while loans delinquent for 120 days or more are rated Non-performing. Non-performing other consumer loans are deemed to be credit impaired loans accounted for under ASC 310-30.

 

The Company subjected loans that do not meet the ASC 310-30 criteria to ASC 450-20 by collectively evaluating these loans for an allowance for loan loss. The Company applied a methodology similar to the methodology prescribed for originated loans, which includes the application of environmental factors to each category of loans. The methodology to collectively evaluate the acquired loans outside the scope of ASC 310-30 includes the application of a number of environmental factors that reflect management’s best estimate of the level of incremental credit losses that might be recognized given current conditions. This is reviewed as part of the allowance for loan loss adequacy analysis. As the loan portfolio matures and environmental factors change, the loan portfolio will be reassessed each quarter to determine an appropriate reserve allowance.

 

A decrease in the expected cash flows in subsequent periods requires the establishment of an allowance for loan losses at that time for ASC 310-30 loans. At December 31, 2011, there had not been such a decrease and therefore there was no allowance for losses on acquired loans under Subtopic ASC 310-30.

 

The Company presented several tables within this footnote by historical loans and acquired loans in order to distinguish the credit performance of the newly acquired loans.

 

F-44
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The following table presents the Company’s loans by risk rating at year-end 2011 and 2010:

 

Historical Loans

 

Residential Mortgage Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Internally Assigned Grade

   1-4 family   Construction   Total residential mortgages 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                              
Pass  $637,110   $616,435   $32,191   $24,663   $669,301   $641,098 
Special mention   877    1,598    -    104    877    1,702 
Substandard   11,480    1,936    -    237    11,480    2,173 
Total  $649,467   $619,969   $32,191   $25,004   $681,658   $644,973 

 

Commercial Mortgage Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Creditworthiness Category

   Construction   Single and multi-family   Real estate   Total commercial mortgages 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                                        
Pass  $91,452   $100,737   $85,153   $82,017   $674,814   $626,571   $851,419   $809,325 
Special mention   5,939    10,803    435    381    16,459    27,377    22,833    38,561 
Substandard   17,262    15,095    3,813    4,527    55,156    57,752    76,231    77,374 
Doubtful   2,839    189    -    -    116    124    2,955    313 
Loss   -    -    -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total  $117,492   $126,824   $89,401   $86,925   $746,545   $711,824   $953,438   $925,573 

 

Commercial Business Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Creditworthiness Category  

   Asset based lending   Other   Total commercial business 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                              
Pass  $149,741   $98,239   $200,246   $180,321   $349,987   $278,560 
Special mention   -    -    607    1,281    607    1,281 
Substandard   1,324    -    9,753    6,164    11,077    6,164 
Doubtful   -    -    95    82    95    82 
Loss   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total  $151,065   $98,239   $210,701   $187,848   $361,766   $286,087 

 

Consumer Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile Based on Payment Activity

   Home equity   Other   Total consumer 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Performing  $224,677   $225,749   $38,972   $59,034   $263,649   $284,783 
Nonperforming   1,692    709    48    37    1,740    746 
Total  $226,369   $226,458   $39,020   $59,071   $265,389   $285,529 

  

F-45
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Acquired Loans

 

Residential Mortgage Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Internally Assigned Grade

   1-4 family   Construction   Total residential mortgages 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                              
Pass  $327,715   $-   $9,205   $-   $336,920   $- 
Special mention   242    -    -    -    242    - 
Substandard   1,450    -    165    -    1,615    - 
Total  $329,407   $-   $9,370   $-   $338,777   $- 

 

Commercial Mortgage Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Creditworthiness Category

   Construction   Single and multi-family   Real estate   Total commercial mortgages 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                                        
Pass  $3,548   $-   $14,802   $-   $161,218   $-   $179,568   $- 
Special mention   2,160    -    272    -    8,071    -    10,503    - 
Substandard   1,018    -    1,324    -    10,390    -    12,732    - 
Doubtful   -    -    -    -    -    -    -    - 
Loss   -    -    -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total  $6,726   $-   $16,398   $-   $179,679   $-   $202,803   $- 

 

Commercial Business Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile by Creditworthiness Category 

   Asset based lending   Other   Total commercial business 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Grade:                              
Pass  $2,206   $-   $39,578   $-   $41,784   $- 
Special mention   -    -    3,810    -    3,810    - 
Substandard   -    -    2,932    -    2,932    - 
Doubtful   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Loss   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Total  $2,206   $-   $46,320   $-   $48,526   $- 

 

Consumer Credit Exposure

Credit Risk Profile Based on Payment Activity

   Home equity   Other   Total consumer 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2011   2010   2011   2010 
Performing  $71,752   $-   $32,248   $-   $104,000   $- 
Nonperforming   75    -    138    -    213    - 
Total  $71,827   $-   $32,386   $-   $104,213   $- 

  

The Company’s loan portfolio also includes certain loans that have been modified in a Troubled Debt Restructuring (TDR), where economic concessions have been granted to borrowers who have experienced or are expected to experience financial difficulties. These concessions typically result from the Company’s loss mitigation activities and could include reductions in the interest rate, payment extensions, forgiveness of principal, forbearance or other actions. Certain TDRs are classified as nonperforming at the time of restructure and may only be returned to performing status after considering the borrower’s sustained repayment performance for a reasonable period, generally six months.

 

The following tables include the recorded investment and number of modifications for modified loans identified during the year-ended December 31, 2011. The Company reports the recorded investment in the loans prior to a modification and also the recorded investment in the loans after the loans were restructured.

 

F-46
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

   Modifications by Class 
   For the twelve months ending December 31, 2011 
   Number of
Modifications
   Pre-Modification
Outstanding Recorded
Investment
   Post-Modification
Outstanding Recorded
Investment
 
Troubled Debt Restructurings               
Residential- 1-4 Family   1   $607   $607 
Commercial - Other   1    726    176 
    2   $1,333   $783 

 

As of December 31, 2011, there were no loans that were restructured within the last 12 months that have subsequently defaulted.

 

The following table presents the Company’s TDR activity in 2011 and 2010:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Balance at beginning of year  $7,829   $30,991 
Principal payments   (69)   (6,294)
TDR status change (1)   (7,041)   (16,368)
Other reductions (2)   (239)   (1,880)
Newly identified TDRs   783    1,380 
Balance at end of year  $1,263   $7,829 

 

(1)TDR Status change classification represents TDR loans with a specified interest rate equal to or greater than the rate that the Company was willing to accept at the time of the restructuring for a new loan with comparable risk and the loan was on current payment status and not impaired based on the terms specified by the restructuring agreement.
(2)Other Reductions classification consists of transfer to other real estate owned and charge-offs to loans.

 

  

The evaluation of certain loans individually for specific impairment includes loans that were previously classified as TDRs or continue to be classified as TDRs.

 

F-47
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

9.          PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

 

Year-end premises and equipment are summarized as follows: 

 

(In thousands)  2011(1)  2010   Estimated Useful
Life
 
                
Land  $8,349   $3,836   N/A 
Buildings and improvements   52,762    36,302   5 - 39 years 
Furniture and equipment   30,886    25,329   3 - 7 years 
Construction in process   2,375    1,773      
Premises and equipment, gross   94,372    67,240      
Accumulated depreciation and amortization   (33,543)   (28,694)     
Premises and equipment, net  $60,829   $38,546      

(1)Amounts include balances associated with discontinued operations

 

Depreciation and amortization expense for the years 2011, 2010 and 2009 amounted to $4.8 million, $3.8 million, and $3.9 million, respectively.

 

10.          GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLES

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets are presented in the tables below. The increases in goodwill and certain other intangible assets were related to the acquisition of Legacy and Rome. Refer to Note 3 – Mergers and Acquisitions.

 

Year-end goodwill relates to the following reporting units:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Banking  $179,214   $138,549 
Insurance   23,176    23,176 
Total  $202,390   $161,725 

 

The Company tests goodwill impairment annually in the fourth quarter or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that impairment is possible. No impairment was recorded on goodwill for 2011 and 2010.

 

F-48
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The components of other intangible assets are as follows: 

 

(In thousands)  Gross
Intangible
Assets
   Accumulated
Amortization
   Net
Intangible
Assets
 
             
December 31, 2011 (1)               
Non-maturity deposits  $28,663   $(13,538)  $15,125 
Insurance contracts   7,345    (3,795)   3,550 
All other intangible assets   3,522    (650)   2,872 
Total  $39,530   $(17,983)  $21,547 
                
December 31, 2010               
Non-maturity deposits  $16,978   $(10,371)  $6,607 
Insurance contracts   7,463    (3,178)   4,285 
All other intangible assets   1,037    (575)   462 
Total  $25,478   $(14,124)  $11,354 

(1)Amounts include balances associated with discontinued operations

 

Other intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line or accelerated basis over their estimated lives, which range from eight to eleven years. Amortization expense related to intangible assets totaled $4.4 million in 2011, $3.0 million in 2010, and $3.3 million in 2009.

 

F-49
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The estimated aggregate future amortization expense for intangible assets remaining at year-end 2011 is as follows: 2012- $5.1 million; 2013- $4.6 million; 2014- $3.9 million; 2015- $2.6 million; 2016- $2.0 million and thereafter- $2.9 million.

 

For the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, no impairment charges were identified for the Company’s intangible assets.

 

11.          OTHER ASSETS 

 

Year-end other assets are summarized as follows: 

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Net deferred tax asset  $39,691   $17,779 
Capitalized mortgage servicing rights   3,067    2,035 
Accrued interest receivable   11,350    8,769 
Investment in tax credits   9,527    4,618 
FDIC insurance   7,095    8,053 
Accrued federal and state tax receivable   1,480    6,404 
Derivative assets   13,926    7,673 
Other   5,173    3,576 
           
Total other assets  $91,309   $58,907 

 

The Bank has sold loans in the secondary market and has retained the servicing responsibility and receives fees for the services provided. Mortgage loans sold and serviced for others amounted to $486.6 million, $319.8 million, and $245.2 million at year-end 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively. Mortgage loans serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The risks inherent in mortgage servicing assets relate primarily to changes in prepayments that result from shifts in mortgage interest rates. At inception, capitalized mortgage servicing rights approximates the capitalized net present value of fee income streams generated from servicing these loans. The fair value of these rights is based on discounted cash flow projections. Contractually specified servicing fees were $1.2 million, $2.0 million, and $1.8 million for the years 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively, and included as a component of loan related fees of non-interest income. The significant assumptions used in the valuation at year-end 2011 included a discount rate of 11% and pre-payment speed assumptions ranging from 13.0% to 20.4%. Net gains on sales of mortgage loans were $257 thousand, $851 thousand, and $890 thousand for the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

Mortgage servicing rights activity was as follows: 

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Balance at beginning of year  $2,035   $1,620 
  Additions   1,555    1,121 
  Amortization   (523)   (528)
  Impairment Adjustment   -    (178)
Balance at end of year  $3,067   $2,035 

 

F-50
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

12.          DEPOSITS

 

A summary of year-end time deposits is as follows:

 

(In thousands)  2011(1)   2010 
Maturity date:          
Within 1 year  $523,228   $393,944 
Over 1 year to 2 years   219,492    140,842 
Over 2 years to 3 years   114,204    79,436 
Over 3 years to 4 years   75,474    63,258 
Over 4 years to 5 years   58,977    48,765 
Over 5 years   11,263    14,879 
Total  $1,002,638   $741,124 
           
Account balances:          
Less than $100,000  $511,592   $368,770 
$100,000 or more   491,046    372,354 
Total  $1,002,638   $741,124 

(1) Amounts include balances associated with discontinued operations

 

13.          BORROWINGS & JUNIOR SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES

 

Short-term debt includes FHLBB advances with an original maturity of less than one year and outstanding borrowings on lines of credit.  Total short-term debt was $10 million and $47.0 million at year-end 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The weighted-average interest rates on short-term debt at year-end 2011 and 2010 were 0.16% and 0.38%, respectively. The Bank also maintains a $3 million secured line of credit with the FHLBB that bears a daily adjustable rate calculated by the FHLBB. There was no outstanding balance on the FHLBB line of credit at year-end 2011 and 2010.

 

The Bank is approved to borrow on a short-term basis from the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston as a non-member bank. The Bank has pledged certain loans and securities to the Federal Reserve Bank to support this arrangement. No borrowings with the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston took place in 2011.   The Bank had no outstanding borrowings at year-end 2011, 2010 or 2009.

 

Long-term FHLBB advances consist of advances with an original maturity of more than one year. The advances outstanding at year-end 2011 include callable advances totaling $8 million, and amortizing advances totaling $5.8 million. All FHLBB borrowings, including the line of credit, are secured by a blanket security agreement on certain qualified collateral, principally all residential first mortgage loans and certain securities.

 

F-51
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

A summary of long-term FHLBB advances at year-end 2011 and 2010 is as follows:

 

   2011   2010 
       Weighted       Weighted 
(In thousands)  Amount   Average Rate   Amount   Average Rate 
                 
Fixed rate advances maturing:                    
2011  $-              -  $610    5.70%
2012   10,000    0.16    -    - 
2013   16,727    1.44    3,000    4.89 
2014   20,543    3.01    10,207    5.00 
2016 and beyond   10,579    4.10    10,443    4.15 
Total fixed rate advances   57,849    2.26    24,260    4.64 
                     
Variable rate advances maturing:                    
2012   34,940    0.59    34,874    0.37 
2013   59,149    1.37    58,673    0.53 
2014   10,000    0.64    20,000    0.51 
2015   20,000    0.42    20,000    0.34 
2016 and beyond   40,000    0.42    40,000    0.34 
Total variable rate advances   164,089    0.81    173,547    0.43 
                     
Total FHLBB advances  $221,938    1.19%  $197,807    0.94%

 

The Company holds 100% of the common stock of Berkshire Hills Capital Trust I (“Trust I”) which is included in other assets with a cost of $0.5 million.  The sole asset of Trust I is $15.5 million of the Company’s junior subordinated debentures due in 2035. These debentures bear interest at a variable rate equal to LIBOR plus 1.85% and had a rate of 2.35% at year-end 2011. The Company has the right to defer payments of interest for up to five years on the debentures at any time, or from time to time, with certain limitations, including a restriction on the payment of dividends to stockholders while such interest payments on the debentures have been deferred.  The Company has not exercised this right to defer payments.  The Company has the right to redeem the debentures at par value. Trust I is considered a variable interest entity for which the Company is not the primary beneficiary.  Accordingly, Trust I is not consolidated into the Company’s financial statements.

 

14.          OTHER LIABILITIES 

 

Year-end other liabilities are summarized as follows:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Derivative liabilities  $26,930   $18,717 
Other   16,828    9,297 
           
Total other liabilities  $43,758   $28,014 

 

F-52
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

15.          EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

 

The Company accounts for our pension and postretirement plans by recognizing in the financial statements an asset for a plan’s overfunded status or a liability for a plan’s underfunded status. The Company reports changes in the funded status of our pension and postretirement plan as a component of other comprehensive income, net of applicable taxes, in the year in which changes occur.

 

Pension Plans

 

The Company maintains a legacy employer sponsored defined benefit pension plan (the “Plan”) for which participation and benefit accruals were frozen in 2011. Accordingly, no employees are permitted to commence participation in the Plan and future salary increases and years of credited service are not considered when computing an employee’s benefits under the Plan. As of December 31, 2011, all minimum ERISA funding requirements have been met.

 

Information regarding the pension plan at December 31, 2011 is as follows (in thousands):

 

Change in projected benefit obligation:     
Projected benefit obligation at plan acquisition date  $5,744 
Interest cost   223 
Actuarial loss   451 
Benefits paid   (258)
Settlements   (120)
Projected benefit obligation at end of year   6,040 
      
Change in fair value of plan assets:     
Fair value of plan assets at plan acquisition date   4,915 
Actual return on plan assets   (267)
Contributions by employer   186 
Benefits paid   (258)
Settlements   (120)
Fair value of plan assets at end of year   4,456 
      
Underfunded status at year end  $(1,584)

 

Amounts Recognized in Statement of Financial Position

 

Current Liabilities   - 
Noncurrent Liabilities   (1,584)

 

Net pension cost is comprised of the following for the year ended December 31, 2011 (in thousands):

 

Interest cost  $223 
Expected return on plan assets   (319)
Net periodic pension credit  $(96)

  

F-53
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income during 2011 are as follows (in thousands): 

 

Actuarial loss  $1,037 
Total loss recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income   1,037 
Total recognized in net periodic pension cost and other comprehensive income  $941 

 

The Company expects to make cash contributions of $191 thousand to the pension trust during the 2012 fiscal year.

 

The amount expected to be amortized from other comprehensive income into net periodic pension cost over the next fiscal year is $47 thousand.

 

The principal actuarial assumptions used at December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 

Projected benefit obligation     
Discount rate   4.660%
Net periodic pension cost     
Discount rate   5.360%
Long term rate of return on plan assets   9.000%

 

The discount rate that is used in the measurement of the pension obligation is determined by comparing the pension plan expected future retirement payment cash flows to the Citigroup Above Median Pension Liability Index as of the measurement date. The expected long-term rate of return on Plan assets reflects long-term earnings expectations on existing Plan assets and those contributions expected to be received during the current plan year. In estimating that rate, appropriate consideration was given to historical returns earned by Plan assets in the fund and the rates of return expected to be available for reinvestment. The rates of return were adjusted to reflect current capital market assumptions and changes in investment allocations.

 

The Company’s overall investment strategy with respect to the Plan’s assets is primarily for preservation of capital and to provide regular dividend and interest payments. The Plan’s targeted asset allocation is 65% equity securities and 35% fixed-income securities. Equity securities primarily include investments in large cap core, value, and growth stocks. The fixed income portion of the Plan assets is invested in one index fund which is an investment grade, intermediate term index. Equity securities are expected to earn a return in the range of 5% to 9% and fixed income securities are expected to earn a return in the range of 2% to 6%. The long-term inflation rate was estimated to be 3%. When these overall return expectations are applied to the Plan’s target allocation, we expect the future rate of return to be approximately 9%.

 

The fair values of the Plan’s assets by asset category and level within the fair value hierarchy are as follows at December 31, 2011 (in thousands):

 

Asset Category  Total   Level 1   Level 2 
Equity mutual funds:               
Large-Cap  $399   $399    - 
Small-Cap   527    527    - 
Equity trusts:   -    -    - 
Large-Cap   1,346    -   $1,346 
International   491    -    491 
Fixed Income Trusts   1,693    -    1,693 
Total  $4,456   $926   $3,530 

 

F-54
 

 

 Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

The Plan did not hold any assets classified as Level 3 during 2011.

 

Estimated benefit payments under our pension plans over the next ten years at December 31, 2011 are as follows (in thousands):

 

Year  Payments 
2012  $350 
2013   377 
2014   378 
2015   383 
2016   375 
2017–2021   1,931 

 

Postretirement Benefits

 

The Company has an unfunded post-retirement medical plan which was assumed in connection with the Rome Bancorp acquisition in 2011 and has modified the postretirement plan so that participation is closed to those employees who did not meet the retirement eligibility requirements by March 31, 2011. The Company contributes partially to medical benefits and life insurance coverage for retirees. The retiree and surviving spouse are responsible for the remainder of the medical benefits, including increases in premiums levels, between the total premium and the Company’s contribution. Information regarding the postretirement plan at December 31, 2011 is as follows (in thousands):

 

Change in accumulated postretirement benefit obligation:     
Accumulated postretirement benefit obligation at plan acquisition date  $1,468 
Interest cost   53 
Participant contributions   30 
Actuarial loss   44 
Benefits paid   (107)
Amendments   (405)
Accumulated postretirement benefit obligation at end of year   1,083 
      
Change in plan assets:     
Fair value of plan assets at plan acquisition date  $- 
Contributions by employer   77 
Contributions by participant   30 
Benefits paid   (107)
Fair value of plan assets at end of year  $- 

 

Amounts Recognized in Statement of Financial Position

 

Current Liabilities   (93)
Noncurrent Liabilities   (990)

 

The postretirement benefit obligation recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income and the accrued liability for the year ended December 31, 2011 are as follows (in thousands):

 

Prior service cost   (405)
Net actuarial loss   44 
Total recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income   (361)
Accrued postretirement liability recognized  $(1,444)

 

F-55
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The Company expects to contribute $93 thousand to the postretirement benefit plan during the next fiscal year equal to the expected benefit payments in this unfunded plan.

 

The amount expected to be amortized from other comprehensive income into net periodic postretirement cost over the next fiscal year is $34 thousand.

 

A discount rate of 4.25% was utilized as of December 31, 2011 to calculate the future postretirement obligation related to the medial plan. The assumed health care cost trend rate used in measuring the accumulated post-retirement benefit obligation was 8% for 2011, and gradually decreased to 5% by 2017. This assumption can have a significant effect on the amounts reported, although as noted above, increases in premium levels are the financial responsibility of the plan beneficiary and thus an increase or decrease in 1% of the health care cost trend rates utilized would have had an immaterial effect on the service and interest cost as well as the accumulated post-retirement benefit obligation for the postretirement plan as of December 31, 2011.

 

Estimated benefit payments under the postretirement benefit plan over the next ten years at December 31, 2011 are as follows (in thousands):

 

Year  Payments 
2012  $93 
2013   91 
2014   89 
2015   87 
2016   85 
2017–2021   398 

 

401(k) Plan

 

The Company provides a 401(k) Plan which most employees participate in. The Company contributes a non-elective 3% of gross annual wages for each participant, regardless of the participant’s deferral, in addition to a 100% match up to 4% of gross annual wages. The Company’s contributions vest immediately. Expense related to the plan was $1.9 million in 2011 and $1.5 million for each of the years 2010 and 2009.

 

Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”)

 

Two ESOP plans were acquired by the Company in connection with our previous whole-bank acquisitions in 2011, and both were frozen and terminated prior to the completion of those transactions. As these plans were frozen and terminated, all amounts in the ESOP as of that date were vested and the loan under the ESOP was repaid from the proceeds of unallocated shares in the ESOP.

 

Other Plans

 

The Company maintains a supplemental executive retirement plan (“SERP”) for a few select executives. Benefits generally commence no earlier than age sixty-two and are payable at the executive’s option, either as an annuity or as a lump sum. Some of these SERPs were assumed in connection with the Legacy acquisition in 2011. At year-end 2011 and 2010, the accrued liability for these SERPs were $2.0 million and $1.4 million, respectively. SERP expense was $326 thousand in 2011, $242 thousand in 2010, and $207 thousand in 2009, and is recognized over the required service period.

 

The Company has endorsement split-dollar life insurance arrangements pertaining to certain current and prior executives. Under these arrangements, the Company purchased policies insuring the lives of the executives, and separately entered into agreements to split the policy benefits with the executive. There are no post-retirement benefits associated with these policies.

 

F-56
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

16.          INCOME TAXES

 

Income tax expense (benefit) is as follows:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
             
Current:               
Federal tax expense (benefit)  $2,112   $6,634   $(6,578)
State tax expense   572    2,004    95 
Total current expense (benefit)   2,684    8,638    (6,483)
Deferred :               
Federal tax (benefit) expense   2,102    (4,508)   (8,247)
State tax (benefit) expense   1,025    (1,545)   (867)
Total deferred (benefit) expense   3,127    (6,053)   (9,114)
Decrease in valuation allowance   -    -    - 
Total income tax expense (benefit)  $5,811   $2,585   $(15,597)

 

The effective income tax rate differs from the statutory tax rate as a result of the following:

 

   2011   2010   2009 
             
Statutory tax rate   35.0%   35.0%   (35.0)%
Increase (decrease) resulting from:               
State taxes, net of federal tax benefit   4.4    1.8    0.1 
Tax exempt income - investments, net   (9.5)   (13.5)   (5.5)
Bank-owned life insurance   (3.4)   (2.8)   (1.4)
Non-taxable gain on Rome and Legacy   (3.1)   -    - 
Non-deductible goodwill on branch divestiture   6.9    -    - 
Tax credits, net of basis reduction   (7.2)   (5.8)   (8.4)
Other, net   1.7    1.0    0.7 
                
Effective tax rate (1)   24.8%   15.7%   (49.5)%

 

Year-end deferred tax assets (liabilities) relate to the following:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Allowance for loan losses  $17,439   $18,668 
Intangible amortization   (8,388)   (6,916)
Bonus depreciation on premises and equipment   (1,186)   (2,686)
Tax credit carryforwards   8,612    4,146 
Net unrealized loss on swaps and securities available for sale in OCI   3,510    2,189 
Employee benefit plans   2,776    1,523 
Investments   209    347 
Purchase accounting adjustments   12,178    23 
Net operating loss and capital loss carryforwards   6,125    - 
Other   556    485 
Deferred tax asset, net before valuation allowance   41,831    17,779 
Valuation allowance   (2,140)   - 
Deferred tax asset, net of valuation allowance  $39,691   $17,779 

 

F-57
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Management believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will realize its deferred tax assets, net of the valuation allowance based on anticipated future levels of pre-tax income. As part of the Legacy merger, it was determined that a $2.1 million valuation allowance against the capital loss carryforward will be maintained to the extent the capital losses are not expected to be utilized in the future. Actual future income may differ from management’s expectations which could lead the Company to establish an additional allowance in future years.

 

The Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal income tax or state income tax examinations for tax years prior to 2008. However, the 2007 U.S. federal income tax year remains open to the extent of the 2009 net operating loss carryback claim. The Company is currently under examination by the Internal Revenue Service for 2007 to the extent of the 2009 net operating loss carryback claim and for the 2008 and 2009 tax years.

 

On April 1, 2011, the Company completed its acquisition of Rome and its subsidiaries and on July 21, 2011, the Company completed its acquisition of Legacy and its subsidiaries. Refer to Note 3 for further details. As a result of the merger, the Company will inherit the tax histories of Rome and Legacy for all of their tax periods still open for examination.

 

The Company recorded $0.7 million in unrecognized income tax benefits at December 31, 2011. If recognized, the unrecognized income tax benefits would minimally affect the Company’s annualized income tax rate. No significant reserves for uncertain tax positions were recorded at year-end 2010 and 2009. Interest and penalties recognized as part of the Company’s income tax expense was not material for the year ending 2011.

 

17.          DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING ACTIVITIES

 

At year-end 2011, the Company held derivatives with a total notional amount of $578 million. Of this total, interest rate swaps with a combined notional amount of $200 million were designated as cash flow hedges and $335 million have been designated as economic hedges.  The remaining $43 million notional amount represents commitments to originate residential mortgage loans for sale and commitments to sell residential mortgage loans, which are also accounted for as derivative financial instruments. At year-end 2011, no derivatives were designated as hedges of net investments in foreign operations.  Additionally, the Company does not use derivatives for trading or speculative purposes. 

 

As part of the Company’s risk management strategy, the Company enters into interest rate swap agreements to mitigate the interest rate risk inherent in certain of the Company’s assets and liabilities. Interest rate swap agreements involve the risk of dealing with both Bank customers and institutional derivative counterparties and their ability to meet contractual terms. The agreements are entered into with counterparties that meet established credit standards and contain master netting and collateral provisions protecting the at-risk party. The derivatives program is overseen by the Risk Management Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors. Based on adherence to the Company’s credit standards and the presence of the netting and collateral provisions, the Company believes that the credit risk inherent in these contracts was not significant at year-end 2011.

 

The Company pledged collateral to derivative counterparties in the form of cash totaling $1.6 million and securities with an amortized cost of $33.1 million and a fair value of $35.2 million at year-end 2011. The Company does not typically require its Commercial customers to post cash or securities collateral on its program of back-to-back economic hedges, however certain language is written in to the ISDA and loan documents where, in default situations, the Bank is allowed to access collateral supporting the loan relationship to recover any losses suffered on the derivative asset. The Company may need to post additional collateral in the future in proportion to potential increases in unrealized loss positions.

 

F-58
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Information about interest rate swap agreements and non-hedging derivative assets and liabilities at year-end 2011 follows:

 

       Weighted           Estimated 
   Notional   Average   Weighted Average Rate   Fair Value 
   Amount   Maturity   Received   Paid   Asset (Liability) 
   (In thousands)   (In years)           (In thousands) 
Cash flow hedges:                         
Interest rate swaps on FHLBB borrowings  $105,000    1.7    0.49%   4.00%  $(5,888)
Forward-starting interest rate swaps on FHLBB borrowings   80,000    3.5    -    2.56%   (2,064)
Interest rate swaps on junior subordinated debentures   15,000    2.4    2.35%   5.54%   (1,055)
Total cash flow hedges   200,000                   (9,007)
                          
Economic hedges:                         
Interest rate swap on tax advantaged economic development bond   14,096    17.9    0.64%   5.09%   (3,505)
Interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers   160,389    5.6    2.73%   5.77%   (14,351)
Reverse interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers   160,389    5.6    5.77%   2.73%   13,871 
Total economic hedges   334,874                   (3,985)
                          
Non-hedging derivatives:                         
Commitments to originate residential mortgage loans   21,538    0.2              (66)
Commitments to sell residential mortgage loans   21,538    0.2              55 
Total non-hedging derivatives   43,076                   (11)
                          
Total  $577,950                  $(13,003)

 

Information about interest rate swap agreements and non-hedging derivative asset and liabilities at year-end 2010 follows:

 

       Weighted           Estimated 
   Notional   Average   Weighted Average Rate   Fair Value 
   Amount   Maturity   Received   Paid   Asset (Liability) 
   (In thousands)   (In years)           (In thousands) 
Cash flow hedges:                         
Interest rate swaps on FHLBB borrowings  $105,000    2.7    0.29%   4.00%  $(7,696)
Forward-starting interest rate swaps on FHLBB borrowings   40,000    2.8    -    3.13    (468)
Interest rate swaps on junior subordinated debentures   15,000    3.4    2.13    5.54    (1,142)
Total cash flow hedges   160,000                   (9,306)
                          
Economic hedges:                         
Interest rate swap on tax advantaged economic development bond   14,559    18.9    0.63    5.09    (1,757)
Interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers   137,295    6.5    2.93    6.04    (7,374)
Reverse interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers   137,295    6.5    6.04    2.93    7,406 
Total economic hedges   289,149                   (1,725)
                          
Non-hedging derivatives:                         
Commitments to originate residential mortgage loans   13,172    0.2              (280)
Commitments to sell residential mortgage loans   13,172    0.2              267 
Total non-hedging derivatives   26,344                   (13)
                          
Total  $475,493                  $(11,044)

 

Cash Flow Hedges

 

The effective portion of unrealized changes in the fair value of derivatives accounted for as cash flow hedges are reported in other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified to earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings. Each quarter, the Company assesses the effectiveness of each hedging relationship by comparing the changes in cash flows of the derivative hedging instrument with the changes in cash flows of the designated hedged item or transaction. The ineffective portion of changes in the fair value of the derivatives is recognized directly in earnings.

 

F-59
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The Company has entered into several interest rate swaps with an aggregate notional amount of $105 million to convert the LIBOR based floating interest rates on a $105 million portfolio of FHLBB advances to fixed rates, with the objective of fixing the Company’s monthly interest expense on these borrowings.  In the third quarter of 2010, the Company terminated $40 million notional amount of interest rate swaps that were used to convert floating based FHLBB advances to a fixed rate.  The Company has retained the floating rate advances and fully anticipates holding these advances until maturity.  Net gains and losses for terminated cash flow hedges remain in accumulated other comprehensive income and are amortized into earnings in the same period or periods during which the originally hedged forecasted transaction affects earnings.  Management’s decision to terminate the swaps was based on its assessment that these hedges were no longer needed to execute management’s strategy for balance sheet management.

 

The Company has also entered into eight forward-starting interest rate swaps each with a notional value of $80 million at year-end 2011. These swaps become effective in sets of two at a time with the first set becoming effective in April 2012, the second in June 2012, the third in January 2013 and the final set becoming effective in April 2013. Four of these swaps have a one year duration, two have a four year duration and the remaining two have a five year duration. This hedge strategy converts the LIBOR based rate of interest on certain FHLBB advances to fixed interest rates, thereby protecting the Company from floating interest rate variability.

 

The Company has also entered into an interest rate swap with a notional value of $15 million to convert the floating rate interest on its junior subordinated debentures to a fixed rate of interest. The purpose of the hedge was to protect the Company from the risk of variability arising from the floating rate interest on the debentures.

 

Amounts included in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and in the other comprehensive income section of the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity related to interest rate derivatives designated as hedges of cash flows, were as follows:

 

F-60
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Interest rate swaps on FHLBB borrowings:          
Unrealized (loss) gain recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss  $254   $(4,738)
           
Elimination of unrealized loss for termination of swaps   -    5,448 
           
Realized loss recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss for termination of swaps   -    (6,382)
           
Reclassification of realized loss (gain)  from accumulated other comprehensive loss to interest expense for termination of swaps   942    319 
           
Reclassification of unrealized loss from accumulated other comprehensive loss to other non-interest income for hedge ineffectiveness   42    83 
           
Net tax benefit (expense) on items recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss   (505)   2,174 
           
Interest rate swaps on junior subordinated debentures:          
Unrealized (loss) gain recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss   87    (474)
           
Net tax benefit (expense) on items recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss   (37)   196 
Other comprehensive (loss) income recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of reclassification adjustments and tax effects  $783   $(3,374)
           
Net interest expense recognized in interest expense on hedged FHLBB borrowings  $4,870   $5,327 
Net interest expense recognized in interest expense on junior subordinated debentures  $516   $509 

 

Hedge ineffectiveness on interest rate swaps designated as cash flow hedges was immaterial to the Company’s financial statements during the years ended 2011 and 2010.  The Company does not anticipate material events or transactions within the next twelve months that are likely to result in a reclassification of unrealized gains or losses from accumulated other comprehensive loss to earnings.

 

Amounts reported in accumulated other comprehensive loss related to derivatives will be reclassified to interest expense as interest payments are made on the Company’s variable-rate liabilities. During the next twelve months, the Company estimates that $4.7 million will be reclassified as an increase to interest expense.

 

Economic Hedges and Non-Hedging Derivatives

 

At year-end 2011 and 2010, respectively, the Company has an interest rate swap with a $14.1 million and $14.6 million notional amount to swap out the fixed rate of interest on an economic development bond bearing a fixed rate of 5.09%, currently within the Company’s trading portfolio under the fair value option, in exchange for a LIBOR-based floating rate. The intent of the economic hedge is to improve the Company’s asset sensitivity to changing interest rates in anticipation of favorable average floating rates of interest over the 21-year life of the bond.  The fair value changes of the economic development bond are mostly offset by fair value changes of the related interest rate swap.

 

The Company also offers certain derivative products directly to qualified commercial borrowers.  The Company economically hedges derivative transactions executed with commercial borrowers by entering into mirror-image, offsetting derivatives with third-party financial institutions.  The transaction allows the Company’s customer to convert a variable-rate loan to a fixed rate loan. Because the Company acts as an intermediary for its customer, changes in the fair value of the underlying derivative contracts mostly offset each other in earnings. Credit valuation adjustments arising from the difference in credit worthiness of the commercial loan and financial institution counterparties totaled $480 thousand at year-end 2011 and were not material to the financial statements.  The interest income and expense on these mirror image swaps exactly offset each other.

 

F-61
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The Company enters into commitments with certain of its retail customers to originate fixed rate mortgage loans and simultaneously enters into an agreement to sell these fixed rate mortgage loans to Federal National Mortgage Association (“Fannie Mae”).  These commitments are considered derivative financial instruments and are recorded at fair value with any changes in fair value recorded through earnings.

 

Amounts included in the Consolidated Statements of Operations related to economic hedges and non-hedging derivatives were as follows: 

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands)  2011   2010 
         
Economic hedges          
Interest rate swap on industrial revenue bond:          
           
Net interest expense recognized in interest and dividend income on securities  $(727)  $(666)
           
Unrealized (loss) gain recognized in other non-interest income   -    (739)
           
Interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers:          
Unrealized gain recognized in other non-interest income   6,977    4,487 
           
Reverse interest rate swaps on loans with commercial loan customers:          
Unrealized loss recognized in other non-interest income   (6,977)   (4,487)
           
(Unfavorable) favorable change in credit valuation adjustment recognized in other non-interest income  $(512)  $(43)
           
Non-hedging derivatives          
Commitments to originate residential mortgage loans to be sold:          
Unrealized loss recognized in other non-interest income  $(358)  $(519)
           
Commitments to sell residential mortgage loans:          
Unrealized gain recognized in other non-interest income  $311   $535 

 

18.         OTHER COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES, AND OFF-BALANCE SHEET ACTIVITIES

 

Credit Related Financial Instruments. The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Such commitments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

 

F-62
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

The Company’s exposure to credit loss in the event of non-performance by the other party to the financial instrument is represented by the contractual amount of these commitments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments as it does for on-balance-sheet instruments.

 

A summary of financial instruments outstanding whose contract amounts represent credit risk is as follows at year-end:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Commitments to originate new loans  $26,184   $46,214 
Unused funds on commercial and other lines of credit   229,084    154,716 
Unadvanced funds on home equity lines of credit   225,315    172,117 
Unadvanced funds on construction and real estate loans   163,135    122,086 
Standby letters of credit   32,622    32,404 
Tax credit commitments   -    4,648 
Total  $676,340   $532,185 

 

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The commitments for lines of credit may expire without being drawn upon. Therefore, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Company evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis.

 

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. These letters of credit are primarily issued to support borrowing arrangements. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The Company considers standby letters of credit to be guarantees and the amount of the recorded liability related to such guarantees was not material at year-end 2011.

 

Tax credit commitments are contractual obligations to provide capital contributions to tax credit partnerships that support low income housing initiatives.

 

Operating Lease Commitments. Future minimum rental payments required under operating leases at year-end 2011 are as follows: 2012– $3.7 million; 2013 – $3.8 million; 2014 – $3.8 million; 2015 – $3.7 million; 2016 -$3.5 million and all years thereafter – $42.3 million. The leases contain options to extend for periods up to eighteen years. The cost of such rental options is not included above. Total rent expense for the years 2011, 2010 and 2009 amounted to $3.2 million, $3.2 million and $2.7 million, respectively.

 

Employment and Change in Control Agreements. The Company and the Bank have entered into a three-year employment agreement with one senior executive. The Company and the Bank also have change in control agreements with several officers which provide a severance payment in the event employment is terminated in conjunction with a defined change in control.

 

Legal Claims. Various legal claims arise from time to time in the normal course of business. In the opinion of management, claims outstanding at year-end 2011 will have no material effect on the Company’s financial statements.

 

Proposed Merger. On October 25, 2011, the Company and the Bank entered into a Merger Agreement with CBT pursuant to which CBT will merge with and into Berkshire Bank. The transaction is valued at approximately $30 million. Refer to Note 3 for further information.

 

F-63
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

19.          STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE

 

Earnings per common share have been computed based on the following (average diluted shares outstanding is calculated using the treasury stock method):

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands, except per share data)  2011   2010   2009 
             
Net income (loss) from continuing operations   16,667    13,858    (15,931)
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes (including gain on disposal of $4,962)   4,684    -    - 
Income tax expense   3,770    -    - 
Net income from discontinued operations   914    -    - 
Net income  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)
Less: Cumulative preferred stock dividends and accretion   -    -    1,030 
Less: Deemed dividend from preferred stock repayment   -    -    2,954 
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders  $17,581   $13,858   $(19,915)
                
Average number of common shares issued   19,812    15,849    15,239 
Less: average number of treasury shares   1,741    1,818    1,930 
Less: average number of unvested stock award shares   186    169    120 
Average number of basic common shares outstanding   17,885    13,862    13,189 
Plus:  dilutive effect of unvested stock award shares   -    25    - 
Plus:  dilutive effect of stock options outstanding   67    9    - 
Average number of diluted common shares outstanding   17,952    13,896    13,189 
                
Basic and diluted earnings per share:               
Continuing Operations  $0.93   $1.00   $(1.51)
Discontinued Operations  $0.05   $-   $- 

 

For the year ended 2011, 394 thousand options were anti-dilutive and therefore excluded from the earnings per share calculations. For the year ended 2010, 301 thousand options were anti-dilutive and therefore excluded from the earnings per share calculations. For the year ended 2009, 120 thousand shares of restricted stock and 430 thousand options were anti-dilutive and therefore excluded from the earnings per share calculations.

 

Basic earnings per common share (“EPS”) excludes dilution and is computed by dividing net income applicable to common stock by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the year. Diluted EPS reflects the potential dilution that could occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock (such as stock options) were exercised or converted into additional common shares that would then share in the earnings of the entity. Diluted EPS is computed by dividing net income applicable to common stock by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the year, plus an incremental number of common-equivalent shares computed using the treasury stock method.

 

F-64
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Minimum Regulatory Capital Requirements

 

The Bank is subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal and state banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of its assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weighting and other factors. The Company, as a savings and loan holding company, has no specific quantitative capital requirements.

 

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined) and of Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined). As of year-end 2011 and 2010, the Bank met the capital adequacy requirements. Regulators may set higher expected capital requirements in some cases based on their examinations.

 

As of year-end 2011 and 2010, the Bank met the conditions to be classified as “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as well capitalized, an institution must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based, and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the following tables.

 

The Bank’s actual and required capital amounts were as follows:

 

                   Minimum to be Well 
           Minimum   Capitalized Under 
           Capital   Prompt Corrective 
   Actual   Requirement   Action Provisions 
(Dollars in thousands)  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio 
                         
December 31, 2011                              
Total capital to risk-weighted assets  $347,187    11.29%  $246,014    8.00%  $307,517    10.00%
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets   314,320    10.22    123,022    4.00    184,532    6.00 
Tier 1 capital to average assets   314,320    8.41    149,498    4.00    186,873    5.00 
                               
December 31, 2010                              
Total capital to risk-weighted assets  $240,355    10.61%  $181,245    8.00%  $226,557    10.00%
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets   211,991    9.36    90,623    4.00    135,934    6.00 
Tier 1 capital to average assets   211,991    8.04    105,341    4.00    131,676    5.00 

  

F-65
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

 A reconciliation of the Company’s year-end total stockholders’ equity to the Bank’s regulatory capital is as follows: 

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Total stockholders' equity per consolidated financial statements  $553,365   $388,647 
           
Adjustments for Bank Tier 1 Capital:          
Holding company equity adjustment   (35,674)   (33,992)
Net unrealized gain on available for sale securities   (3,960)   (2,541)
Net unrealized loss on cash flow hedges   7,549    4,693 
Net unrealized loss on terminated swaps   -    3,547 
Disallowed goodwill and other intangible assets   (198,715)   (148,363)
Disallowed deferred taxes   (8,245)   - 
Total Bank Tier 1 Capital   314,320    211,991 
           
Adjustments for total capital:          
Includible allowances for loan losses   32,519    28,364 
Net unrealized loss (gain) on available for sale securities includible in Tier 2 capital   348    - 
Total Bank capital per regulatory reporting  $347,187   $240,355 

 

Common stock

 

The Bank is subject to dividend restrictions imposed by various regulators, including a limitation on the total of all dividends that the Bank may pay to the Company in any calendar year, to an amount that shall not exceed the Bank’s net income for the current year (as defined by statute), plus the Bank’s net income retained for the two previous years, without regulatory approval.  Dividends from the Bank are an important source of funds to the Company to make dividend payments on its common and preferred stock, to make payments on its borrowings, and for its other cash needs.  The ability of the Company and the Bank to pay dividends is dependent on regulatory policies and regulatory capital requirements.  The ability to pay such dividends in the future may be adversely affected by new legislation or regulations, or by changes in regulatory policies relating to capital, safety and soundness, and other regulatory concerns.

 

The payment of dividends by the Company is subject to Delaware law, which generally limits dividends to an amount equal to an excess of the net assets of a company (the amount by which total assets exceed total liabilities) over statutory capital, or if there is no excess, to the Company’s net profits for the current and/or immediately preceding fiscal year.

 

Other comprehensive (loss) income

 

Comprehensive (loss) income is the total of net income and all other non-owner changes in equity. It is displayed in the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity. Reclassification detail is shown for the years below.

 

F-66
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
Unrealized holding gain (loss) on AFS securities during the period  $2,329   $(116)  $6,958 
Reclassification adjustment for net realized loss on sale of AFS securities   -    -    4 
Unrealized gain (loss) on AFS securities at period end   2,329    (116)   6,962 
Net loss (gain) on effective cash flow hedging derivatives   341    319    7,286 
Net loss on terminated swap   942    (6,063)   - 
Net loss on pension plans   (676)   -    - 
Tax effects   (1,411)   2,418    (5,642)
Total other comprehensive (income) loss, net  $1,525   $(3,442)  $8,606 

 

Year-end components of accumulated other comprehensive loss are as follows:

 

(In thousands)  2011   2010 
Net unrealized holding gain (loss) on AFS securities  $6,299   $3,969 
Net loss on effective cash flow hedging derivatives   (8,882)   (9,222)
Net loss on terminated swap   (5,121)   (6,063)
Net unrealized holding gain (loss) on pension plans   (676)   - 
Tax effects   3,495    4,906 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  $(4,885)  $(6,410)

 

The Company’s accumulated other comprehensive loss totaled $4.9 million at year-end 2011. Of this loss, $14 million was attributable to accumulated losses on cash flow hedges, net of deferred tax benefits of $5.8 million, $6.3 million was attributable to accumulated gains on available-for-sale securities, net of deferred tax expenses of $2.3 million, and $0.7 million was attributable to accumulated losses on pensions.

 

The Company’s accumulated other comprehensive loss totaled $6.4 million at year-end 2010. Of this loss, $15.3 million was attributable to accumulated losses on cash flow hedges, net of deferred tax benefits of $6.4 million, and $4.0 million was attributable to accumulated gains on available-for-sale securities, net of deferred tax expenses of $1.5 million.

 

20.         STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS

The 2011 Equity Compensation Plan (the “Plan”) permits the granting of a combination of Restricted stock awards and incentive and non-qualified stock options (“Stock Options”) to employees and directors. A total of 1.4 million shares were authorized under the Plan. Awards may be granted as either Restricted Stock or Stock Options provided that any shares that are granted as Restricted Stock are counted against the share limit set forth as (1) three for every one share of Restricted Stock granted and (2) one for every one share of Stock Option granted. As of year-end 2011, the Company had the ability to grant approximately 1.2 million shares under this plan.

 

F-67
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

A summary of activity in the Company’s stock compensation plans is shown below:

 

   Non-vested Stock         
   Awards Outstanding   Stock Options Outstanding 
       Weighted-       Weighted- 
       Average       Average 
   Number of   Grant Date   Number of   Exercise 
(Shares in thousands)  Shares   Fair Value   Shares   Price 
Balance, December 31, 2010   171   $18.42    255   $25.69 
Granted   136    20.88    -    - 
Acquired   -    -    195    23.19 
Stock options exercised   -    -    (16)   15.87 
Stock awards vested   (68)   19.80    -    - 
Forfeited   (23)   19.49    -    - 
Expired   -    -    (37)   19.86 
Balance, December 31, 2011   216   $19.88    397   $25.39 
Exercisable options, December 31, 2011             397   $25.39 

 

Stock Awards

 

The total compensation cost for stock awards recognized as expense was $1.5 million, $1.6 million, and $1.4 million, in the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The total recognized tax benefit associated with this compensation cost was $0.6 million, $0.6 million, and $0.6 million, respectively.

 

The weighted average fair value of stock awards granted was $20.88, $16.76 and $23.10 in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Stock awards vest over periods up to five years and are valued at the closing price of the stock on the grant date.

 

The total fair value of stock awards vested during 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $1.3 million, $913 thousand and $1.4 million, respectively. The unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to unvested stock awards was $2.4 million as of year-end 2011. This amount is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of two years.

 

Option Awards

 

Option awards are granted with an exercise price equal to the market price of the Company’s stock at the date of grant, and vest over periods up to five years. The options grant the holder the right to acquire a share of the Company’s common stock for each option held, and have a contractual life of ten years. The Company generally issues shares from treasury stock as options are exercised. The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The expected dividend yield and expected term are based on management estimates. The expected volatility is based on historical volatility. The risk-free interest rates for the expected term are based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of the grant. The Company did not grant option awards in 2011 or 2010.

 

The total intrinsic value of options exercised was $98 thousand, $198 thousand, and $178 thousand for the years 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively. The expense pertaining to options vesting in the years 2011, 2010, and 2009 was $0, $53 thousand, and $43 thousand, respectively.

 

F-68
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

21.         FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS

 

A description of the valuation methodologies used for instruments measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy, is set forth below. These valuation methodologies were applied to all of the Company's financial assets and financial liabilities that are carried at fair value.

 

Recurring Fair Value Measurements of Financial Instruments

 

The following table summarizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of year-end 2011 and 2010, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value.

 

   2011 
   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3   Total 
(In thousands)  Inputs   Inputs   Inputs   Fair Value 
                 
 Trading account security  $-   $-   $17,395   $17,395 
 Available-for-sale securities:                    
Municipal bonds and obligations   -    77,854    -    77,854 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities   -    45,096    -    45,096 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   -    247,611    -    247,611 
Corporate bonds   -    9,727    -    9,727 
Trust preferred securities   -    17,271    544    17,815 
Other bonds and obligations   -    644    -    644 
Marketable equity securities   21,009    -    -    21,009 
 Derivative assets   -    13,926    -    13,926 
 Derivative liabilities   -    26,864    66    26,930 

  

   2010 
   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3   Total 
(In thousands)  Inputs   Inputs   Inputs   Fair Value 
                 
 Trading account security  $-   $-   $16,155   $16,155 
 Available-for-sale securities:                    
Municipal bonds and obligations   -    79,906    -    79,906 
Government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities   -    26,164    -    26,164 
Government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities   -    146,719    -    146,719 
Corporate bonds   -    18,290    -    18,290 
Trust preferred securities   -    19,637    218    19,855 
Other bonds and obligations   -    403    -    403 
Marketable equity securities   17,428    -    1,477    18,905 
 Derivative assets   -    7,673    -    7,673 
 Derivative liabilities   -    18,437    280    18,717 

 

Trading Security at Fair Value. The Company holds one security designated as a trading security. It is a tax advantaged economic development bond issued by the Company to a local nonprofit organization which provides wellness and health programs. The determination of the fair value for this security is determined based on a discounted cash flow methodology. Certain inputs to the fair value calculation are unobservable and there is little to no market activity in the security, therefore, the security meets the definition of a Level 3 security.

 

F-69
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Securities Available for Sale. AFS securities classified as Level 1 consist of publicly-traded equity securities for which the fair values can be obtained through quoted market prices in active exchange markets. AFS securities classified as Level 2 include most of the Company’s debt securities. The pricing on Level 2 was primarily sourced from third party pricing services, overseen by management, and is based on models that consider standard input factors such as dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the U.S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels, trade execution data, market consensus prepayment speeds, credit information and the bond's terms and condition, among other things.  The Company holds one pooled trust preferred security. This security’s fair value is based on unobservable issuer-provided financial information and discounted cash flow models derived from the underlying structured pool and therefore classified as Level 3.

 

Derivative Assets and Liabilities. The valuation of the Company’s interest rate swaps is obtained from a third-party pricing service overseen by management and is determined using a discounted cash flow analysis on the expected cash flows of each derivative. The pricing analysis is based on observable inputs for the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period to maturity and interest rate curves.

 

The Company incorporates credit valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect both its own non-performance risk and the respective counterparty’s non-performance risk in the fair value measurements.  In adjusting the fair value of its derivative contracts for the effect of non-performance risk, the Company has considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements, such as collateral postings.

 

Although the Company has determined that the majority of the inputs used to value its interest rate derivatives fall within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, the credit valuation adjustments associated with its derivatives utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default by itself and its counterparties.  However, as of year-end 2010 and 2011, the Company has assessed the significance of the impact of the credit valuation adjustments on the overall valuation of its derivative positions and has determined that the credit valuation adjustments are not significant to the overall valuation of its derivatives. As a result, the Company has determined that its derivative valuations in their entirety are classified in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.

 

The Company enters into various commitments to originate residential mortgage loans for sale and commitments to sell residential mortgage loans. Such commitments are considered to be derivative financial instruments and are carried at estimated fair value on the consolidated balance sheets. The estimated fair value of commitments to originate residential mortgage loans for sale is adjusted to reflect estimates for fall-out rates, associated servicing and origination costs. These assumptions are considered significant unobservable inputs resulting in a Level 3 classification. At year-end 2011, liabilities derived from commitments to originate residential mortgage loans for sale totaled $66 thousand. The estimated fair values of commitments to sell residential mortgage loans were calculated by reference to prices quoted by the Federal National Mortgage Association in secondary markets. These valuations result in a Level 2 classification. At year-end 2011, assets derived from commitments to sell residential mortgage loans totaled $311 thousand.

 

The table below presents the changes in Level 3 assets that were measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the years ended 2011 and 2010.

 

F-70
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

   Assets   Liabilities 
   Trading   Securities     
   Account   Available   Derivative 
(In thousands)  Security   for Sale   Liabilities 
             
Balance as of December 31, 2009  $15,880   $2,016   $(273)
                
Unrealized gain (loss) recognized in other non-interest income   715    -    (7)
Unrealized loss included in accumulated other comprehensive loss   -    (321)   - 
Amortization of trading account security   (440)   -    - 
Balance as of December 31, 2010  $16,155   $1,695   $(280)
                
Unrealized gain (loss) recognized in other non-interest income   1,704    -    214 
Unrealized gain included in accumulated other comprehensive loss   -    326    - 
Amortization of trading account security   (464)   -    - 
Transfer out of Level 3   -    (1,477)   - 
Balance as of December 31, 2011  $17,395   $544   $(66)
                
Unrealized gains (losses) relating to instruments still held at December 31, 2011  $3,299   $(2,055)  $- 
Unrealized gains (losses) relating to instruments still held at December 31, 2010  $1,595   $(2,447)  $- 

 

Non-Recurring Fair Value Measurements

 

The Company is required, on a non-recurring basis, to adjust the carrying value or provide valuation allowances for certain assets using fair value measurements in accordance with GAAP. The following is a summary of applicable non-recurring fair value measurements. There are no liabilities measured on a non-recurring basis.

 

   December 31, 2011   Year ended
December 31, 2011
 
   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3   Total 
(In thousands)  Inputs   Inputs   Inputs   Losses 
Assets                    
Impaired loans   -    -    11,155   $5,348 
Other real estate owned   -    -    1,900    1,950 
Capitalized mortgage servicing rights   -    -    3,067    - 
                     
Total Assets  $-   $-   $16,122   $7,298 

  

   December 31, 2010   Year ended
December 31, 2010
 
   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3   Total 
(In thousands)  Inputs   Inputs   Inputs   Losses 
Assets                    
Impaired loans  $-   $-   $4,960   $1,512 
Other real estate owned   -    -    3,386    1,100 
Capitalized mortgage servicing rights   -    -    2,035    178 
                     
Total Assets  $-   $-   $10,381   $2,790 

 

F-71
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Securities Held to Maturity. Held to maturity securities are recorded at amortized cost and are evaluated periodically for impairment. No impairments were recorded on securities held to maturity for the years ended 2011 and 2010. Held to maturity securities are fair valued using the same methodologies applied to the available for sale securities portfolio.  Most securities in the held to maturity portfolio consist of economic development bonds and issues to local municipalities that are not actively traded and are priced using a discounted cash flows model using unobservable inputs.  The Company views these as Level 3 pricing.

 

Restricted Equity Securities. The Company’s restricted equity securities balance is primarily composed of FHLBB stock having a carrying value of $32 million at year-end 2011. The additional $5.1 million of securities in this section include Savings Bank Life Insurance stock and stock in Federal Home Loan Bank of New York.  Restricted equity securities are recorded at par and periodically evaluated for impairment.  The FHLBB is a cooperative that provides services to its member banking institutions. The primary reason for joining the FHLBB was to obtain funding from the FHLBB and the purchase of stock in the FHLBB is a requirement for a member to gain access to funding. The Company purchases FHLBB stock proportional to the volume of funding received and views the purchases as a necessary long-term investment for the purposes of balance sheet liquidity and not for investment return.

 

The FHLBB reported positive net income for 2011 and reinstated its dividend payment in the first quarter of 2011. The Company also reviewed recent public filings, rating agency’s analysis which showed investment-grade ratings, capital position which exceeds all required capital levels, and other factors. As a result of the Company’s review for OTTI, management deemed the investment in the FHLBB stock not to be OTTI at year-end 2011. There can be no assurance as to the outcome of management’s future evaluation of the Company’s investment in the FHLBB though it will continue to be monitored closely.

 

Loans. Loans are generally not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Periodically, the Company records non-recurring adjustments to the carrying value of loans based on fair value measurements for partial charge-offs of the uncollectible portions of those loans. Non-recurring adjustments can also include certain impairment amounts for collateral-dependent loans calculated when establishing the allowance for credit losses. Such amounts are generally based on the fair value of the underlying collateral supporting the loan.  Real estate collateral is typically valued using appraisals or other indications of value based on recent comparable sales of similar properties or assumptions generally observable in the marketplace.  However, the choice of observable data is subject to significant judgment, and there are often adjustments based on judgment in order to make observable data comparable and to consider the impact of time, the condition of properties, interest rates, and other market factors on current values.  Additionally, commercial real estate appraisals frequently involve discounting of projected cash flows, which relies inherently on unobservable data.  Therefore, real estate collateral related nonrecurring fair value measurement adjustments have generally been classified as Level 3. Estimates of fair value used for other collateral supporting commercial loans generally are based on assumptions not observable in the marketplace and therefore such valuations have been classified as Level 3.

 

Loans Held for Sale. Loans originated and held for sale are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or fair value. No fair value adjustments were recorded on loans held for sale during 2011 and 2010.  The Company holds loans in the held for sale category for a period generally less than 3 months and as a result fair value approximates carrying value.

 

Capitalized Mortgage Loan Servicing Rights.   A loan servicing right asset represents the amount by which the present value of the estimated future net cash flows to be received from servicing loans are expected to more than adequately compensate the Company for performing the servicing. The fair value of servicing rights is estimated using a present value cash flow model. The most important assumptions used in the valuation model are the anticipated rate of the loan prepayments and discount rates. Adjustments are only recorded when the discounted cash flows derived from the valuation model are less than the carrying value of the asset. Although some assumptions in determining fair value are based on standards used by market participants, some are based on unobservable inputs and therefore are classified in Level 3 of the valuation hierarchy.

  

F-72
 

 

 Notes to consolidated financial statements

 

Other Real Estate Owned (“OREO”). OREO results from the foreclosure process on residential or commercial loans issued by the Bank. Upon assuming the real estate, the Company records the property at the fair value of the asset less the estimated sales costs. Thereafter, OREO properties are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. OREO fair values are primarily determined based on Level 3 data including sales comparables and appraisals.

 

Intangibles and Goodwill. The Company’s other intangible balance at year-end 2011 totaled $21.0 million. Other intangibles include core deposit intangibles, insurance and wealth management customer relationships, and non-compete agreements assumed by the Company as part of historical acquisitions. Other intangibles are initially recorded at fair value based on Level 3 data, such as internal appraisals and customized discounted criteria, and are amortized over their estimated lives on a straight-line or accelerated basis ranging from five to ten years. No impairment was recorded on other intangible assets for 2011 and 2010.

 

The Company’s Goodwill balance at year-end 2011 and 2010 was $202.4 million and $161.7 million respectively. The Company tests goodwill impairment annually in the fourth quarter or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that impairment is possible. No impairment was recorded on goodwill for 2011 and 2010. See Note 10 – Goodwill and Other Intangibles.

 

Summary of Estimated Fair Values of Financial Instruments

 

The estimated fair values, and related carrying amounts, of the Company’s financial instruments follow. Certain financial instruments and all non-financial instruments are excluded from disclosure requirements. Accordingly, the aggregate fair value amounts presented herein may not necessarily represent the underlying fair value of the Company.

  

F-73
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

  2011   2010 
   Carrying   Fair   Carrying   Fair 
(In thousands)  Amount   Value   Amount   Value 
                 
Financial Assets                    
                     
Cash and cash equivalents  $75,359   $75,359   $44,140   $44,140 
Trading security   17,395    17,395    16,155    16,155 
Securities available for sale   419,756    419,756    310,242    310,242 
Securities held to maturity   58,912    60,395    56,436    57,594 
Restricted equity securities   37,118    37,118    23,120    23,120 
Net loans   2,924,126    2,990,173    2,110,264    2,051,829 
Loans held for sale   1,455    1,455    1,043    1,043 
Accrued interest receivable   11,350    11,350    8,769    8,769 
Cash surrender value of life insurance policies   75,009    75,009    46,085    46,085 
Derivative assets   13,926    13,926    7,673    7,673 
                     
Financial Liabilities                    
                     
Total deposits  $3,101,175   $3,104,204   $2,204,441   $2,215,307 
Short-term debt   10,000    10,000    47,030    47,030 
Long-term Federal Home Loan Bank advances   211,938    215,008    197,807    200,746 
Junior subordinated debentures   15,464    11,436    15,464    9,742 
Derivative liabilities   26,930    26,930    18,717    18,717 

 

Other than as discussed above, the following methods and assumptions were used by management to estimate the fair value of significant classes of financial instruments for which it is practicable to estimate that value.

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents. Carrying value is assumed to represent fair value for cash and cash equivalents that have original maturities of ninety days or less.

 

Restricted Equity Securities. Carrying value approximates fair value based on the redemption provisions of the issuers.

 

Cash Surrender Value of Life Insurance Policies. Carrying value approximates fair value.

 

Loans, net. The carrying value of the loans in the loan portfolio is based on the cash flows of the loans discounted over their respective loan origination rates. The origination rates are adjusted for substandard and special mention loans to factor the impact of declines in the loan’s credit standing. The fair value of the loans is estimated by discounting future cash flows using the current interest rates at which similar loans with similar terms would be made to borrowers of similar credit quality.

 

Accrued Interest Receivable. Carrying value approximates fair value.

 

Deposits. The fair value of demand, non-interest bearing checking, savings and money market deposits is determined as the amount payable on demand at the reporting date. The fair value of time deposits is estimated by discounting the estimated future cash flows using market rates offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities.

 

Borrowed Funds. The fair value of borrowed funds is estimated by discounting the future cash flows using market rates for similar borrowings. Such funds include all categories of debt and debentures in the table above.

  

F-74
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

Junior Subordinated Debentures. The Company utilizes a pricing service along with internal models to estimate the valuation of its junior subordinated debentures. The junior subordinated debentures re-price every ninety days.

 

Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments. Off-balance-sheet financial instruments include standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees and commitments considered immaterial to the Company’s financial statements.

 

22.        OPERATING SEGMENTS 

  

The Company has two reportable operating segments, Banking and Insurance, which are delineated by the consolidated subsidiaries of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. Banking includes the activities of the Bank and its subsidiaries, which provide retail and commercial banking, along with wealth management and investment services. Insurance includes the activities of BIG, which provides retail and commercial insurance services. The only other consolidated financial activity of the Company is the Parent, which consists of the transactions of Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. Management fees for corporate services provided by the Bank to Berkshire Insurance Group and the Parent are eliminated.

 

The accounting policies of each reportable segment are the same as those of the Company. The Insurance segment and the Parent reimburse the Bank for administrative services provided to them. Income tax expense for the individual segments is calculated based on the activity of the segments, and the Parent records the tax expense or benefit necessary to reconcile to the consolidated total. The Parent does not allocate capital costs. Average assets include securities available-for-sale based on amortized cost.

 

F-75
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

A summary of the Company’s operating segments is as follows:

                   Total 
(In thousands)  Banking   Insurance   Parent   Eliminations   Consolidated 
Year ended December 31, 2011                         
Net interest income  $107,348   $-   $3,372   $(4,200)  $106,520 
Provision for loan losses   7,563    -    -    -    7,563 
Non-interest income   24,716    11,087    16,300    (16,300)   35,803 
Non-interest expense   103,197    8,736    4,119    -    116,052 
Income before income taxes   21,304    2,351    15,553    (20,500)   18,708 
Income tax expense (benefit)   3,083    986    (2,028)   -    2,041 
Net income from continuing operations   18,221    1,365    17,581    (20,500)   16,667 
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes (including gain on disposal of $4,962)   4,684    -    -    -    4,684 
Income tax expense   3,770    -    -    -    3,770 
Net income from discontinued operations   914    -    -    -    914 
Net income  $19,135   $1,365   $17,581   $(20,500)  $17,581 
              -           
Average assets (in millions)  $3,447   $32   $435   $(433)  $3,481 

 

                   Total 
(In thousands)  Banking   Insurance   Parent   Eliminations   Consolidated 
Year ended December 31, 2010                         
Net interest income  $77,802   $-   $(855)  $-   $76,947 
Provision for loan losses   8,526    -    -    -    8,526 
Non-interest income   18,560    11,193    15,089    (15,091)   29,751 
Non-interest expense   70,925    9,380    1,426    (2)   81,729 
Income before income taxes   16,911    1,813    12,808    (15,089)   16,443 
Income tax expense (benefit)   2,770    745    (930)   -    2,585 
Net income  $14,141   $1,068   $13,738   $(15,089)  $13,858 
                          
Average assets (in millions)  $2,704   $32   $361   $(359)  $2,738 

 

(In thousands)  Banking   Insurance   Parent   Eliminations   Total
Consolidated
 
Year ended December 31, 2009                         
Net interest income  $70,673   $-   $13,911   $(14,988)  $69,596 
Provision for loan losses   47,730    -    -    -    47,730 
Non-interest income   11,952    12,255    (29,290)   30,260    25,177 
Non-interest expense   67,167    10,165    1,241    (2)   78,571 
(Loss) income before income taxes   (32,272)   2,090    (16,620)   15,274    (31,528)
Income tax expense (benefit)   (15,963)   919    (553)   -    (15,597)
Net (loss) income  $(16,309)  $1,171   $(16,067)  $15,274   $(15,931)
                          
Average assets (in millions)  $2,647   $33   $385   $(397)  $2,683 

 

F-76
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

23.       CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF PARENT COMPANY

  

Condensed financial information pertaining only to the Parent, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, is as follows:

 

CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

 

   December 31, 
( In thousands)  2011   2010 
Assets          
           
Cash due from Berkshire Bank  $15,913   $13,145 
Investment in subsidiaries   541,725    382,118 
Other assets   12,610    10,148 
Total assets  $570,248   $405,411 
           
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity          
           
Accrued expenses payable  $1,419   $1,300 
Junior subordinated debentures   15,464    15,464 
Stockholders' equity   553,365    388,647 
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity  $570,248   $405,411 

 

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
             
Income:               
Dividends from subsidiaries   4,200   $-   $15,000 
Other   11    10    984 
Total income   4,211    10    15,984 
Interest expense   839    865    1,089 
Operating expenses   4,119    1,426    1,241 
Total expense   4,958    2,291    2,330 
Income (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed income (loss) of subsidiaries   (747)   (2,281)   13,654 
Income tax benefit   (2,028)   (930)   (553)
Income (loss) before equity in undistributed income (loss) of subsidiaries   1,281    (1,351)   14,207 
Equity in undistributed income (loss) of subsidiaries   16,300    15,209    (30,138)
                
Net income  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)

 

F-77
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
             
Cash flows from operating activities:               
Net income  (loss)  $17,851   $13,858   $(15,931)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash (used) provided by operating activities:               
Equity in undistributed (income) loss of subsidiaries   (20,500)   (15,209)   30,138 
Other, net   (194)   679    (678)
Net cash (used) provided by operating activities   (2,843)   (672)   13,529 
                
Cash flows from investing activities:               
Investment in insurance subsidiary   -    -    (1,400)
Acquisitions, net of cash paid   13,069    -    - 
Purchase of securities   -    (225)   (524)
Net cash provided (used) by investing activities   13,069    (225)   (1,924)
                
Cash flows from financing activities:               
Repayment of long-term debt   -    (1,580)   (17,000)
Redemption of preferred stock and warrant   -    -    (41,040)
Net proceeds from common stock issuance   -    -    32,365 
Net proceeds from reissuance of treasury stock   252    1,004    344 
Preferred stock cash dividends paid   -    -    (806)
Dividend from insurance subsidiary   4,200    -    - 
Common stock cash dividends paid   (11,910)   (8,989)   (8,390)
Net cash used by financing activities   (7,458)   (9,565)   (34,527)
                
Net change in cash and cash equivalents   2,768    (10,462)   (22,922)
                
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year   13,145    23,607    46,529 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  $15,913   $13,145   $23,607 

 

F-78
 

 

  

 Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

24.       QUARTERLY DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

Quarterly results of operations were as follows:

   2011   2010 
   Fourth   Third   Second   First   Fourth   Third   Second   First 
(In thousands, except per share data)  Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter 
                                 
Interest and dividend income  $39,028   $39,266   $32,053   $27,913   $28,369   $28,463   $27,963   $27,482 
Interest expense   7,893    8,228    7,852    7,767    8,274    8,779    9,092    9,185 
Net interest income   31,135    31,038    24,201    20,146    20,095    19,684    18,871    18,297 
Non-interest income   8,825    10,674    8,170    8,134    7,431    6,563    7,611    8,146 
Total revenue   39,960    41,712    32,371    28,280    27,526    26,247    26,482    26,443 
Provision for loan losses   2,263    2,200    1,500    1,600    2,000    2,000    2,200    2,326 
Non-interest expense   29,530    34,710    28,623    23,189    21,415    20,094    20,028    20,192 
Income before income taxes   8,167    4,802    2,248    3,491    4,111    4,153    4,254    3,925 
Income tax expense   609    405    371    656    511    699    816    559 
Net income from continuing operations   7,558    4,397    1,877    2,835    3,600    3,454    3,438    3,366 
Gain/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax   919    (5)   -    -    -    -    -    - 
Net income  $8,477   $4,392   $1,877   $2,835   $3,600   $3,454   $3,438   $3,366 
                                         
Average diluted common shares outstanding (thousands)   21,043    20,105    16,601    13,981    13,934    13,893    13,894    13,858 
                                         
Basic and diluted earnings per share:                                        
Continuing Operations  $0.36   $0.22   $0.11   $0.20   $0.26   $0.25   $0.25   $0.24 
Discontinued Operations  $0.04   $-   $-   $-   $-   $-   $-   $- 

 

Please see Note 2 regarding the Correction of an Immaterial Error.  Quarterly results of 2010 and the first quarter of 2011 have been revised to reflect this correction, as previously disclosed in the Company’s financial statements for the second and third quarters of 2011. 

 

In 2011, quarterly results were affected by the acquisitions of Rome Bancorp on April 1 and Legacy Bancorp on July 21.  Most categories of revenue and expense increased as a result of these acquisitions, and earnings per share were affected by new shares issued as merger consideration.  Additionally, the Company recorded merger and nonrecurring items which totaled (in millions after-tax) $1.4, $3.9, $4.2, and $0.8 in the first through fourth quarters respectively.  These items significantly affected quarterly net income and earnings per share.  The category of non-recurring and merger related expense totaled $20 million for the year 2011.  These expenses included $9 million in compensation and severance related expenses, $5 million in professional services, and $3 million in premises related charges, together with accruals for systems conversion costs and other restructuring costs. In the second half of the year, the Company designated certain Legacy branches as discontinued operations; these operations were divested in the fourth quarter of 2011 and the first quarter of 2012.  In addition to the impact of the acquisitions, net interest income benefited from an improvement in the net interest margin which primarily reflected lower funding costs as deposit rates were reduced in the ongoing low interest rate environment.  Changes in the loan loss provision reflected small changes in the loan loss allowance analysis.  Third quarter non-interest income included gains recorded on existing investments in Legacy common stock.  Quarterly non-interest expense included the impact of the merger related charges noted above.  The effective income tax rate for continuing operations decreased to 8% in the second half of the year from 18% in the first half of the year due primarily to the timing of the Legacy acquisition and the related branch divestiture, and costs related to those activities.

 

F-79
 

 

Notes to consolidated financial statements 

 

In 2010, net income increased in every quarter due to the benefit of organic growth and strict disciplines for margin and expense management.  Asset yields and funding costs continued to decline throughout the year due to the impact of the ongoing low interest rate environment.  The Company reduced its funding costs more than the decrease in earning asset yields, and as a result the net interest spread improved throughout the year, and the net interest margin improved in most quarters as well.  Average earning assets increased due primarily to loan growth.  Reflecting the benefit of higher balances and margins, quarterly net interest income improved throughout the year.  Non-interest income included seasonal insurance contingency revenues in the first half of the year.   Non-interest income increased in the final quarter of 2010 due to volume related growth in banking fees for deposit, loan, and interest rate swap services.  The quarterly loan loss provision and non-interest expense were generally flat throughout the year, except that fourth quarter non-interest expense increased including merger and acquisition related costs, along with other costs related to the Company’s expansion.  The quarterly effective tax rate was 14% in the first quarter, peaking at 19% in the second quarter due to the improving earnings, and declining to 12% in the final quarter due to proportionately higher tax preference items. 

 

25.       SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

 

On October 25, 2011, Berkshire Bank entered into a Purchase and Assumption Agreement with NBT Bank to sell approximately $57 million of deposits for a 2.5% deposit premium along with $1.6 million of loans and certain branch facilities of four former Legacy Banks branches located in Greene and Schoharie Counties, New York. On January 20, 2012, Berkshire Hills Bancorp, Inc. completed the divestiture of the deposits of four former Legacy Banks branches.

 

26.       NET INTEREST INCOME AFTER PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES

 

Presented below is net interest income after provision for loan losses for the three years ended 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively:

 

   Years Ended December 31, 
(In thousands)  2011   2010   2009 
Net interest income   106,520    76,947    69,596 
Provision for loan losses   7,563    8,526    47,730 
Net interest income after provision for loan losses   98,957    68,421    21,866 
Total non-interest income   35,803    29,751    25,177 
Total non-interest expense   116,052    81,729    78,571 
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes   18,708    16,443    (31,528)
Income tax expense (benefit)   2,041    2,585    (15,597)
Net income (loss) from continuing operations   16,667    13,858    (15,931)
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes (including gain on disposal of $4,962)   4,684    -    - 
Income tax expense   3,770    -    - 
Net income from discontinued operations   914    -    - 
Net income  $17,581   $13,858   $(15,931)
Less: Cumulative preferred stock dividends and accretion   -    -    1,030 
Less: Deemed dividend from preferred stock repayment   -    -    2,954 
Net income (loss) available to common stockholders  $17,581   $13,858   $(19,915)

 

F-80